1 /* Everything about breakpoints, for GDB.
3 Copyright (C) 1986-2016 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
5 This file is part of GDB.
7 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
8 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
9 the Free Software Foundation; either version 3 of the License, or
10 (at your option) any later version.
12 This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
13 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
14 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
15 GNU General Public License for more details.
17 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
18 along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. */
21 #include "arch-utils.h"
26 #include "breakpoint.h"
27 #include "tracepoint.h"
29 #include "expression.h"
36 #include "gdbthread.h"
39 #include "gdb-demangle.h"
40 #include "filenames.h"
46 #include "completer.h"
49 #include "cli/cli-script.h"
59 #include "parser-defs.h"
60 #include "gdb_regex.h"
62 #include "cli/cli-utils.h"
63 #include "continuations.h"
67 #include "dummy-frame.h"
71 #include "thread-fsm.h"
72 #include "tid-parse.h"
74 /* readline include files */
75 #include "readline/readline.h"
76 #include "readline/history.h"
78 /* readline defines this. */
81 #include "mi/mi-common.h"
82 #include "extension.h"
85 /* Enums for exception-handling support. */
86 enum exception_event_kind
93 /* Prototypes for local functions. */
95 static void enable_delete_command (char *, int);
97 static void enable_once_command (char *, int);
99 static void enable_count_command (char *, int);
101 static void disable_command (char *, int);
103 static void enable_command (char *, int);
105 static void map_breakpoint_numbers (const char *,
106 void (*) (struct breakpoint *,
110 static void ignore_command (char *, int);
112 static int breakpoint_re_set_one (void *);
114 static void breakpoint_re_set_default (struct breakpoint *);
117 create_sals_from_location_default (const struct event_location *location,
118 struct linespec_result *canonical,
119 enum bptype type_wanted);
121 static void create_breakpoints_sal_default (struct gdbarch *,
122 struct linespec_result *,
123 char *, char *, enum bptype,
124 enum bpdisp, int, int,
126 const struct breakpoint_ops *,
127 int, int, int, unsigned);
129 static void decode_location_default (struct breakpoint *b,
130 const struct event_location *location,
131 struct program_space *search_pspace,
132 struct symtabs_and_lines *sals);
134 static void clear_command (char *, int);
136 static void catch_command (char *, int);
138 static int can_use_hardware_watchpoint (struct value *);
140 static void break_command_1 (char *, int, int);
142 static void mention (struct breakpoint *);
144 static struct breakpoint *set_raw_breakpoint_without_location (struct gdbarch *,
146 const struct breakpoint_ops *);
147 static struct bp_location *add_location_to_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *,
148 const struct symtab_and_line *);
150 /* This function is used in gdbtk sources and thus can not be made
152 struct breakpoint *set_raw_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
153 struct symtab_and_line,
155 const struct breakpoint_ops *);
157 static struct breakpoint *
158 momentary_breakpoint_from_master (struct breakpoint *orig,
160 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
163 static void breakpoint_adjustment_warning (CORE_ADDR, CORE_ADDR, int, int);
165 static CORE_ADDR adjust_breakpoint_address (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
169 static void describe_other_breakpoints (struct gdbarch *,
170 struct program_space *, CORE_ADDR,
171 struct obj_section *, int);
173 static int watchpoint_locations_match (struct bp_location *loc1,
174 struct bp_location *loc2);
176 static int breakpoint_location_address_match (struct bp_location *bl,
177 struct address_space *aspace,
180 static int breakpoint_location_address_range_overlap (struct bp_location *,
181 struct address_space *,
184 static void breakpoints_info (char *, int);
186 static void watchpoints_info (char *, int);
188 static int breakpoint_1 (char *, int,
189 int (*) (const struct breakpoint *));
191 static int breakpoint_cond_eval (void *);
193 static void cleanup_executing_breakpoints (void *);
195 static void commands_command (char *, int);
197 static void condition_command (char *, int);
199 static int remove_breakpoint (struct bp_location *);
200 static int remove_breakpoint_1 (struct bp_location *, enum remove_bp_reason);
202 static enum print_stop_action print_bp_stop_message (bpstat bs);
204 static int watchpoint_check (void *);
206 static void maintenance_info_breakpoints (char *, int);
208 static int hw_breakpoint_used_count (void);
210 static int hw_watchpoint_use_count (struct breakpoint *);
212 static int hw_watchpoint_used_count_others (struct breakpoint *except,
214 int *other_type_used);
216 static void hbreak_command (char *, int);
218 static void thbreak_command (char *, int);
220 static void enable_breakpoint_disp (struct breakpoint *, enum bpdisp,
223 static void stop_command (char *arg, int from_tty);
225 static void stopin_command (char *arg, int from_tty);
227 static void stopat_command (char *arg, int from_tty);
229 static void tcatch_command (char *arg, int from_tty);
231 static void free_bp_location (struct bp_location *loc);
232 static void incref_bp_location (struct bp_location *loc);
233 static void decref_bp_location (struct bp_location **loc);
235 static struct bp_location *allocate_bp_location (struct breakpoint *bpt);
237 /* update_global_location_list's modes of operation wrt to whether to
238 insert locations now. */
239 enum ugll_insert_mode
241 /* Don't insert any breakpoint locations into the inferior, only
242 remove already-inserted locations that no longer should be
243 inserted. Functions that delete a breakpoint or breakpoints
244 should specify this mode, so that deleting a breakpoint doesn't
245 have the side effect of inserting the locations of other
246 breakpoints that are marked not-inserted, but should_be_inserted
247 returns true on them.
249 This behavior is useful is situations close to tear-down -- e.g.,
250 after an exec, while the target still has execution, but
251 breakpoint shadows of the previous executable image should *NOT*
252 be restored to the new image; or before detaching, where the
253 target still has execution and wants to delete breakpoints from
254 GDB's lists, and all breakpoints had already been removed from
258 /* May insert breakpoints iff breakpoints_should_be_inserted_now
259 claims breakpoints should be inserted now. */
262 /* Insert locations now, irrespective of
263 breakpoints_should_be_inserted_now. E.g., say all threads are
264 stopped right now, and the user did "continue". We need to
265 insert breakpoints _before_ resuming the target, but
266 UGLL_MAY_INSERT wouldn't insert them, because
267 breakpoints_should_be_inserted_now returns false at that point,
268 as no thread is running yet. */
272 static void update_global_location_list (enum ugll_insert_mode);
274 static void update_global_location_list_nothrow (enum ugll_insert_mode);
276 static int is_hardware_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *bpt);
278 static void insert_breakpoint_locations (void);
280 static void tracepoints_info (char *, int);
282 static void delete_trace_command (char *, int);
284 static void enable_trace_command (char *, int);
286 static void disable_trace_command (char *, int);
288 static void trace_pass_command (char *, int);
290 static void set_tracepoint_count (int num);
292 static int is_masked_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *b);
294 static struct bp_location **get_first_locp_gte_addr (CORE_ADDR address);
296 /* Return 1 if B refers to a static tracepoint set by marker ("-m"), zero
299 static int strace_marker_p (struct breakpoint *b);
301 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be inherited by all breakpoint_ops
302 that are implemented on top of software or hardware breakpoints
303 (user breakpoints, internal and momentary breakpoints, etc.). */
304 static struct breakpoint_ops bkpt_base_breakpoint_ops;
306 /* Internal breakpoints class type. */
307 static struct breakpoint_ops internal_breakpoint_ops;
309 /* Momentary breakpoints class type. */
310 static struct breakpoint_ops momentary_breakpoint_ops;
312 /* Momentary breakpoints for bp_longjmp and bp_exception class type. */
313 static struct breakpoint_ops longjmp_breakpoint_ops;
315 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in regular user created
317 struct breakpoint_ops bkpt_breakpoint_ops;
319 /* Breakpoints set on probes. */
320 static struct breakpoint_ops bkpt_probe_breakpoint_ops;
322 /* Dynamic printf class type. */
323 struct breakpoint_ops dprintf_breakpoint_ops;
325 /* The style in which to perform a dynamic printf. This is a user
326 option because different output options have different tradeoffs;
327 if GDB does the printing, there is better error handling if there
328 is a problem with any of the arguments, but using an inferior
329 function lets you have special-purpose printers and sending of
330 output to the same place as compiled-in print functions. */
332 static const char dprintf_style_gdb[] = "gdb";
333 static const char dprintf_style_call[] = "call";
334 static const char dprintf_style_agent[] = "agent";
335 static const char *const dprintf_style_enums[] = {
341 static const char *dprintf_style = dprintf_style_gdb;
343 /* The function to use for dynamic printf if the preferred style is to
344 call into the inferior. The value is simply a string that is
345 copied into the command, so it can be anything that GDB can
346 evaluate to a callable address, not necessarily a function name. */
348 static char *dprintf_function = "";
350 /* The channel to use for dynamic printf if the preferred style is to
351 call into the inferior; if a nonempty string, it will be passed to
352 the call as the first argument, with the format string as the
353 second. As with the dprintf function, this can be anything that
354 GDB knows how to evaluate, so in addition to common choices like
355 "stderr", this could be an app-specific expression like
356 "mystreams[curlogger]". */
358 static char *dprintf_channel = "";
360 /* True if dprintf commands should continue to operate even if GDB
362 static int disconnected_dprintf = 1;
364 /* A reference-counted struct command_line. This lets multiple
365 breakpoints share a single command list. */
366 struct counted_command_line
368 /* The reference count. */
371 /* The command list. */
372 struct command_line *commands;
375 struct command_line *
376 breakpoint_commands (struct breakpoint *b)
378 return b->commands ? b->commands->commands : NULL;
381 /* Flag indicating that a command has proceeded the inferior past the
382 current breakpoint. */
384 static int breakpoint_proceeded;
387 bpdisp_text (enum bpdisp disp)
389 /* NOTE: the following values are a part of MI protocol and
390 represent values of 'disp' field returned when inferior stops at
392 static const char * const bpdisps[] = {"del", "dstp", "dis", "keep"};
394 return bpdisps[(int) disp];
397 /* Prototypes for exported functions. */
398 /* If FALSE, gdb will not use hardware support for watchpoints, even
399 if such is available. */
400 static int can_use_hw_watchpoints;
403 show_can_use_hw_watchpoints (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty,
404 struct cmd_list_element *c,
407 fprintf_filtered (file,
408 _("Debugger's willingness to use "
409 "watchpoint hardware is %s.\n"),
413 /* If AUTO_BOOLEAN_FALSE, gdb will not attempt to create pending breakpoints.
414 If AUTO_BOOLEAN_TRUE, gdb will automatically create pending breakpoints
415 for unrecognized breakpoint locations.
416 If AUTO_BOOLEAN_AUTO, gdb will query when breakpoints are unrecognized. */
417 static enum auto_boolean pending_break_support;
419 show_pending_break_support (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty,
420 struct cmd_list_element *c,
423 fprintf_filtered (file,
424 _("Debugger's behavior regarding "
425 "pending breakpoints is %s.\n"),
429 /* If 1, gdb will automatically use hardware breakpoints for breakpoints
430 set with "break" but falling in read-only memory.
431 If 0, gdb will warn about such breakpoints, but won't automatically
432 use hardware breakpoints. */
433 static int automatic_hardware_breakpoints;
435 show_automatic_hardware_breakpoints (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty,
436 struct cmd_list_element *c,
439 fprintf_filtered (file,
440 _("Automatic usage of hardware breakpoints is %s.\n"),
444 /* If on, GDB keeps breakpoints inserted even if the inferior is
445 stopped, and immediately inserts any new breakpoints as soon as
446 they're created. If off (default), GDB keeps breakpoints off of
447 the target as long as possible. That is, it delays inserting
448 breakpoints until the next resume, and removes them again when the
449 target fully stops. This is a bit safer in case GDB crashes while
450 processing user input. */
451 static int always_inserted_mode = 0;
454 show_always_inserted_mode (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty,
455 struct cmd_list_element *c, const char *value)
457 fprintf_filtered (file, _("Always inserted breakpoint mode is %s.\n"),
461 /* See breakpoint.h. */
464 breakpoints_should_be_inserted_now (void)
466 if (gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ()))
468 /* If breakpoints are global, they should be inserted even if no
469 thread under gdb's control is running, or even if there are
470 no threads under GDB's control yet. */
473 else if (target_has_execution)
475 struct thread_info *tp;
477 if (always_inserted_mode)
479 /* The user wants breakpoints inserted even if all threads
484 if (threads_are_executing ())
487 /* Don't remove breakpoints yet if, even though all threads are
488 stopped, we still have events to process. */
489 ALL_NON_EXITED_THREADS (tp)
491 && tp->suspend.waitstatus_pending_p)
497 static const char condition_evaluation_both[] = "host or target";
499 /* Modes for breakpoint condition evaluation. */
500 static const char condition_evaluation_auto[] = "auto";
501 static const char condition_evaluation_host[] = "host";
502 static const char condition_evaluation_target[] = "target";
503 static const char *const condition_evaluation_enums[] = {
504 condition_evaluation_auto,
505 condition_evaluation_host,
506 condition_evaluation_target,
510 /* Global that holds the current mode for breakpoint condition evaluation. */
511 static const char *condition_evaluation_mode_1 = condition_evaluation_auto;
513 /* Global that we use to display information to the user (gets its value from
514 condition_evaluation_mode_1. */
515 static const char *condition_evaluation_mode = condition_evaluation_auto;
517 /* Translate a condition evaluation mode MODE into either "host"
518 or "target". This is used mostly to translate from "auto" to the
519 real setting that is being used. It returns the translated
523 translate_condition_evaluation_mode (const char *mode)
525 if (mode == condition_evaluation_auto)
527 if (target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
528 return condition_evaluation_target;
530 return condition_evaluation_host;
536 /* Discovers what condition_evaluation_auto translates to. */
539 breakpoint_condition_evaluation_mode (void)
541 return translate_condition_evaluation_mode (condition_evaluation_mode);
544 /* Return true if GDB should evaluate breakpoint conditions or false
548 gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p (void)
550 const char *mode = breakpoint_condition_evaluation_mode ();
552 return (mode == condition_evaluation_host);
555 void _initialize_breakpoint (void);
557 /* Are we executing breakpoint commands? */
558 static int executing_breakpoint_commands;
560 /* Are overlay event breakpoints enabled? */
561 static int overlay_events_enabled;
563 /* See description in breakpoint.h. */
564 int target_exact_watchpoints = 0;
566 /* Walk the following statement or block through all breakpoints.
567 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE does so even if the statement deletes the
568 current breakpoint. */
570 #define ALL_BREAKPOINTS(B) for (B = breakpoint_chain; B; B = B->next)
572 #define ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE(B,TMP) \
573 for (B = breakpoint_chain; \
574 B ? (TMP=B->next, 1): 0; \
577 /* Similar iterator for the low-level breakpoints. SAFE variant is
578 not provided so update_global_location_list must not be called
579 while executing the block of ALL_BP_LOCATIONS. */
581 #define ALL_BP_LOCATIONS(B,BP_TMP) \
582 for (BP_TMP = bp_location; \
583 BP_TMP < bp_location + bp_location_count && (B = *BP_TMP); \
586 /* Iterates through locations with address ADDRESS for the currently selected
587 program space. BP_LOCP_TMP points to each object. BP_LOCP_START points
588 to where the loop should start from.
589 If BP_LOCP_START is a NULL pointer, the macro automatically seeks the
590 appropriate location to start with. */
592 #define ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR(BP_LOCP_TMP, BP_LOCP_START, ADDRESS) \
593 for (BP_LOCP_START = BP_LOCP_START == NULL ? get_first_locp_gte_addr (ADDRESS) : BP_LOCP_START, \
594 BP_LOCP_TMP = BP_LOCP_START; \
596 && (BP_LOCP_TMP < bp_location + bp_location_count \
597 && (*BP_LOCP_TMP)->address == ADDRESS); \
600 /* Iterator for tracepoints only. */
602 #define ALL_TRACEPOINTS(B) \
603 for (B = breakpoint_chain; B; B = B->next) \
604 if (is_tracepoint (B))
606 /* Chains of all breakpoints defined. */
608 struct breakpoint *breakpoint_chain;
610 /* Array is sorted by bp_location_compare - primarily by the ADDRESS. */
612 static struct bp_location **bp_location;
614 /* Number of elements of BP_LOCATION. */
616 static unsigned bp_location_count;
618 /* Maximum alignment offset between bp_target_info.PLACED_ADDRESS and
619 ADDRESS for the current elements of BP_LOCATION which get a valid
620 result from bp_location_has_shadow. You can use it for roughly
621 limiting the subrange of BP_LOCATION to scan for shadow bytes for
622 an address you need to read. */
624 static CORE_ADDR bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max;
626 /* Maximum offset plus alignment between bp_target_info.PLACED_ADDRESS
627 + bp_target_info.SHADOW_LEN and ADDRESS for the current elements of
628 BP_LOCATION which get a valid result from bp_location_has_shadow.
629 You can use it for roughly limiting the subrange of BP_LOCATION to
630 scan for shadow bytes for an address you need to read. */
632 static CORE_ADDR bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max;
634 /* The locations that no longer correspond to any breakpoint, unlinked
635 from bp_location array, but for which a hit may still be reported
637 VEC(bp_location_p) *moribund_locations = NULL;
639 /* Number of last breakpoint made. */
641 static int breakpoint_count;
643 /* The value of `breakpoint_count' before the last command that
644 created breakpoints. If the last (break-like) command created more
645 than one breakpoint, then the difference between BREAKPOINT_COUNT
646 and PREV_BREAKPOINT_COUNT is more than one. */
647 static int prev_breakpoint_count;
649 /* Number of last tracepoint made. */
651 static int tracepoint_count;
653 static struct cmd_list_element *breakpoint_set_cmdlist;
654 static struct cmd_list_element *breakpoint_show_cmdlist;
655 struct cmd_list_element *save_cmdlist;
657 /* See declaration at breakpoint.h. */
660 breakpoint_find_if (int (*func) (struct breakpoint *b, void *d),
663 struct breakpoint *b = NULL;
667 if (func (b, user_data) != 0)
674 /* Return whether a breakpoint is an active enabled breakpoint. */
676 breakpoint_enabled (struct breakpoint *b)
678 return (b->enable_state == bp_enabled);
681 /* Set breakpoint count to NUM. */
684 set_breakpoint_count (int num)
686 prev_breakpoint_count = breakpoint_count;
687 breakpoint_count = num;
688 set_internalvar_integer (lookup_internalvar ("bpnum"), num);
691 /* Used by `start_rbreak_breakpoints' below, to record the current
692 breakpoint count before "rbreak" creates any breakpoint. */
693 static int rbreak_start_breakpoint_count;
695 /* Called at the start an "rbreak" command to record the first
699 start_rbreak_breakpoints (void)
701 rbreak_start_breakpoint_count = breakpoint_count;
704 /* Called at the end of an "rbreak" command to record the last
708 end_rbreak_breakpoints (void)
710 prev_breakpoint_count = rbreak_start_breakpoint_count;
713 /* Used in run_command to zero the hit count when a new run starts. */
716 clear_breakpoint_hit_counts (void)
718 struct breakpoint *b;
724 /* Allocate a new counted_command_line with reference count of 1.
725 The new structure owns COMMANDS. */
727 static struct counted_command_line *
728 alloc_counted_command_line (struct command_line *commands)
730 struct counted_command_line *result = XNEW (struct counted_command_line);
733 result->commands = commands;
738 /* Increment reference count. This does nothing if CMD is NULL. */
741 incref_counted_command_line (struct counted_command_line *cmd)
747 /* Decrement reference count. If the reference count reaches 0,
748 destroy the counted_command_line. Sets *CMDP to NULL. This does
749 nothing if *CMDP is NULL. */
752 decref_counted_command_line (struct counted_command_line **cmdp)
756 if (--(*cmdp)->refc == 0)
758 free_command_lines (&(*cmdp)->commands);
765 /* A cleanup function that calls decref_counted_command_line. */
768 do_cleanup_counted_command_line (void *arg)
770 decref_counted_command_line ((struct counted_command_line **) arg);
773 /* Create a cleanup that calls decref_counted_command_line on the
776 static struct cleanup *
777 make_cleanup_decref_counted_command_line (struct counted_command_line **cmdp)
779 return make_cleanup (do_cleanup_counted_command_line, cmdp);
783 /* Return the breakpoint with the specified number, or NULL
784 if the number does not refer to an existing breakpoint. */
787 get_breakpoint (int num)
789 struct breakpoint *b;
792 if (b->number == num)
800 /* Mark locations as "conditions have changed" in case the target supports
801 evaluating conditions on its side. */
804 mark_breakpoint_modified (struct breakpoint *b)
806 struct bp_location *loc;
808 /* This is only meaningful if the target is
809 evaluating conditions and if the user has
810 opted for condition evaluation on the target's
812 if (gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p ()
813 || !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
816 if (!is_breakpoint (b))
819 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
820 loc->condition_changed = condition_modified;
823 /* Mark location as "conditions have changed" in case the target supports
824 evaluating conditions on its side. */
827 mark_breakpoint_location_modified (struct bp_location *loc)
829 /* This is only meaningful if the target is
830 evaluating conditions and if the user has
831 opted for condition evaluation on the target's
833 if (gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p ()
834 || !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
838 if (!is_breakpoint (loc->owner))
841 loc->condition_changed = condition_modified;
844 /* Sets the condition-evaluation mode using the static global
845 condition_evaluation_mode. */
848 set_condition_evaluation_mode (char *args, int from_tty,
849 struct cmd_list_element *c)
851 const char *old_mode, *new_mode;
853 if ((condition_evaluation_mode_1 == condition_evaluation_target)
854 && !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
856 condition_evaluation_mode_1 = condition_evaluation_mode;
857 warning (_("Target does not support breakpoint condition evaluation.\n"
858 "Using host evaluation mode instead."));
862 new_mode = translate_condition_evaluation_mode (condition_evaluation_mode_1);
863 old_mode = translate_condition_evaluation_mode (condition_evaluation_mode);
865 /* Flip the switch. Flip it even if OLD_MODE == NEW_MODE as one of the
866 settings was "auto". */
867 condition_evaluation_mode = condition_evaluation_mode_1;
869 /* Only update the mode if the user picked a different one. */
870 if (new_mode != old_mode)
872 struct bp_location *loc, **loc_tmp;
873 /* If the user switched to a different evaluation mode, we
874 need to synch the changes with the target as follows:
876 "host" -> "target": Send all (valid) conditions to the target.
877 "target" -> "host": Remove all the conditions from the target.
880 if (new_mode == condition_evaluation_target)
882 /* Mark everything modified and synch conditions with the
884 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, loc_tmp)
885 mark_breakpoint_location_modified (loc);
889 /* Manually mark non-duplicate locations to synch conditions
890 with the target. We do this to remove all the conditions the
891 target knows about. */
892 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, loc_tmp)
893 if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner) && loc->inserted)
894 loc->needs_update = 1;
898 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
904 /* Shows the current mode of breakpoint condition evaluation. Explicitly shows
905 what "auto" is translating to. */
908 show_condition_evaluation_mode (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty,
909 struct cmd_list_element *c, const char *value)
911 if (condition_evaluation_mode == condition_evaluation_auto)
912 fprintf_filtered (file,
913 _("Breakpoint condition evaluation "
914 "mode is %s (currently %s).\n"),
916 breakpoint_condition_evaluation_mode ());
918 fprintf_filtered (file, _("Breakpoint condition evaluation mode is %s.\n"),
922 /* A comparison function for bp_location AP and BP that is used by
923 bsearch. This comparison function only cares about addresses, unlike
924 the more general bp_location_compare function. */
927 bp_location_compare_addrs (const void *ap, const void *bp)
929 const struct bp_location *a = *(const struct bp_location **) ap;
930 const struct bp_location *b = *(const struct bp_location **) bp;
932 if (a->address == b->address)
935 return ((a->address > b->address) - (a->address < b->address));
938 /* Helper function to skip all bp_locations with addresses
939 less than ADDRESS. It returns the first bp_location that
940 is greater than or equal to ADDRESS. If none is found, just
943 static struct bp_location **
944 get_first_locp_gte_addr (CORE_ADDR address)
946 struct bp_location dummy_loc;
947 struct bp_location *dummy_locp = &dummy_loc;
948 struct bp_location **locp_found = NULL;
950 /* Initialize the dummy location's address field. */
951 memset (&dummy_loc, 0, sizeof (struct bp_location));
952 dummy_loc.address = address;
954 /* Find a close match to the first location at ADDRESS. */
955 locp_found = ((struct bp_location **)
956 bsearch (&dummy_locp, bp_location, bp_location_count,
957 sizeof (struct bp_location **),
958 bp_location_compare_addrs));
960 /* Nothing was found, nothing left to do. */
961 if (locp_found == NULL)
964 /* We may have found a location that is at ADDRESS but is not the first in the
965 location's list. Go backwards (if possible) and locate the first one. */
966 while ((locp_found - 1) >= bp_location
967 && (*(locp_found - 1))->address == address)
974 set_breakpoint_condition (struct breakpoint *b, const char *exp,
977 xfree (b->cond_string);
978 b->cond_string = NULL;
980 if (is_watchpoint (b))
982 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
984 w->cond_exp.reset ();
988 struct bp_location *loc;
990 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
994 /* No need to free the condition agent expression
995 bytecode (if we have one). We will handle this
996 when we go through update_global_location_list. */
1003 printf_filtered (_("Breakpoint %d now unconditional.\n"), b->number);
1007 const char *arg = exp;
1009 /* I don't know if it matters whether this is the string the user
1010 typed in or the decompiled expression. */
1011 b->cond_string = xstrdup (arg);
1012 b->condition_not_parsed = 0;
1014 if (is_watchpoint (b))
1016 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
1018 innermost_block = NULL;
1020 w->cond_exp = parse_exp_1 (&arg, 0, 0, 0);
1022 error (_("Junk at end of expression"));
1023 w->cond_exp_valid_block = innermost_block;
1027 struct bp_location *loc;
1029 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
1033 parse_exp_1 (&arg, loc->address,
1034 block_for_pc (loc->address), 0);
1036 error (_("Junk at end of expression"));
1040 mark_breakpoint_modified (b);
1042 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b);
1045 /* Completion for the "condition" command. */
1047 static VEC (char_ptr) *
1048 condition_completer (struct cmd_list_element *cmd,
1049 const char *text, const char *word)
1053 text = skip_spaces_const (text);
1054 space = skip_to_space_const (text);
1058 struct breakpoint *b;
1059 VEC (char_ptr) *result = NULL;
1063 /* We don't support completion of history indices. */
1064 if (isdigit (text[1]))
1066 return complete_internalvar (&text[1]);
1069 /* We're completing the breakpoint number. */
1070 len = strlen (text);
1076 xsnprintf (number, sizeof (number), "%d", b->number);
1078 if (strncmp (number, text, len) == 0)
1079 VEC_safe_push (char_ptr, result, xstrdup (number));
1085 /* We're completing the expression part. */
1086 text = skip_spaces_const (space);
1087 return expression_completer (cmd, text, word);
1090 /* condition N EXP -- set break condition of breakpoint N to EXP. */
1093 condition_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
1095 struct breakpoint *b;
1100 error_no_arg (_("breakpoint number"));
1103 bnum = get_number (&p);
1105 error (_("Bad breakpoint argument: '%s'"), arg);
1108 if (b->number == bnum)
1110 /* Check if this breakpoint has a "stop" method implemented in an
1111 extension language. This method and conditions entered into GDB
1112 from the CLI are mutually exclusive. */
1113 const struct extension_language_defn *extlang
1114 = get_breakpoint_cond_ext_lang (b, EXT_LANG_NONE);
1116 if (extlang != NULL)
1118 error (_("Only one stop condition allowed. There is currently"
1119 " a %s stop condition defined for this breakpoint."),
1120 ext_lang_capitalized_name (extlang));
1122 set_breakpoint_condition (b, p, from_tty);
1124 if (is_breakpoint (b))
1125 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
1130 error (_("No breakpoint number %d."), bnum);
1133 /* Check that COMMAND do not contain commands that are suitable
1134 only for tracepoints and not suitable for ordinary breakpoints.
1135 Throw if any such commands is found. */
1138 check_no_tracepoint_commands (struct command_line *commands)
1140 struct command_line *c;
1142 for (c = commands; c; c = c->next)
1146 if (c->control_type == while_stepping_control)
1147 error (_("The 'while-stepping' command can "
1148 "only be used for tracepoints"));
1150 for (i = 0; i < c->body_count; ++i)
1151 check_no_tracepoint_commands ((c->body_list)[i]);
1153 /* Not that command parsing removes leading whitespace and comment
1154 lines and also empty lines. So, we only need to check for
1155 command directly. */
1156 if (strstr (c->line, "collect ") == c->line)
1157 error (_("The 'collect' command can only be used for tracepoints"));
1159 if (strstr (c->line, "teval ") == c->line)
1160 error (_("The 'teval' command can only be used for tracepoints"));
1164 /* Encapsulate tests for different types of tracepoints. */
1167 is_tracepoint_type (enum bptype type)
1169 return (type == bp_tracepoint
1170 || type == bp_fast_tracepoint
1171 || type == bp_static_tracepoint);
1175 is_tracepoint (const struct breakpoint *b)
1177 return is_tracepoint_type (b->type);
1180 /* A helper function that validates that COMMANDS are valid for a
1181 breakpoint. This function will throw an exception if a problem is
1185 validate_commands_for_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b,
1186 struct command_line *commands)
1188 if (is_tracepoint (b))
1190 struct tracepoint *t = (struct tracepoint *) b;
1191 struct command_line *c;
1192 struct command_line *while_stepping = 0;
1194 /* Reset the while-stepping step count. The previous commands
1195 might have included a while-stepping action, while the new
1199 /* We need to verify that each top-level element of commands is
1200 valid for tracepoints, that there's at most one
1201 while-stepping element, and that the while-stepping's body
1202 has valid tracing commands excluding nested while-stepping.
1203 We also need to validate the tracepoint action line in the
1204 context of the tracepoint --- validate_actionline actually
1205 has side effects, like setting the tracepoint's
1206 while-stepping STEP_COUNT, in addition to checking if the
1207 collect/teval actions parse and make sense in the
1208 tracepoint's context. */
1209 for (c = commands; c; c = c->next)
1211 if (c->control_type == while_stepping_control)
1213 if (b->type == bp_fast_tracepoint)
1214 error (_("The 'while-stepping' command "
1215 "cannot be used for fast tracepoint"));
1216 else if (b->type == bp_static_tracepoint)
1217 error (_("The 'while-stepping' command "
1218 "cannot be used for static tracepoint"));
1221 error (_("The 'while-stepping' command "
1222 "can be used only once"));
1227 validate_actionline (c->line, b);
1231 struct command_line *c2;
1233 gdb_assert (while_stepping->body_count == 1);
1234 c2 = while_stepping->body_list[0];
1235 for (; c2; c2 = c2->next)
1237 if (c2->control_type == while_stepping_control)
1238 error (_("The 'while-stepping' command cannot be nested"));
1244 check_no_tracepoint_commands (commands);
1248 /* Return a vector of all the static tracepoints set at ADDR. The
1249 caller is responsible for releasing the vector. */
1252 static_tracepoints_here (CORE_ADDR addr)
1254 struct breakpoint *b;
1255 VEC(breakpoint_p) *found = 0;
1256 struct bp_location *loc;
1259 if (b->type == bp_static_tracepoint)
1261 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
1262 if (loc->address == addr)
1263 VEC_safe_push(breakpoint_p, found, b);
1269 /* Set the command list of B to COMMANDS. If breakpoint is tracepoint,
1270 validate that only allowed commands are included. */
1273 breakpoint_set_commands (struct breakpoint *b,
1274 struct command_line *commands)
1276 validate_commands_for_breakpoint (b, commands);
1278 decref_counted_command_line (&b->commands);
1279 b->commands = alloc_counted_command_line (commands);
1280 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b);
1283 /* Set the internal `silent' flag on the breakpoint. Note that this
1284 is not the same as the "silent" that may appear in the breakpoint's
1288 breakpoint_set_silent (struct breakpoint *b, int silent)
1290 int old_silent = b->silent;
1293 if (old_silent != silent)
1294 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b);
1297 /* Set the thread for this breakpoint. If THREAD is -1, make the
1298 breakpoint work for any thread. */
1301 breakpoint_set_thread (struct breakpoint *b, int thread)
1303 int old_thread = b->thread;
1306 if (old_thread != thread)
1307 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b);
1310 /* Set the task for this breakpoint. If TASK is 0, make the
1311 breakpoint work for any task. */
1314 breakpoint_set_task (struct breakpoint *b, int task)
1316 int old_task = b->task;
1319 if (old_task != task)
1320 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b);
1324 check_tracepoint_command (char *line, void *closure)
1326 struct breakpoint *b = (struct breakpoint *) closure;
1328 validate_actionline (line, b);
1331 /* A structure used to pass information through
1332 map_breakpoint_numbers. */
1334 struct commands_info
1336 /* True if the command was typed at a tty. */
1339 /* The breakpoint range spec. */
1342 /* Non-NULL if the body of the commands are being read from this
1343 already-parsed command. */
1344 struct command_line *control;
1346 /* The command lines read from the user, or NULL if they have not
1348 struct counted_command_line *cmd;
1351 /* A callback for map_breakpoint_numbers that sets the commands for
1352 commands_command. */
1355 do_map_commands_command (struct breakpoint *b, void *data)
1357 struct commands_info *info = (struct commands_info *) data;
1359 if (info->cmd == NULL)
1361 struct command_line *l;
1363 if (info->control != NULL)
1364 l = copy_command_lines (info->control->body_list[0]);
1367 struct cleanup *old_chain;
1370 str = xstrprintf (_("Type commands for breakpoint(s) "
1371 "%s, one per line."),
1374 old_chain = make_cleanup (xfree, str);
1376 l = read_command_lines (str,
1379 ? check_tracepoint_command : 0),
1382 do_cleanups (old_chain);
1385 info->cmd = alloc_counted_command_line (l);
1388 /* If a breakpoint was on the list more than once, we don't need to
1390 if (b->commands != info->cmd)
1392 validate_commands_for_breakpoint (b, info->cmd->commands);
1393 incref_counted_command_line (info->cmd);
1394 decref_counted_command_line (&b->commands);
1395 b->commands = info->cmd;
1396 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b);
1401 commands_command_1 (const char *arg, int from_tty,
1402 struct command_line *control)
1404 struct cleanup *cleanups;
1405 struct commands_info info;
1407 info.from_tty = from_tty;
1408 info.control = control;
1410 /* If we read command lines from the user, then `info' will hold an
1411 extra reference to the commands that we must clean up. */
1412 cleanups = make_cleanup_decref_counted_command_line (&info.cmd);
1414 std::string new_arg;
1416 if (arg == NULL || !*arg)
1418 if (breakpoint_count - prev_breakpoint_count > 1)
1419 new_arg = string_printf ("%d-%d", prev_breakpoint_count + 1,
1421 else if (breakpoint_count > 0)
1422 new_arg = string_printf ("%d", breakpoint_count);
1427 info.arg = new_arg.c_str ();
1429 map_breakpoint_numbers (info.arg, do_map_commands_command, &info);
1431 if (info.cmd == NULL)
1432 error (_("No breakpoints specified."));
1434 do_cleanups (cleanups);
1438 commands_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
1440 commands_command_1 (arg, from_tty, NULL);
1443 /* Like commands_command, but instead of reading the commands from
1444 input stream, takes them from an already parsed command structure.
1446 This is used by cli-script.c to DTRT with breakpoint commands
1447 that are part of if and while bodies. */
1448 enum command_control_type
1449 commands_from_control_command (const char *arg, struct command_line *cmd)
1451 commands_command_1 (arg, 0, cmd);
1452 return simple_control;
1455 /* Return non-zero if BL->TARGET_INFO contains valid information. */
1458 bp_location_has_shadow (struct bp_location *bl)
1460 if (bl->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint)
1464 if (bl->target_info.shadow_len == 0)
1465 /* BL isn't valid, or doesn't shadow memory. */
1470 /* Update BUF, which is LEN bytes read from the target address
1471 MEMADDR, by replacing a memory breakpoint with its shadowed
1474 If READBUF is not NULL, this buffer must not overlap with the of
1475 the breakpoint location's shadow_contents buffer. Otherwise, a
1476 failed assertion internal error will be raised. */
1479 one_breakpoint_xfer_memory (gdb_byte *readbuf, gdb_byte *writebuf,
1480 const gdb_byte *writebuf_org,
1481 ULONGEST memaddr, LONGEST len,
1482 struct bp_target_info *target_info,
1483 struct gdbarch *gdbarch)
1485 /* Now do full processing of the found relevant range of elements. */
1486 CORE_ADDR bp_addr = 0;
1490 if (!breakpoint_address_match (target_info->placed_address_space, 0,
1491 current_program_space->aspace, 0))
1493 /* The breakpoint is inserted in a different address space. */
1497 /* Addresses and length of the part of the breakpoint that
1499 bp_addr = target_info->placed_address;
1500 bp_size = target_info->shadow_len;
1502 if (bp_addr + bp_size <= memaddr)
1504 /* The breakpoint is entirely before the chunk of memory we are
1509 if (bp_addr >= memaddr + len)
1511 /* The breakpoint is entirely after the chunk of memory we are
1516 /* Offset within shadow_contents. */
1517 if (bp_addr < memaddr)
1519 /* Only copy the second part of the breakpoint. */
1520 bp_size -= memaddr - bp_addr;
1521 bptoffset = memaddr - bp_addr;
1525 if (bp_addr + bp_size > memaddr + len)
1527 /* Only copy the first part of the breakpoint. */
1528 bp_size -= (bp_addr + bp_size) - (memaddr + len);
1531 if (readbuf != NULL)
1533 /* Verify that the readbuf buffer does not overlap with the
1534 shadow_contents buffer. */
1535 gdb_assert (target_info->shadow_contents >= readbuf + len
1536 || readbuf >= (target_info->shadow_contents
1537 + target_info->shadow_len));
1539 /* Update the read buffer with this inserted breakpoint's
1541 memcpy (readbuf + bp_addr - memaddr,
1542 target_info->shadow_contents + bptoffset, bp_size);
1546 const unsigned char *bp;
1547 CORE_ADDR addr = target_info->reqstd_address;
1550 /* Update the shadow with what we want to write to memory. */
1551 memcpy (target_info->shadow_contents + bptoffset,
1552 writebuf_org + bp_addr - memaddr, bp_size);
1554 /* Determine appropriate breakpoint contents and size for this
1556 bp = gdbarch_breakpoint_from_pc (gdbarch, &addr, &placed_size);
1558 /* Update the final write buffer with this inserted
1559 breakpoint's INSN. */
1560 memcpy (writebuf + bp_addr - memaddr, bp + bptoffset, bp_size);
1564 /* Update BUF, which is LEN bytes read from the target address MEMADDR,
1565 by replacing any memory breakpoints with their shadowed contents.
1567 If READBUF is not NULL, this buffer must not overlap with any of
1568 the breakpoint location's shadow_contents buffers. Otherwise,
1569 a failed assertion internal error will be raised.
1571 The range of shadowed area by each bp_location is:
1572 bl->address - bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max
1573 up to bl->address + bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max
1574 The range we were requested to resolve shadows for is:
1575 memaddr ... memaddr + len
1576 Thus the safe cutoff boundaries for performance optimization are
1577 memaddr + len <= (bl->address
1578 - bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max)
1580 bl->address + bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max <= memaddr */
1583 breakpoint_xfer_memory (gdb_byte *readbuf, gdb_byte *writebuf,
1584 const gdb_byte *writebuf_org,
1585 ULONGEST memaddr, LONGEST len)
1587 /* Left boundary, right boundary and median element of our binary
1589 unsigned bc_l, bc_r, bc;
1591 /* Find BC_L which is a leftmost element which may affect BUF
1592 content. It is safe to report lower value but a failure to
1593 report higher one. */
1596 bc_r = bp_location_count;
1597 while (bc_l + 1 < bc_r)
1599 struct bp_location *bl;
1601 bc = (bc_l + bc_r) / 2;
1602 bl = bp_location[bc];
1604 /* Check first BL->ADDRESS will not overflow due to the added
1605 constant. Then advance the left boundary only if we are sure
1606 the BC element can in no way affect the BUF content (MEMADDR
1607 to MEMADDR + LEN range).
1609 Use the BP_LOCATION_SHADOW_LEN_AFTER_ADDRESS_MAX safety
1610 offset so that we cannot miss a breakpoint with its shadow
1611 range tail still reaching MEMADDR. */
1613 if ((bl->address + bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max
1615 && (bl->address + bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max
1622 /* Due to the binary search above, we need to make sure we pick the
1623 first location that's at BC_L's address. E.g., if there are
1624 multiple locations at the same address, BC_L may end up pointing
1625 at a duplicate location, and miss the "master"/"inserted"
1626 location. Say, given locations L1, L2 and L3 at addresses A and
1629 L1@A, L2@A, L3@B, ...
1631 BC_L could end up pointing at location L2, while the "master"
1632 location could be L1. Since the `loc->inserted' flag is only set
1633 on "master" locations, we'd forget to restore the shadow of L1
1636 && bp_location[bc_l]->address == bp_location[bc_l - 1]->address)
1639 /* Now do full processing of the found relevant range of elements. */
1641 for (bc = bc_l; bc < bp_location_count; bc++)
1643 struct bp_location *bl = bp_location[bc];
1645 /* bp_location array has BL->OWNER always non-NULL. */
1646 if (bl->owner->type == bp_none)
1647 warning (_("reading through apparently deleted breakpoint #%d?"),
1650 /* Performance optimization: any further element can no longer affect BUF
1653 if (bl->address >= bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max
1654 && memaddr + len <= (bl->address
1655 - bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max))
1658 if (!bp_location_has_shadow (bl))
1661 one_breakpoint_xfer_memory (readbuf, writebuf, writebuf_org,
1662 memaddr, len, &bl->target_info, bl->gdbarch);
1668 /* Return true if BPT is either a software breakpoint or a hardware
1672 is_breakpoint (const struct breakpoint *bpt)
1674 return (bpt->type == bp_breakpoint
1675 || bpt->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint
1676 || bpt->type == bp_dprintf);
1679 /* Return true if BPT is of any hardware watchpoint kind. */
1682 is_hardware_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *bpt)
1684 return (bpt->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
1685 || bpt->type == bp_read_watchpoint
1686 || bpt->type == bp_access_watchpoint);
1689 /* Return true if BPT is of any watchpoint kind, hardware or
1693 is_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *bpt)
1695 return (is_hardware_watchpoint (bpt)
1696 || bpt->type == bp_watchpoint);
1699 /* Returns true if the current thread and its running state are safe
1700 to evaluate or update watchpoint B. Watchpoints on local
1701 expressions need to be evaluated in the context of the thread that
1702 was current when the watchpoint was created, and, that thread needs
1703 to be stopped to be able to select the correct frame context.
1704 Watchpoints on global expressions can be evaluated on any thread,
1705 and in any state. It is presently left to the target allowing
1706 memory accesses when threads are running. */
1709 watchpoint_in_thread_scope (struct watchpoint *b)
1711 return (b->base.pspace == current_program_space
1712 && (ptid_equal (b->watchpoint_thread, null_ptid)
1713 || (ptid_equal (inferior_ptid, b->watchpoint_thread)
1714 && !is_executing (inferior_ptid))));
1717 /* Set watchpoint B to disp_del_at_next_stop, even including its possible
1718 associated bp_watchpoint_scope breakpoint. */
1721 watchpoint_del_at_next_stop (struct watchpoint *w)
1723 struct breakpoint *b = &w->base;
1725 if (b->related_breakpoint != b)
1727 gdb_assert (b->related_breakpoint->type == bp_watchpoint_scope);
1728 gdb_assert (b->related_breakpoint->related_breakpoint == b);
1729 b->related_breakpoint->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
1730 b->related_breakpoint->related_breakpoint = b->related_breakpoint;
1731 b->related_breakpoint = b;
1733 b->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
1736 /* Extract a bitfield value from value VAL using the bit parameters contained in
1739 static struct value *
1740 extract_bitfield_from_watchpoint_value (struct watchpoint *w, struct value *val)
1742 struct value *bit_val;
1747 bit_val = allocate_value (value_type (val));
1749 unpack_value_bitfield (bit_val,
1752 value_contents_for_printing (val),
1759 /* Allocate a dummy location and add it to B, which must be a software
1760 watchpoint. This is required because even if a software watchpoint
1761 is not watching any memory, bpstat_stop_status requires a location
1762 to be able to report stops. */
1765 software_watchpoint_add_no_memory_location (struct breakpoint *b,
1766 struct program_space *pspace)
1768 gdb_assert (b->type == bp_watchpoint && b->loc == NULL);
1770 b->loc = allocate_bp_location (b);
1771 b->loc->pspace = pspace;
1772 b->loc->address = -1;
1773 b->loc->length = -1;
1776 /* Returns true if B is a software watchpoint that is not watching any
1777 memory (e.g., "watch $pc"). */
1780 is_no_memory_software_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *b)
1782 return (b->type == bp_watchpoint
1784 && b->loc->next == NULL
1785 && b->loc->address == -1
1786 && b->loc->length == -1);
1789 /* Assuming that B is a watchpoint:
1790 - Reparse watchpoint expression, if REPARSE is non-zero
1791 - Evaluate expression and store the result in B->val
1792 - Evaluate the condition if there is one, and store the result
1794 - Update the list of values that must be watched in B->loc.
1796 If the watchpoint disposition is disp_del_at_next_stop, then do
1797 nothing. If this is local watchpoint that is out of scope, delete
1800 Even with `set breakpoint always-inserted on' the watchpoints are
1801 removed + inserted on each stop here. Normal breakpoints must
1802 never be removed because they might be missed by a running thread
1803 when debugging in non-stop mode. On the other hand, hardware
1804 watchpoints (is_hardware_watchpoint; processed here) are specific
1805 to each LWP since they are stored in each LWP's hardware debug
1806 registers. Therefore, such LWP must be stopped first in order to
1807 be able to modify its hardware watchpoints.
1809 Hardware watchpoints must be reset exactly once after being
1810 presented to the user. It cannot be done sooner, because it would
1811 reset the data used to present the watchpoint hit to the user. And
1812 it must not be done later because it could display the same single
1813 watchpoint hit during multiple GDB stops. Note that the latter is
1814 relevant only to the hardware watchpoint types bp_read_watchpoint
1815 and bp_access_watchpoint. False hit by bp_hardware_watchpoint is
1816 not user-visible - its hit is suppressed if the memory content has
1819 The following constraints influence the location where we can reset
1820 hardware watchpoints:
1822 * target_stopped_by_watchpoint and target_stopped_data_address are
1823 called several times when GDB stops.
1826 * Multiple hardware watchpoints can be hit at the same time,
1827 causing GDB to stop. GDB only presents one hardware watchpoint
1828 hit at a time as the reason for stopping, and all the other hits
1829 are presented later, one after the other, each time the user
1830 requests the execution to be resumed. Execution is not resumed
1831 for the threads still having pending hit event stored in
1832 LWP_INFO->STATUS. While the watchpoint is already removed from
1833 the inferior on the first stop the thread hit event is kept being
1834 reported from its cached value by linux_nat_stopped_data_address
1835 until the real thread resume happens after the watchpoint gets
1836 presented and thus its LWP_INFO->STATUS gets reset.
1838 Therefore the hardware watchpoint hit can get safely reset on the
1839 watchpoint removal from inferior. */
1842 update_watchpoint (struct watchpoint *b, int reparse)
1844 int within_current_scope;
1845 struct frame_id saved_frame_id;
1848 /* If this is a local watchpoint, we only want to check if the
1849 watchpoint frame is in scope if the current thread is the thread
1850 that was used to create the watchpoint. */
1851 if (!watchpoint_in_thread_scope (b))
1854 if (b->base.disposition == disp_del_at_next_stop)
1859 /* Determine if the watchpoint is within scope. */
1860 if (b->exp_valid_block == NULL)
1861 within_current_scope = 1;
1864 struct frame_info *fi = get_current_frame ();
1865 struct gdbarch *frame_arch = get_frame_arch (fi);
1866 CORE_ADDR frame_pc = get_frame_pc (fi);
1868 /* If we're at a point where the stack has been destroyed
1869 (e.g. in a function epilogue), unwinding may not work
1870 properly. Do not attempt to recreate locations at this
1871 point. See similar comments in watchpoint_check. */
1872 if (gdbarch_stack_frame_destroyed_p (frame_arch, frame_pc))
1875 /* Save the current frame's ID so we can restore it after
1876 evaluating the watchpoint expression on its own frame. */
1877 /* FIXME drow/2003-09-09: It would be nice if evaluate_expression
1878 took a frame parameter, so that we didn't have to change the
1881 saved_frame_id = get_frame_id (get_selected_frame (NULL));
1883 fi = frame_find_by_id (b->watchpoint_frame);
1884 within_current_scope = (fi != NULL);
1885 if (within_current_scope)
1889 /* We don't free locations. They are stored in the bp_location array
1890 and update_global_location_list will eventually delete them and
1891 remove breakpoints if needed. */
1894 if (within_current_scope && reparse)
1899 s = b->exp_string_reparse ? b->exp_string_reparse : b->exp_string;
1900 b->exp = parse_exp_1 (&s, 0, b->exp_valid_block, 0);
1901 /* If the meaning of expression itself changed, the old value is
1902 no longer relevant. We don't want to report a watchpoint hit
1903 to the user when the old value and the new value may actually
1904 be completely different objects. */
1905 value_free (b->val);
1909 /* Note that unlike with breakpoints, the watchpoint's condition
1910 expression is stored in the breakpoint object, not in the
1911 locations (re)created below. */
1912 if (b->base.cond_string != NULL)
1914 b->cond_exp.reset ();
1916 s = b->base.cond_string;
1917 b->cond_exp = parse_exp_1 (&s, 0, b->cond_exp_valid_block, 0);
1921 /* If we failed to parse the expression, for example because
1922 it refers to a global variable in a not-yet-loaded shared library,
1923 don't try to insert watchpoint. We don't automatically delete
1924 such watchpoint, though, since failure to parse expression
1925 is different from out-of-scope watchpoint. */
1926 if (!target_has_execution)
1928 /* Without execution, memory can't change. No use to try and
1929 set watchpoint locations. The watchpoint will be reset when
1930 the target gains execution, through breakpoint_re_set. */
1931 if (!can_use_hw_watchpoints)
1933 if (b->base.ops->works_in_software_mode (&b->base))
1934 b->base.type = bp_watchpoint;
1936 error (_("Can't set read/access watchpoint when "
1937 "hardware watchpoints are disabled."));
1940 else if (within_current_scope && b->exp)
1943 struct value *val_chain, *v, *result, *next;
1944 struct program_space *frame_pspace;
1946 fetch_subexp_value (b->exp.get (), &pc, &v, &result, &val_chain, 0);
1948 /* Avoid setting b->val if it's already set. The meaning of
1949 b->val is 'the last value' user saw, and we should update
1950 it only if we reported that last value to user. As it
1951 happens, the code that reports it updates b->val directly.
1952 We don't keep track of the memory value for masked
1954 if (!b->val_valid && !is_masked_watchpoint (&b->base))
1956 if (b->val_bitsize != 0)
1958 v = extract_bitfield_from_watchpoint_value (b, v);
1966 frame_pspace = get_frame_program_space (get_selected_frame (NULL));
1968 /* Look at each value on the value chain. */
1969 for (v = val_chain; v; v = value_next (v))
1971 /* If it's a memory location, and GDB actually needed
1972 its contents to evaluate the expression, then we
1973 must watch it. If the first value returned is
1974 still lazy, that means an error occurred reading it;
1975 watch it anyway in case it becomes readable. */
1976 if (VALUE_LVAL (v) == lval_memory
1977 && (v == val_chain || ! value_lazy (v)))
1979 struct type *vtype = check_typedef (value_type (v));
1981 /* We only watch structs and arrays if user asked
1982 for it explicitly, never if they just happen to
1983 appear in the middle of some value chain. */
1985 || (TYPE_CODE (vtype) != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
1986 && TYPE_CODE (vtype) != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY))
1989 enum target_hw_bp_type type;
1990 struct bp_location *loc, **tmp;
1991 int bitpos = 0, bitsize = 0;
1993 if (value_bitsize (v) != 0)
1995 /* Extract the bit parameters out from the bitfield
1997 bitpos = value_bitpos (v);
1998 bitsize = value_bitsize (v);
2000 else if (v == result && b->val_bitsize != 0)
2002 /* If VAL_BITSIZE != 0 then RESULT is actually a bitfield
2003 lvalue whose bit parameters are saved in the fields
2004 VAL_BITPOS and VAL_BITSIZE. */
2005 bitpos = b->val_bitpos;
2006 bitsize = b->val_bitsize;
2009 addr = value_address (v);
2012 /* Skip the bytes that don't contain the bitfield. */
2017 if (b->base.type == bp_read_watchpoint)
2019 else if (b->base.type == bp_access_watchpoint)
2022 loc = allocate_bp_location (&b->base);
2023 for (tmp = &(b->base.loc); *tmp != NULL; tmp = &((*tmp)->next))
2026 loc->gdbarch = get_type_arch (value_type (v));
2028 loc->pspace = frame_pspace;
2029 loc->address = addr;
2033 /* Just cover the bytes that make up the bitfield. */
2034 loc->length = ((bitpos % 8) + bitsize + 7) / 8;
2037 loc->length = TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (v));
2039 loc->watchpoint_type = type;
2044 /* Change the type of breakpoint between hardware assisted or
2045 an ordinary watchpoint depending on the hardware support
2046 and free hardware slots. REPARSE is set when the inferior
2051 enum bp_loc_type loc_type;
2052 struct bp_location *bl;
2054 reg_cnt = can_use_hardware_watchpoint (val_chain);
2058 int i, target_resources_ok, other_type_used;
2061 /* Use an exact watchpoint when there's only one memory region to be
2062 watched, and only one debug register is needed to watch it. */
2063 b->exact = target_exact_watchpoints && reg_cnt == 1;
2065 /* We need to determine how many resources are already
2066 used for all other hardware watchpoints plus this one
2067 to see if we still have enough resources to also fit
2068 this watchpoint in as well. */
2070 /* If this is a software watchpoint, we try to turn it
2071 to a hardware one -- count resources as if B was of
2072 hardware watchpoint type. */
2073 type = b->base.type;
2074 if (type == bp_watchpoint)
2075 type = bp_hardware_watchpoint;
2077 /* This watchpoint may or may not have been placed on
2078 the list yet at this point (it won't be in the list
2079 if we're trying to create it for the first time,
2080 through watch_command), so always account for it
2083 /* Count resources used by all watchpoints except B. */
2084 i = hw_watchpoint_used_count_others (&b->base, type, &other_type_used);
2086 /* Add in the resources needed for B. */
2087 i += hw_watchpoint_use_count (&b->base);
2090 = target_can_use_hardware_watchpoint (type, i, other_type_used);
2091 if (target_resources_ok <= 0)
2093 int sw_mode = b->base.ops->works_in_software_mode (&b->base);
2095 if (target_resources_ok == 0 && !sw_mode)
2096 error (_("Target does not support this type of "
2097 "hardware watchpoint."));
2098 else if (target_resources_ok < 0 && !sw_mode)
2099 error (_("There are not enough available hardware "
2100 "resources for this watchpoint."));
2102 /* Downgrade to software watchpoint. */
2103 b->base.type = bp_watchpoint;
2107 /* If this was a software watchpoint, we've just
2108 found we have enough resources to turn it to a
2109 hardware watchpoint. Otherwise, this is a
2111 b->base.type = type;
2114 else if (!b->base.ops->works_in_software_mode (&b->base))
2116 if (!can_use_hw_watchpoints)
2117 error (_("Can't set read/access watchpoint when "
2118 "hardware watchpoints are disabled."));
2120 error (_("Expression cannot be implemented with "
2121 "read/access watchpoint."));
2124 b->base.type = bp_watchpoint;
2126 loc_type = (b->base.type == bp_watchpoint? bp_loc_other
2127 : bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint);
2128 for (bl = b->base.loc; bl; bl = bl->next)
2129 bl->loc_type = loc_type;
2132 for (v = val_chain; v; v = next)
2134 next = value_next (v);
2139 /* If a software watchpoint is not watching any memory, then the
2140 above left it without any location set up. But,
2141 bpstat_stop_status requires a location to be able to report
2142 stops, so make sure there's at least a dummy one. */
2143 if (b->base.type == bp_watchpoint && b->base.loc == NULL)
2144 software_watchpoint_add_no_memory_location (&b->base, frame_pspace);
2146 else if (!within_current_scope)
2148 printf_filtered (_("\
2149 Watchpoint %d deleted because the program has left the block\n\
2150 in which its expression is valid.\n"),
2152 watchpoint_del_at_next_stop (b);
2155 /* Restore the selected frame. */
2157 select_frame (frame_find_by_id (saved_frame_id));
2161 /* Returns 1 iff breakpoint location should be
2162 inserted in the inferior. We don't differentiate the type of BL's owner
2163 (breakpoint vs. tracepoint), although insert_location in tracepoint's
2164 breakpoint_ops is not defined, because in insert_bp_location,
2165 tracepoint's insert_location will not be called. */
2167 should_be_inserted (struct bp_location *bl)
2169 if (bl->owner == NULL || !breakpoint_enabled (bl->owner))
2172 if (bl->owner->disposition == disp_del_at_next_stop)
2175 if (!bl->enabled || bl->shlib_disabled || bl->duplicate)
2178 if (user_breakpoint_p (bl->owner) && bl->pspace->executing_startup)
2181 /* This is set for example, when we're attached to the parent of a
2182 vfork, and have detached from the child. The child is running
2183 free, and we expect it to do an exec or exit, at which point the
2184 OS makes the parent schedulable again (and the target reports
2185 that the vfork is done). Until the child is done with the shared
2186 memory region, do not insert breakpoints in the parent, otherwise
2187 the child could still trip on the parent's breakpoints. Since
2188 the parent is blocked anyway, it won't miss any breakpoint. */
2189 if (bl->pspace->breakpoints_not_allowed)
2192 /* Don't insert a breakpoint if we're trying to step past its
2193 location, except if the breakpoint is a single-step breakpoint,
2194 and the breakpoint's thread is the thread which is stepping past
2196 if ((bl->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
2197 || bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2198 && stepping_past_instruction_at (bl->pspace->aspace,
2200 /* The single-step breakpoint may be inserted at the location
2201 we're trying to step if the instruction branches to itself.
2202 However, the instruction won't be executed at all and it may
2203 break the semantics of the instruction, for example, the
2204 instruction is a conditional branch or updates some flags.
2205 We can't fix it unless GDB is able to emulate the instruction
2206 or switch to displaced stepping. */
2207 && !(bl->owner->type == bp_single_step
2208 && thread_is_stepping_over_breakpoint (bl->owner->thread)))
2212 fprintf_unfiltered (gdb_stdlog,
2213 "infrun: skipping breakpoint: "
2214 "stepping past insn at: %s\n",
2215 paddress (bl->gdbarch, bl->address));
2220 /* Don't insert watchpoints if we're trying to step past the
2221 instruction that triggered one. */
2222 if ((bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint)
2223 && stepping_past_nonsteppable_watchpoint ())
2227 fprintf_unfiltered (gdb_stdlog,
2228 "infrun: stepping past non-steppable watchpoint. "
2229 "skipping watchpoint at %s:%d\n",
2230 paddress (bl->gdbarch, bl->address),
2239 /* Same as should_be_inserted but does the check assuming
2240 that the location is not duplicated. */
2243 unduplicated_should_be_inserted (struct bp_location *bl)
2246 const int save_duplicate = bl->duplicate;
2249 result = should_be_inserted (bl);
2250 bl->duplicate = save_duplicate;
2254 /* Parses a conditional described by an expression COND into an
2255 agent expression bytecode suitable for evaluation
2256 by the bytecode interpreter. Return NULL if there was
2257 any error during parsing. */
2259 static agent_expr_up
2260 parse_cond_to_aexpr (CORE_ADDR scope, struct expression *cond)
2265 agent_expr_up aexpr;
2267 /* We don't want to stop processing, so catch any errors
2268 that may show up. */
2271 aexpr = gen_eval_for_expr (scope, cond);
2274 CATCH (ex, RETURN_MASK_ERROR)
2276 /* If we got here, it means the condition could not be parsed to a valid
2277 bytecode expression and thus can't be evaluated on the target's side.
2278 It's no use iterating through the conditions. */
2282 /* We have a valid agent expression. */
2286 /* Based on location BL, create a list of breakpoint conditions to be
2287 passed on to the target. If we have duplicated locations with different
2288 conditions, we will add such conditions to the list. The idea is that the
2289 target will evaluate the list of conditions and will only notify GDB when
2290 one of them is true. */
2293 build_target_condition_list (struct bp_location *bl)
2295 struct bp_location **locp = NULL, **loc2p;
2296 int null_condition_or_parse_error = 0;
2297 int modified = bl->needs_update;
2298 struct bp_location *loc;
2300 /* Release conditions left over from a previous insert. */
2301 bl->target_info.conditions.clear ();
2303 /* This is only meaningful if the target is
2304 evaluating conditions and if the user has
2305 opted for condition evaluation on the target's
2307 if (gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p ()
2308 || !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
2311 /* Do a first pass to check for locations with no assigned
2312 conditions or conditions that fail to parse to a valid agent expression
2313 bytecode. If any of these happen, then it's no use to send conditions
2314 to the target since this location will always trigger and generate a
2315 response back to GDB. */
2316 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (loc2p, locp, bl->address)
2319 if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner) && loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num)
2323 /* Re-parse the conditions since something changed. In that
2324 case we already freed the condition bytecodes (see
2325 force_breakpoint_reinsertion). We just
2326 need to parse the condition to bytecodes again. */
2327 loc->cond_bytecode = parse_cond_to_aexpr (bl->address,
2331 /* If we have a NULL bytecode expression, it means something
2332 went wrong or we have a null condition expression. */
2333 if (!loc->cond_bytecode)
2335 null_condition_or_parse_error = 1;
2341 /* If any of these happened, it means we will have to evaluate the conditions
2342 for the location's address on gdb's side. It is no use keeping bytecodes
2343 for all the other duplicate locations, thus we free all of them here.
2345 This is so we have a finer control over which locations' conditions are
2346 being evaluated by GDB or the remote stub. */
2347 if (null_condition_or_parse_error)
2349 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (loc2p, locp, bl->address)
2352 if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner) && loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num)
2354 /* Only go as far as the first NULL bytecode is
2356 if (!loc->cond_bytecode)
2359 loc->cond_bytecode.reset ();
2364 /* No NULL conditions or failed bytecode generation. Build a condition list
2365 for this location's address. */
2366 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (loc2p, locp, bl->address)
2370 && is_breakpoint (loc->owner)
2371 && loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num
2372 && loc->owner->enable_state == bp_enabled
2375 /* Add the condition to the vector. This will be used later
2376 to send the conditions to the target. */
2377 bl->target_info.conditions.push_back (loc->cond_bytecode.get ());
2384 /* Parses a command described by string CMD into an agent expression
2385 bytecode suitable for evaluation by the bytecode interpreter.
2386 Return NULL if there was any error during parsing. */
2388 static agent_expr_up
2389 parse_cmd_to_aexpr (CORE_ADDR scope, char *cmd)
2391 struct cleanup *old_cleanups = 0;
2392 struct expression **argvec;
2393 const char *cmdrest;
2394 const char *format_start, *format_end;
2395 struct format_piece *fpieces;
2397 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
2404 if (*cmdrest == ',')
2406 cmdrest = skip_spaces_const (cmdrest);
2408 if (*cmdrest++ != '"')
2409 error (_("No format string following the location"));
2411 format_start = cmdrest;
2413 fpieces = parse_format_string (&cmdrest);
2415 old_cleanups = make_cleanup (free_format_pieces_cleanup, &fpieces);
2417 format_end = cmdrest;
2419 if (*cmdrest++ != '"')
2420 error (_("Bad format string, non-terminated '\"'."));
2422 cmdrest = skip_spaces_const (cmdrest);
2424 if (!(*cmdrest == ',' || *cmdrest == '\0'))
2425 error (_("Invalid argument syntax"));
2427 if (*cmdrest == ',')
2429 cmdrest = skip_spaces_const (cmdrest);
2431 /* For each argument, make an expression. */
2433 argvec = (struct expression **) alloca (strlen (cmd)
2434 * sizeof (struct expression *));
2437 while (*cmdrest != '\0')
2442 expression_up expr = parse_exp_1 (&cmd1, scope, block_for_pc (scope), 1);
2443 argvec[nargs++] = expr.release ();
2445 if (*cmdrest == ',')
2449 agent_expr_up aexpr;
2451 /* We don't want to stop processing, so catch any errors
2452 that may show up. */
2455 aexpr = gen_printf (scope, gdbarch, 0, 0,
2456 format_start, format_end - format_start,
2457 fpieces, nargs, argvec);
2459 CATCH (ex, RETURN_MASK_ERROR)
2461 /* If we got here, it means the command could not be parsed to a valid
2462 bytecode expression and thus can't be evaluated on the target's side.
2463 It's no use iterating through the other commands. */
2467 do_cleanups (old_cleanups);
2469 /* We have a valid agent expression, return it. */
2473 /* Based on location BL, create a list of breakpoint commands to be
2474 passed on to the target. If we have duplicated locations with
2475 different commands, we will add any such to the list. */
2478 build_target_command_list (struct bp_location *bl)
2480 struct bp_location **locp = NULL, **loc2p;
2481 int null_command_or_parse_error = 0;
2482 int modified = bl->needs_update;
2483 struct bp_location *loc;
2485 /* Clear commands left over from a previous insert. */
2486 bl->target_info.tcommands.clear ();
2488 if (!target_can_run_breakpoint_commands ())
2491 /* For now, limit to agent-style dprintf breakpoints. */
2492 if (dprintf_style != dprintf_style_agent)
2495 /* For now, if we have any duplicate location that isn't a dprintf,
2496 don't install the target-side commands, as that would make the
2497 breakpoint not be reported to the core, and we'd lose
2499 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (loc2p, locp, bl->address)
2502 if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner)
2503 && loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num
2504 && loc->owner->type != bp_dprintf)
2508 /* Do a first pass to check for locations with no assigned
2509 conditions or conditions that fail to parse to a valid agent expression
2510 bytecode. If any of these happen, then it's no use to send conditions
2511 to the target since this location will always trigger and generate a
2512 response back to GDB. */
2513 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (loc2p, locp, bl->address)
2516 if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner) && loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num)
2520 /* Re-parse the commands since something changed. In that
2521 case we already freed the command bytecodes (see
2522 force_breakpoint_reinsertion). We just
2523 need to parse the command to bytecodes again. */
2525 = parse_cmd_to_aexpr (bl->address,
2526 loc->owner->extra_string);
2529 /* If we have a NULL bytecode expression, it means something
2530 went wrong or we have a null command expression. */
2531 if (!loc->cmd_bytecode)
2533 null_command_or_parse_error = 1;
2539 /* If anything failed, then we're not doing target-side commands,
2541 if (null_command_or_parse_error)
2543 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (loc2p, locp, bl->address)
2546 if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner)
2547 && loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num)
2549 /* Only go as far as the first NULL bytecode is
2551 if (loc->cmd_bytecode == NULL)
2554 loc->cmd_bytecode.reset ();
2559 /* No NULL commands or failed bytecode generation. Build a command list
2560 for this location's address. */
2561 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (loc2p, locp, bl->address)
2564 if (loc->owner->extra_string
2565 && is_breakpoint (loc->owner)
2566 && loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num
2567 && loc->owner->enable_state == bp_enabled
2570 /* Add the command to the vector. This will be used later
2571 to send the commands to the target. */
2572 bl->target_info.tcommands.push_back (loc->cmd_bytecode.get ());
2576 bl->target_info.persist = 0;
2577 /* Maybe flag this location as persistent. */
2578 if (bl->owner->type == bp_dprintf && disconnected_dprintf)
2579 bl->target_info.persist = 1;
2582 /* Return the kind of breakpoint on address *ADDR. Get the kind
2583 of breakpoint according to ADDR except single-step breakpoint.
2584 Get the kind of single-step breakpoint according to the current
2588 breakpoint_kind (struct bp_location *bl, CORE_ADDR *addr)
2590 if (bl->owner->type == bp_single_step)
2592 struct thread_info *thr = find_thread_global_id (bl->owner->thread);
2593 struct regcache *regcache;
2595 regcache = get_thread_regcache (thr->ptid);
2597 return gdbarch_breakpoint_kind_from_current_state (bl->gdbarch,
2601 return gdbarch_breakpoint_kind_from_pc (bl->gdbarch, addr);
2604 /* Insert a low-level "breakpoint" of some type. BL is the breakpoint
2605 location. Any error messages are printed to TMP_ERROR_STREAM; and
2606 DISABLED_BREAKS, and HW_BREAKPOINT_ERROR are used to report problems.
2607 Returns 0 for success, 1 if the bp_location type is not supported or
2610 NOTE drow/2003-09-09: This routine could be broken down to an
2611 object-style method for each breakpoint or catchpoint type. */
2613 insert_bp_location (struct bp_location *bl,
2614 struct ui_file *tmp_error_stream,
2615 int *disabled_breaks,
2616 int *hw_breakpoint_error,
2617 int *hw_bp_error_explained_already)
2619 enum errors bp_err = GDB_NO_ERROR;
2620 const char *bp_err_message = NULL;
2622 if (!should_be_inserted (bl) || (bl->inserted && !bl->needs_update))
2625 /* Note we don't initialize bl->target_info, as that wipes out
2626 the breakpoint location's shadow_contents if the breakpoint
2627 is still inserted at that location. This in turn breaks
2628 target_read_memory which depends on these buffers when
2629 a memory read is requested at the breakpoint location:
2630 Once the target_info has been wiped, we fail to see that
2631 we have a breakpoint inserted at that address and thus
2632 read the breakpoint instead of returning the data saved in
2633 the breakpoint location's shadow contents. */
2634 bl->target_info.reqstd_address = bl->address;
2635 bl->target_info.placed_address_space = bl->pspace->aspace;
2636 bl->target_info.length = bl->length;
2638 /* When working with target-side conditions, we must pass all the conditions
2639 for the same breakpoint address down to the target since GDB will not
2640 insert those locations. With a list of breakpoint conditions, the target
2641 can decide when to stop and notify GDB. */
2643 if (is_breakpoint (bl->owner))
2645 build_target_condition_list (bl);
2646 build_target_command_list (bl);
2647 /* Reset the modification marker. */
2648 bl->needs_update = 0;
2651 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
2652 || bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2654 if (bl->owner->type != bp_hardware_breakpoint)
2656 /* If the explicitly specified breakpoint type
2657 is not hardware breakpoint, check the memory map to see
2658 if the breakpoint address is in read only memory or not.
2660 Two important cases are:
2661 - location type is not hardware breakpoint, memory
2662 is readonly. We change the type of the location to
2663 hardware breakpoint.
2664 - location type is hardware breakpoint, memory is
2665 read-write. This means we've previously made the
2666 location hardware one, but then the memory map changed,
2669 When breakpoints are removed, remove_breakpoints will use
2670 location types we've just set here, the only possible
2671 problem is that memory map has changed during running
2672 program, but it's not going to work anyway with current
2674 struct mem_region *mr
2675 = lookup_mem_region (bl->target_info.reqstd_address);
2679 if (automatic_hardware_breakpoints)
2681 enum bp_loc_type new_type;
2683 if (mr->attrib.mode != MEM_RW)
2684 new_type = bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint;
2686 new_type = bp_loc_software_breakpoint;
2688 if (new_type != bl->loc_type)
2690 static int said = 0;
2692 bl->loc_type = new_type;
2695 fprintf_filtered (gdb_stdout,
2696 _("Note: automatically using "
2697 "hardware breakpoints for "
2698 "read-only addresses.\n"));
2703 else if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
2704 && mr->attrib.mode != MEM_RW)
2706 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
2707 _("Cannot insert breakpoint %d.\n"
2708 "Cannot set software breakpoint "
2709 "at read-only address %s\n"),
2711 paddress (bl->gdbarch, bl->address));
2717 /* First check to see if we have to handle an overlay. */
2718 if (overlay_debugging == ovly_off
2719 || bl->section == NULL
2720 || !(section_is_overlay (bl->section)))
2722 /* No overlay handling: just set the breakpoint. */
2727 val = bl->owner->ops->insert_location (bl);
2729 bp_err = GENERIC_ERROR;
2731 CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ALL)
2734 bp_err_message = e.message;
2740 /* This breakpoint is in an overlay section.
2741 Shall we set a breakpoint at the LMA? */
2742 if (!overlay_events_enabled)
2744 /* Yes -- overlay event support is not active,
2745 so we must try to set a breakpoint at the LMA.
2746 This will not work for a hardware breakpoint. */
2747 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2748 warning (_("hardware breakpoint %d not supported in overlay!"),
2752 CORE_ADDR addr = overlay_unmapped_address (bl->address,
2754 /* Set a software (trap) breakpoint at the LMA. */
2755 bl->overlay_target_info = bl->target_info;
2756 bl->overlay_target_info.reqstd_address = addr;
2758 /* No overlay handling: just set the breakpoint. */
2763 bl->overlay_target_info.kind
2764 = breakpoint_kind (bl, &addr);
2765 bl->overlay_target_info.placed_address = addr;
2766 val = target_insert_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch,
2767 &bl->overlay_target_info);
2769 bp_err = GENERIC_ERROR;
2771 CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ALL)
2774 bp_err_message = e.message;
2778 if (bp_err != GDB_NO_ERROR)
2779 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
2780 "Overlay breakpoint %d "
2781 "failed: in ROM?\n",
2785 /* Shall we set a breakpoint at the VMA? */
2786 if (section_is_mapped (bl->section))
2788 /* Yes. This overlay section is mapped into memory. */
2793 val = bl->owner->ops->insert_location (bl);
2795 bp_err = GENERIC_ERROR;
2797 CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ALL)
2800 bp_err_message = e.message;
2806 /* No. This breakpoint will not be inserted.
2807 No error, but do not mark the bp as 'inserted'. */
2812 if (bp_err != GDB_NO_ERROR)
2814 /* Can't set the breakpoint. */
2816 /* In some cases, we might not be able to insert a
2817 breakpoint in a shared library that has already been
2818 removed, but we have not yet processed the shlib unload
2819 event. Unfortunately, some targets that implement
2820 breakpoint insertion themselves can't tell why the
2821 breakpoint insertion failed (e.g., the remote target
2822 doesn't define error codes), so we must treat generic
2823 errors as memory errors. */
2824 if ((bp_err == GENERIC_ERROR || bp_err == MEMORY_ERROR)
2825 && bl->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
2826 && (solib_name_from_address (bl->pspace, bl->address)
2827 || shared_objfile_contains_address_p (bl->pspace,
2830 /* See also: disable_breakpoints_in_shlibs. */
2831 bl->shlib_disabled = 1;
2832 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (bl->owner);
2833 if (!*disabled_breaks)
2835 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
2836 "Cannot insert breakpoint %d.\n",
2838 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
2839 "Temporarily disabling shared "
2840 "library breakpoints:\n");
2842 *disabled_breaks = 1;
2843 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
2844 "breakpoint #%d\n", bl->owner->number);
2849 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2851 *hw_breakpoint_error = 1;
2852 *hw_bp_error_explained_already = bp_err_message != NULL;
2853 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
2854 "Cannot insert hardware breakpoint %d%s",
2855 bl->owner->number, bp_err_message ? ":" : ".\n");
2856 if (bp_err_message != NULL)
2857 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream, "%s.\n", bp_err_message);
2861 if (bp_err_message == NULL)
2864 = memory_error_message (TARGET_XFER_E_IO,
2865 bl->gdbarch, bl->address);
2866 struct cleanup *old_chain = make_cleanup (xfree, message);
2868 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
2869 "Cannot insert breakpoint %d.\n"
2871 bl->owner->number, message);
2872 do_cleanups (old_chain);
2876 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
2877 "Cannot insert breakpoint %d: %s\n",
2892 else if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint
2893 /* NOTE drow/2003-09-08: This state only exists for removing
2894 watchpoints. It's not clear that it's necessary... */
2895 && bl->owner->disposition != disp_del_at_next_stop)
2899 gdb_assert (bl->owner->ops != NULL
2900 && bl->owner->ops->insert_location != NULL);
2902 val = bl->owner->ops->insert_location (bl);
2904 /* If trying to set a read-watchpoint, and it turns out it's not
2905 supported, try emulating one with an access watchpoint. */
2906 if (val == 1 && bl->watchpoint_type == hw_read)
2908 struct bp_location *loc, **loc_temp;
2910 /* But don't try to insert it, if there's already another
2911 hw_access location that would be considered a duplicate
2913 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, loc_temp)
2915 && loc->watchpoint_type == hw_access
2916 && watchpoint_locations_match (bl, loc))
2920 bl->target_info = loc->target_info;
2921 bl->watchpoint_type = hw_access;
2928 bl->watchpoint_type = hw_access;
2929 val = bl->owner->ops->insert_location (bl);
2932 /* Back to the original value. */
2933 bl->watchpoint_type = hw_read;
2937 bl->inserted = (val == 0);
2940 else if (bl->owner->type == bp_catchpoint)
2944 gdb_assert (bl->owner->ops != NULL
2945 && bl->owner->ops->insert_location != NULL);
2947 val = bl->owner->ops->insert_location (bl);
2950 bl->owner->enable_state = bp_disabled;
2954 Error inserting catchpoint %d: Your system does not support this type\n\
2955 of catchpoint."), bl->owner->number);
2957 warning (_("Error inserting catchpoint %d."), bl->owner->number);
2960 bl->inserted = (val == 0);
2962 /* We've already printed an error message if there was a problem
2963 inserting this catchpoint, and we've disabled the catchpoint,
2964 so just return success. */
2971 /* This function is called when program space PSPACE is about to be
2972 deleted. It takes care of updating breakpoints to not reference
2976 breakpoint_program_space_exit (struct program_space *pspace)
2978 struct breakpoint *b, *b_temp;
2979 struct bp_location *loc, **loc_temp;
2981 /* Remove any breakpoint that was set through this program space. */
2982 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_temp)
2984 if (b->pspace == pspace)
2985 delete_breakpoint (b);
2988 /* Breakpoints set through other program spaces could have locations
2989 bound to PSPACE as well. Remove those. */
2990 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, loc_temp)
2992 struct bp_location *tmp;
2994 if (loc->pspace == pspace)
2996 /* ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location has LOC->OWNER always non-NULL. */
2997 if (loc->owner->loc == loc)
2998 loc->owner->loc = loc->next;
3000 for (tmp = loc->owner->loc; tmp->next != NULL; tmp = tmp->next)
3001 if (tmp->next == loc)
3003 tmp->next = loc->next;
3009 /* Now update the global location list to permanently delete the
3010 removed locations above. */
3011 update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT);
3014 /* Make sure all breakpoints are inserted in inferior.
3015 Throws exception on any error.
3016 A breakpoint that is already inserted won't be inserted
3017 again, so calling this function twice is safe. */
3019 insert_breakpoints (void)
3021 struct breakpoint *bpt;
3023 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt)
3024 if (is_hardware_watchpoint (bpt))
3026 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bpt;
3028 update_watchpoint (w, 0 /* don't reparse. */);
3031 /* Updating watchpoints creates new locations, so update the global
3032 location list. Explicitly tell ugll to insert locations and
3033 ignore breakpoints_always_inserted_mode. */
3034 update_global_location_list (UGLL_INSERT);
3037 /* Invoke CALLBACK for each of bp_location. */
3040 iterate_over_bp_locations (walk_bp_location_callback callback)
3042 struct bp_location *loc, **loc_tmp;
3044 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, loc_tmp)
3046 callback (loc, NULL);
3050 /* This is used when we need to synch breakpoint conditions between GDB and the
3051 target. It is the case with deleting and disabling of breakpoints when using
3052 always-inserted mode. */
3055 update_inserted_breakpoint_locations (void)
3057 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
3060 int disabled_breaks = 0;
3061 int hw_breakpoint_error = 0;
3062 int hw_bp_details_reported = 0;
3064 struct ui_file *tmp_error_stream = mem_fileopen ();
3065 struct cleanup *cleanups = make_cleanup_ui_file_delete (tmp_error_stream);
3067 /* Explicitly mark the warning -- this will only be printed if
3068 there was an error. */
3069 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream, "Warning:\n");
3071 save_current_space_and_thread ();
3073 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
3075 /* We only want to update software breakpoints and hardware
3077 if (!is_breakpoint (bl->owner))
3080 /* We only want to update locations that are already inserted
3081 and need updating. This is to avoid unwanted insertion during
3082 deletion of breakpoints. */
3083 if (!bl->inserted || (bl->inserted && !bl->needs_update))
3086 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (bl->pspace);
3088 /* For targets that support global breakpoints, there's no need
3089 to select an inferior to insert breakpoint to. In fact, even
3090 if we aren't attached to any process yet, we should still
3091 insert breakpoints. */
3092 if (!gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ())
3093 && ptid_equal (inferior_ptid, null_ptid))
3096 val = insert_bp_location (bl, tmp_error_stream, &disabled_breaks,
3097 &hw_breakpoint_error, &hw_bp_details_reported);
3104 target_terminal_ours_for_output ();
3105 error_stream (tmp_error_stream);
3108 do_cleanups (cleanups);
3111 /* Used when starting or continuing the program. */
3114 insert_breakpoint_locations (void)
3116 struct breakpoint *bpt;
3117 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
3120 int disabled_breaks = 0;
3121 int hw_breakpoint_error = 0;
3122 int hw_bp_error_explained_already = 0;
3124 struct ui_file *tmp_error_stream = mem_fileopen ();
3125 struct cleanup *cleanups = make_cleanup_ui_file_delete (tmp_error_stream);
3127 /* Explicitly mark the warning -- this will only be printed if
3128 there was an error. */
3129 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream, "Warning:\n");
3131 save_current_space_and_thread ();
3133 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
3135 if (!should_be_inserted (bl) || (bl->inserted && !bl->needs_update))
3138 /* There is no point inserting thread-specific breakpoints if
3139 the thread no longer exists. ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location
3140 has BL->OWNER always non-NULL. */
3141 if (bl->owner->thread != -1
3142 && !valid_global_thread_id (bl->owner->thread))
3145 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (bl->pspace);
3147 /* For targets that support global breakpoints, there's no need
3148 to select an inferior to insert breakpoint to. In fact, even
3149 if we aren't attached to any process yet, we should still
3150 insert breakpoints. */
3151 if (!gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ())
3152 && ptid_equal (inferior_ptid, null_ptid))
3155 val = insert_bp_location (bl, tmp_error_stream, &disabled_breaks,
3156 &hw_breakpoint_error, &hw_bp_error_explained_already);
3161 /* If we failed to insert all locations of a watchpoint, remove
3162 them, as half-inserted watchpoint is of limited use. */
3163 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt)
3165 int some_failed = 0;
3166 struct bp_location *loc;
3168 if (!is_hardware_watchpoint (bpt))
3171 if (!breakpoint_enabled (bpt))
3174 if (bpt->disposition == disp_del_at_next_stop)
3177 for (loc = bpt->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
3178 if (!loc->inserted && should_be_inserted (loc))
3185 for (loc = bpt->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
3187 remove_breakpoint (loc);
3189 hw_breakpoint_error = 1;
3190 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
3191 "Could not insert hardware watchpoint %d.\n",
3199 /* If a hardware breakpoint or watchpoint was inserted, add a
3200 message about possibly exhausted resources. */
3201 if (hw_breakpoint_error && !hw_bp_error_explained_already)
3203 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
3204 "Could not insert hardware breakpoints:\n\
3205 You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints/watchpoints.\n");
3207 target_terminal_ours_for_output ();
3208 error_stream (tmp_error_stream);
3211 do_cleanups (cleanups);
3214 /* Used when the program stops.
3215 Returns zero if successful, or non-zero if there was a problem
3216 removing a breakpoint location. */
3219 remove_breakpoints (void)
3221 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
3224 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
3226 if (bl->inserted && !is_tracepoint (bl->owner))
3227 val |= remove_breakpoint (bl);
3232 /* When a thread exits, remove breakpoints that are related to
3236 remove_threaded_breakpoints (struct thread_info *tp, int silent)
3238 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
3240 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
3242 if (b->thread == tp->global_num && user_breakpoint_p (b))
3244 b->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
3246 printf_filtered (_("\
3247 Thread-specific breakpoint %d deleted - thread %s no longer in the thread list.\n"),
3248 b->number, print_thread_id (tp));
3250 /* Hide it from the user. */
3256 /* Remove breakpoints of process PID. */
3259 remove_breakpoints_pid (int pid)
3261 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
3263 struct inferior *inf = find_inferior_pid (pid);
3265 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
3267 if (bl->pspace != inf->pspace)
3270 if (bl->inserted && !bl->target_info.persist)
3272 val = remove_breakpoint (bl);
3281 reattach_breakpoints (int pid)
3283 struct cleanup *old_chain;
3284 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
3286 struct ui_file *tmp_error_stream;
3287 int dummy1 = 0, dummy2 = 0, dummy3 = 0;
3288 struct inferior *inf;
3289 struct thread_info *tp;
3291 tp = any_live_thread_of_process (pid);
3295 inf = find_inferior_pid (pid);
3296 old_chain = save_inferior_ptid ();
3298 inferior_ptid = tp->ptid;
3300 tmp_error_stream = mem_fileopen ();
3301 make_cleanup_ui_file_delete (tmp_error_stream);
3303 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
3305 if (bl->pspace != inf->pspace)
3311 val = insert_bp_location (bl, tmp_error_stream, &dummy1, &dummy2, &dummy3);
3314 do_cleanups (old_chain);
3319 do_cleanups (old_chain);
3323 static int internal_breakpoint_number = -1;
3325 /* Set the breakpoint number of B, depending on the value of INTERNAL.
3326 If INTERNAL is non-zero, the breakpoint number will be populated
3327 from internal_breakpoint_number and that variable decremented.
3328 Otherwise the breakpoint number will be populated from
3329 breakpoint_count and that value incremented. Internal breakpoints
3330 do not set the internal var bpnum. */
3332 set_breakpoint_number (int internal, struct breakpoint *b)
3335 b->number = internal_breakpoint_number--;
3338 set_breakpoint_count (breakpoint_count + 1);
3339 b->number = breakpoint_count;
3343 static struct breakpoint *
3344 create_internal_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
3345 CORE_ADDR address, enum bptype type,
3346 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
3348 struct symtab_and_line sal;
3349 struct breakpoint *b;
3351 init_sal (&sal); /* Initialize to zeroes. */
3354 sal.section = find_pc_overlay (sal.pc);
3355 sal.pspace = current_program_space;
3357 b = set_raw_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, type, ops);
3358 b->number = internal_breakpoint_number--;
3359 b->disposition = disp_donttouch;
3364 static const char *const longjmp_names[] =
3366 "longjmp", "_longjmp", "siglongjmp", "_siglongjmp"
3368 #define NUM_LONGJMP_NAMES ARRAY_SIZE(longjmp_names)
3370 /* Per-objfile data private to breakpoint.c. */
3371 struct breakpoint_objfile_data
3373 /* Minimal symbol for "_ovly_debug_event" (if any). */
3374 struct bound_minimal_symbol overlay_msym;
3376 /* Minimal symbol(s) for "longjmp", "siglongjmp", etc. (if any). */
3377 struct bound_minimal_symbol longjmp_msym[NUM_LONGJMP_NAMES];
3379 /* True if we have looked for longjmp probes. */
3380 int longjmp_searched;
3382 /* SystemTap probe points for longjmp (if any). */
3383 VEC (probe_p) *longjmp_probes;
3385 /* Minimal symbol for "std::terminate()" (if any). */
3386 struct bound_minimal_symbol terminate_msym;
3388 /* Minimal symbol for "_Unwind_DebugHook" (if any). */
3389 struct bound_minimal_symbol exception_msym;
3391 /* True if we have looked for exception probes. */
3392 int exception_searched;
3394 /* SystemTap probe points for unwinding (if any). */
3395 VEC (probe_p) *exception_probes;
3398 static const struct objfile_data *breakpoint_objfile_key;
3400 /* Minimal symbol not found sentinel. */
3401 static struct minimal_symbol msym_not_found;
3403 /* Returns TRUE if MSYM point to the "not found" sentinel. */
3406 msym_not_found_p (const struct minimal_symbol *msym)
3408 return msym == &msym_not_found;
3411 /* Return per-objfile data needed by breakpoint.c.
3412 Allocate the data if necessary. */
3414 static struct breakpoint_objfile_data *
3415 get_breakpoint_objfile_data (struct objfile *objfile)
3417 struct breakpoint_objfile_data *bp_objfile_data;
3419 bp_objfile_data = ((struct breakpoint_objfile_data *)
3420 objfile_data (objfile, breakpoint_objfile_key));
3421 if (bp_objfile_data == NULL)
3424 XOBNEW (&objfile->objfile_obstack, struct breakpoint_objfile_data);
3426 memset (bp_objfile_data, 0, sizeof (*bp_objfile_data));
3427 set_objfile_data (objfile, breakpoint_objfile_key, bp_objfile_data);
3429 return bp_objfile_data;
3433 free_breakpoint_probes (struct objfile *obj, void *data)
3435 struct breakpoint_objfile_data *bp_objfile_data
3436 = (struct breakpoint_objfile_data *) data;
3438 VEC_free (probe_p, bp_objfile_data->longjmp_probes);
3439 VEC_free (probe_p, bp_objfile_data->exception_probes);
3443 create_overlay_event_breakpoint (void)
3445 struct objfile *objfile;
3446 const char *const func_name = "_ovly_debug_event";
3448 ALL_OBJFILES (objfile)
3450 struct breakpoint *b;
3451 struct breakpoint_objfile_data *bp_objfile_data;
3453 struct explicit_location explicit_loc;
3455 bp_objfile_data = get_breakpoint_objfile_data (objfile);
3457 if (msym_not_found_p (bp_objfile_data->overlay_msym.minsym))
3460 if (bp_objfile_data->overlay_msym.minsym == NULL)
3462 struct bound_minimal_symbol m;
3464 m = lookup_minimal_symbol_text (func_name, objfile);
3465 if (m.minsym == NULL)
3467 /* Avoid future lookups in this objfile. */
3468 bp_objfile_data->overlay_msym.minsym = &msym_not_found;
3471 bp_objfile_data->overlay_msym = m;
3474 addr = BMSYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (bp_objfile_data->overlay_msym);
3475 b = create_internal_breakpoint (get_objfile_arch (objfile), addr,
3477 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
3478 initialize_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
3479 explicit_loc.function_name = ASTRDUP (func_name);
3480 b->location = new_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
3482 if (overlay_debugging == ovly_auto)
3484 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
3485 overlay_events_enabled = 1;
3489 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
3490 overlay_events_enabled = 0;
3496 create_longjmp_master_breakpoint (void)
3498 struct program_space *pspace;
3499 struct cleanup *old_chain;
3501 old_chain = save_current_program_space ();
3503 ALL_PSPACES (pspace)
3505 struct objfile *objfile;
3507 set_current_program_space (pspace);
3509 ALL_OBJFILES (objfile)
3512 struct gdbarch *gdbarch;
3513 struct breakpoint_objfile_data *bp_objfile_data;
3515 gdbarch = get_objfile_arch (objfile);
3517 bp_objfile_data = get_breakpoint_objfile_data (objfile);
3519 if (!bp_objfile_data->longjmp_searched)
3523 ret = find_probes_in_objfile (objfile, "libc", "longjmp");
3526 /* We are only interested in checking one element. */
3527 struct probe *p = VEC_index (probe_p, ret, 0);
3529 if (!can_evaluate_probe_arguments (p))
3531 /* We cannot use the probe interface here, because it does
3532 not know how to evaluate arguments. */
3533 VEC_free (probe_p, ret);
3537 bp_objfile_data->longjmp_probes = ret;
3538 bp_objfile_data->longjmp_searched = 1;
3541 if (bp_objfile_data->longjmp_probes != NULL)
3544 struct probe *probe;
3545 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_objfile_arch (objfile);
3548 VEC_iterate (probe_p,
3549 bp_objfile_data->longjmp_probes,
3553 struct breakpoint *b;
3555 b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch,
3556 get_probe_address (probe,
3559 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
3561 = new_probe_location ("-probe-stap libc:longjmp");
3562 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
3568 if (!gdbarch_get_longjmp_target_p (gdbarch))
3571 for (i = 0; i < NUM_LONGJMP_NAMES; i++)
3573 struct breakpoint *b;
3574 const char *func_name;
3576 struct explicit_location explicit_loc;
3578 if (msym_not_found_p (bp_objfile_data->longjmp_msym[i].minsym))
3581 func_name = longjmp_names[i];
3582 if (bp_objfile_data->longjmp_msym[i].minsym == NULL)
3584 struct bound_minimal_symbol m;
3586 m = lookup_minimal_symbol_text (func_name, objfile);
3587 if (m.minsym == NULL)
3589 /* Prevent future lookups in this objfile. */
3590 bp_objfile_data->longjmp_msym[i].minsym = &msym_not_found;
3593 bp_objfile_data->longjmp_msym[i] = m;
3596 addr = BMSYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (bp_objfile_data->longjmp_msym[i]);
3597 b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, addr, bp_longjmp_master,
3598 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
3599 initialize_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
3600 explicit_loc.function_name = ASTRDUP (func_name);
3601 b->location = new_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
3602 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
3607 do_cleanups (old_chain);
3610 /* Create a master std::terminate breakpoint. */
3612 create_std_terminate_master_breakpoint (void)
3614 struct program_space *pspace;
3615 struct cleanup *old_chain;
3616 const char *const func_name = "std::terminate()";
3618 old_chain = save_current_program_space ();
3620 ALL_PSPACES (pspace)
3622 struct objfile *objfile;
3625 set_current_program_space (pspace);
3627 ALL_OBJFILES (objfile)
3629 struct breakpoint *b;
3630 struct breakpoint_objfile_data *bp_objfile_data;
3631 struct explicit_location explicit_loc;
3633 bp_objfile_data = get_breakpoint_objfile_data (objfile);
3635 if (msym_not_found_p (bp_objfile_data->terminate_msym.minsym))
3638 if (bp_objfile_data->terminate_msym.minsym == NULL)
3640 struct bound_minimal_symbol m;
3642 m = lookup_minimal_symbol (func_name, NULL, objfile);
3643 if (m.minsym == NULL || (MSYMBOL_TYPE (m.minsym) != mst_text
3644 && MSYMBOL_TYPE (m.minsym) != mst_file_text))
3646 /* Prevent future lookups in this objfile. */
3647 bp_objfile_data->terminate_msym.minsym = &msym_not_found;
3650 bp_objfile_data->terminate_msym = m;
3653 addr = BMSYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (bp_objfile_data->terminate_msym);
3654 b = create_internal_breakpoint (get_objfile_arch (objfile), addr,
3655 bp_std_terminate_master,
3656 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
3657 initialize_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
3658 explicit_loc.function_name = ASTRDUP (func_name);
3659 b->location = new_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
3660 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
3664 do_cleanups (old_chain);
3667 /* Install a master breakpoint on the unwinder's debug hook. */
3670 create_exception_master_breakpoint (void)
3672 struct objfile *objfile;
3673 const char *const func_name = "_Unwind_DebugHook";
3675 ALL_OBJFILES (objfile)
3677 struct breakpoint *b;
3678 struct gdbarch *gdbarch;
3679 struct breakpoint_objfile_data *bp_objfile_data;
3681 struct explicit_location explicit_loc;
3683 bp_objfile_data = get_breakpoint_objfile_data (objfile);
3685 /* We prefer the SystemTap probe point if it exists. */
3686 if (!bp_objfile_data->exception_searched)
3690 ret = find_probes_in_objfile (objfile, "libgcc", "unwind");
3694 /* We are only interested in checking one element. */
3695 struct probe *p = VEC_index (probe_p, ret, 0);
3697 if (!can_evaluate_probe_arguments (p))
3699 /* We cannot use the probe interface here, because it does
3700 not know how to evaluate arguments. */
3701 VEC_free (probe_p, ret);
3705 bp_objfile_data->exception_probes = ret;
3706 bp_objfile_data->exception_searched = 1;
3709 if (bp_objfile_data->exception_probes != NULL)
3711 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_objfile_arch (objfile);
3713 struct probe *probe;
3716 VEC_iterate (probe_p,
3717 bp_objfile_data->exception_probes,
3721 struct breakpoint *b;
3723 b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch,
3724 get_probe_address (probe,
3726 bp_exception_master,
3727 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
3729 = new_probe_location ("-probe-stap libgcc:unwind");
3730 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
3736 /* Otherwise, try the hook function. */
3738 if (msym_not_found_p (bp_objfile_data->exception_msym.minsym))
3741 gdbarch = get_objfile_arch (objfile);
3743 if (bp_objfile_data->exception_msym.minsym == NULL)
3745 struct bound_minimal_symbol debug_hook;
3747 debug_hook = lookup_minimal_symbol (func_name, NULL, objfile);
3748 if (debug_hook.minsym == NULL)
3750 bp_objfile_data->exception_msym.minsym = &msym_not_found;
3754 bp_objfile_data->exception_msym = debug_hook;
3757 addr = BMSYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (bp_objfile_data->exception_msym);
3758 addr = gdbarch_convert_from_func_ptr_addr (gdbarch, addr,
3760 b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, addr, bp_exception_master,
3761 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
3762 initialize_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
3763 explicit_loc.function_name = ASTRDUP (func_name);
3764 b->location = new_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
3765 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
3769 /* Does B have a location spec? */
3772 breakpoint_event_location_empty_p (const struct breakpoint *b)
3774 return b->location != NULL && event_location_empty_p (b->location);
3778 update_breakpoints_after_exec (void)
3780 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
3781 struct bp_location *bploc, **bplocp_tmp;
3783 /* We're about to delete breakpoints from GDB's lists. If the
3784 INSERTED flag is true, GDB will try to lift the breakpoints by
3785 writing the breakpoints' "shadow contents" back into memory. The
3786 "shadow contents" are NOT valid after an exec, so GDB should not
3787 do that. Instead, the target is responsible from marking
3788 breakpoints out as soon as it detects an exec. We don't do that
3789 here instead, because there may be other attempts to delete
3790 breakpoints after detecting an exec and before reaching here. */
3791 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bploc, bplocp_tmp)
3792 if (bploc->pspace == current_program_space)
3793 gdb_assert (!bploc->inserted);
3795 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
3797 if (b->pspace != current_program_space)
3800 /* Solib breakpoints must be explicitly reset after an exec(). */
3801 if (b->type == bp_shlib_event)
3803 delete_breakpoint (b);
3807 /* JIT breakpoints must be explicitly reset after an exec(). */
3808 if (b->type == bp_jit_event)
3810 delete_breakpoint (b);
3814 /* Thread event breakpoints must be set anew after an exec(),
3815 as must overlay event and longjmp master breakpoints. */
3816 if (b->type == bp_thread_event || b->type == bp_overlay_event
3817 || b->type == bp_longjmp_master || b->type == bp_std_terminate_master
3818 || b->type == bp_exception_master)
3820 delete_breakpoint (b);
3824 /* Step-resume breakpoints are meaningless after an exec(). */
3825 if (b->type == bp_step_resume || b->type == bp_hp_step_resume)
3827 delete_breakpoint (b);
3831 /* Just like single-step breakpoints. */
3832 if (b->type == bp_single_step)
3834 delete_breakpoint (b);
3838 /* Longjmp and longjmp-resume breakpoints are also meaningless
3840 if (b->type == bp_longjmp || b->type == bp_longjmp_resume
3841 || b->type == bp_longjmp_call_dummy
3842 || b->type == bp_exception || b->type == bp_exception_resume)
3844 delete_breakpoint (b);
3848 if (b->type == bp_catchpoint)
3850 /* For now, none of the bp_catchpoint breakpoints need to
3851 do anything at this point. In the future, if some of
3852 the catchpoints need to something, we will need to add
3853 a new method, and call this method from here. */
3857 /* bp_finish is a special case. The only way we ought to be able
3858 to see one of these when an exec() has happened, is if the user
3859 caught a vfork, and then said "finish". Ordinarily a finish just
3860 carries them to the call-site of the current callee, by setting
3861 a temporary bp there and resuming. But in this case, the finish
3862 will carry them entirely through the vfork & exec.
3864 We don't want to allow a bp_finish to remain inserted now. But
3865 we can't safely delete it, 'cause finish_command has a handle to
3866 the bp on a bpstat, and will later want to delete it. There's a
3867 chance (and I've seen it happen) that if we delete the bp_finish
3868 here, that its storage will get reused by the time finish_command
3869 gets 'round to deleting the "use to be a bp_finish" breakpoint.
3870 We really must allow finish_command to delete a bp_finish.
3872 In the absence of a general solution for the "how do we know
3873 it's safe to delete something others may have handles to?"
3874 problem, what we'll do here is just uninsert the bp_finish, and
3875 let finish_command delete it.
3877 (We know the bp_finish is "doomed" in the sense that it's
3878 momentary, and will be deleted as soon as finish_command sees
3879 the inferior stopped. So it doesn't matter that the bp's
3880 address is probably bogus in the new a.out, unlike e.g., the
3881 solib breakpoints.) */
3883 if (b->type == bp_finish)
3888 /* Without a symbolic address, we have little hope of the
3889 pre-exec() address meaning the same thing in the post-exec()
3891 if (breakpoint_event_location_empty_p (b))
3893 delete_breakpoint (b);
3900 detach_breakpoints (ptid_t ptid)
3902 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
3904 struct cleanup *old_chain = save_inferior_ptid ();
3905 struct inferior *inf = current_inferior ();
3907 if (ptid_get_pid (ptid) == ptid_get_pid (inferior_ptid))
3908 error (_("Cannot detach breakpoints of inferior_ptid"));
3910 /* Set inferior_ptid; remove_breakpoint_1 uses this global. */
3911 inferior_ptid = ptid;
3912 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
3914 if (bl->pspace != inf->pspace)
3917 /* This function must physically remove breakpoints locations
3918 from the specified ptid, without modifying the breakpoint
3919 package's state. Locations of type bp_loc_other are only
3920 maintained at GDB side. So, there is no need to remove
3921 these bp_loc_other locations. Moreover, removing these
3922 would modify the breakpoint package's state. */
3923 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_other)
3927 val |= remove_breakpoint_1 (bl, DETACH_BREAKPOINT);
3930 do_cleanups (old_chain);
3934 /* Remove the breakpoint location BL from the current address space.
3935 Note that this is used to detach breakpoints from a child fork.
3936 When we get here, the child isn't in the inferior list, and neither
3937 do we have objects to represent its address space --- we should
3938 *not* look at bl->pspace->aspace here. */
3941 remove_breakpoint_1 (struct bp_location *bl, enum remove_bp_reason reason)
3945 /* BL is never in moribund_locations by our callers. */
3946 gdb_assert (bl->owner != NULL);
3948 /* The type of none suggests that owner is actually deleted.
3949 This should not ever happen. */
3950 gdb_assert (bl->owner->type != bp_none);
3952 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
3953 || bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
3955 /* "Normal" instruction breakpoint: either the standard
3956 trap-instruction bp (bp_breakpoint), or a
3957 bp_hardware_breakpoint. */
3959 /* First check to see if we have to handle an overlay. */
3960 if (overlay_debugging == ovly_off
3961 || bl->section == NULL
3962 || !(section_is_overlay (bl->section)))
3964 /* No overlay handling: just remove the breakpoint. */
3966 /* If we're trying to uninsert a memory breakpoint that we
3967 know is set in a dynamic object that is marked
3968 shlib_disabled, then either the dynamic object was
3969 removed with "remove-symbol-file" or with
3970 "nosharedlibrary". In the former case, we don't know
3971 whether another dynamic object might have loaded over the
3972 breakpoint's address -- the user might well let us know
3973 about it next with add-symbol-file (the whole point of
3974 add-symbol-file is letting the user manually maintain a
3975 list of dynamically loaded objects). If we have the
3976 breakpoint's shadow memory, that is, this is a software
3977 breakpoint managed by GDB, check whether the breakpoint
3978 is still inserted in memory, to avoid overwriting wrong
3979 code with stale saved shadow contents. Note that HW
3980 breakpoints don't have shadow memory, as they're
3981 implemented using a mechanism that is not dependent on
3982 being able to modify the target's memory, and as such
3983 they should always be removed. */
3984 if (bl->shlib_disabled
3985 && bl->target_info.shadow_len != 0
3986 && !memory_validate_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch, &bl->target_info))
3989 val = bl->owner->ops->remove_location (bl, reason);
3993 /* This breakpoint is in an overlay section.
3994 Did we set a breakpoint at the LMA? */
3995 if (!overlay_events_enabled)
3997 /* Yes -- overlay event support is not active, so we
3998 should have set a breakpoint at the LMA. Remove it.
4000 /* Ignore any failures: if the LMA is in ROM, we will
4001 have already warned when we failed to insert it. */
4002 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
4003 target_remove_hw_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch,
4004 &bl->overlay_target_info);
4006 target_remove_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch,
4007 &bl->overlay_target_info,
4010 /* Did we set a breakpoint at the VMA?
4011 If so, we will have marked the breakpoint 'inserted'. */
4014 /* Yes -- remove it. Previously we did not bother to
4015 remove the breakpoint if the section had been
4016 unmapped, but let's not rely on that being safe. We
4017 don't know what the overlay manager might do. */
4019 /* However, we should remove *software* breakpoints only
4020 if the section is still mapped, or else we overwrite
4021 wrong code with the saved shadow contents. */
4022 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint
4023 || section_is_mapped (bl->section))
4024 val = bl->owner->ops->remove_location (bl, reason);
4030 /* No -- not inserted, so no need to remove. No error. */
4035 /* In some cases, we might not be able to remove a breakpoint in
4036 a shared library that has already been removed, but we have
4037 not yet processed the shlib unload event. Similarly for an
4038 unloaded add-symbol-file object - the user might not yet have
4039 had the chance to remove-symbol-file it. shlib_disabled will
4040 be set if the library/object has already been removed, but
4041 the breakpoint hasn't been uninserted yet, e.g., after
4042 "nosharedlibrary" or "remove-symbol-file" with breakpoints
4043 always-inserted mode. */
4045 && (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
4046 && (bl->shlib_disabled
4047 || solib_name_from_address (bl->pspace, bl->address)
4048 || shared_objfile_contains_address_p (bl->pspace,
4054 bl->inserted = (reason == DETACH_BREAKPOINT);
4056 else if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint)
4058 gdb_assert (bl->owner->ops != NULL
4059 && bl->owner->ops->remove_location != NULL);
4061 bl->inserted = (reason == DETACH_BREAKPOINT);
4062 bl->owner->ops->remove_location (bl, reason);
4064 /* Failure to remove any of the hardware watchpoints comes here. */
4065 if (reason == REMOVE_BREAKPOINT && bl->inserted)
4066 warning (_("Could not remove hardware watchpoint %d."),
4069 else if (bl->owner->type == bp_catchpoint
4070 && breakpoint_enabled (bl->owner)
4073 gdb_assert (bl->owner->ops != NULL
4074 && bl->owner->ops->remove_location != NULL);
4076 val = bl->owner->ops->remove_location (bl, reason);
4080 bl->inserted = (reason == DETACH_BREAKPOINT);
4087 remove_breakpoint (struct bp_location *bl)
4090 struct cleanup *old_chain;
4092 /* BL is never in moribund_locations by our callers. */
4093 gdb_assert (bl->owner != NULL);
4095 /* The type of none suggests that owner is actually deleted.
4096 This should not ever happen. */
4097 gdb_assert (bl->owner->type != bp_none);
4099 old_chain = save_current_space_and_thread ();
4101 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (bl->pspace);
4103 ret = remove_breakpoint_1 (bl, REMOVE_BREAKPOINT);
4105 do_cleanups (old_chain);
4109 /* Clear the "inserted" flag in all breakpoints. */
4112 mark_breakpoints_out (void)
4114 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
4116 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
4117 if (bl->pspace == current_program_space)
4121 /* Clear the "inserted" flag in all breakpoints and delete any
4122 breakpoints which should go away between runs of the program.
4124 Plus other such housekeeping that has to be done for breakpoints
4127 Note: this function gets called at the end of a run (by
4128 generic_mourn_inferior) and when a run begins (by
4129 init_wait_for_inferior). */
4134 breakpoint_init_inferior (enum inf_context context)
4136 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
4137 struct bp_location *bl;
4139 struct program_space *pspace = current_program_space;
4141 /* If breakpoint locations are shared across processes, then there's
4143 if (gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ()))
4146 mark_breakpoints_out ();
4148 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
4150 if (b->loc && b->loc->pspace != pspace)
4156 case bp_longjmp_call_dummy:
4158 /* If the call dummy breakpoint is at the entry point it will
4159 cause problems when the inferior is rerun, so we better get
4162 case bp_watchpoint_scope:
4164 /* Also get rid of scope breakpoints. */
4166 case bp_shlib_event:
4168 /* Also remove solib event breakpoints. Their addresses may
4169 have changed since the last time we ran the program.
4170 Actually we may now be debugging against different target;
4171 and so the solib backend that installed this breakpoint may
4172 not be used in by the target. E.g.,
4174 (gdb) file prog-linux
4175 (gdb) run # native linux target
4178 (gdb) file prog-win.exe
4179 (gdb) tar rem :9999 # remote Windows gdbserver.
4182 case bp_step_resume:
4184 /* Also remove step-resume breakpoints. */
4186 case bp_single_step:
4188 /* Also remove single-step breakpoints. */
4190 delete_breakpoint (b);
4194 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
4195 case bp_read_watchpoint:
4196 case bp_access_watchpoint:
4198 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
4200 /* Likewise for watchpoints on local expressions. */
4201 if (w->exp_valid_block != NULL)
4202 delete_breakpoint (b);
4205 /* Get rid of existing locations, which are no longer
4206 valid. New ones will be created in
4207 update_watchpoint, when the inferior is restarted.
4208 The next update_global_location_list call will
4209 garbage collect them. */
4212 if (context == inf_starting)
4214 /* Reset val field to force reread of starting value in
4215 insert_breakpoints. */
4217 value_free (w->val);
4229 /* Get rid of the moribund locations. */
4230 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (bp_location_p, moribund_locations, ix, bl); ++ix)
4231 decref_bp_location (&bl);
4232 VEC_free (bp_location_p, moribund_locations);
4235 /* These functions concern about actual breakpoints inserted in the
4236 target --- to e.g. check if we need to do decr_pc adjustment or if
4237 we need to hop over the bkpt --- so we check for address space
4238 match, not program space. */
4240 /* breakpoint_here_p (PC) returns non-zero if an enabled breakpoint
4241 exists at PC. It returns ordinary_breakpoint_here if it's an
4242 ordinary breakpoint, or permanent_breakpoint_here if it's a
4243 permanent breakpoint.
4244 - When continuing from a location with an ordinary breakpoint, we
4245 actually single step once before calling insert_breakpoints.
4246 - When continuing from a location with a permanent breakpoint, we
4247 need to use the `SKIP_PERMANENT_BREAKPOINT' macro, provided by
4248 the target, to advance the PC past the breakpoint. */
4250 enum breakpoint_here
4251 breakpoint_here_p (struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
4253 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
4254 int any_breakpoint_here = 0;
4256 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
4258 if (bl->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint
4259 && bl->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
4262 /* ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location has BL->OWNER always non-NULL. */
4263 if ((breakpoint_enabled (bl->owner)
4265 && breakpoint_location_address_match (bl, aspace, pc))
4267 if (overlay_debugging
4268 && section_is_overlay (bl->section)
4269 && !section_is_mapped (bl->section))
4270 continue; /* unmapped overlay -- can't be a match */
4271 else if (bl->permanent)
4272 return permanent_breakpoint_here;
4274 any_breakpoint_here = 1;
4278 return any_breakpoint_here ? ordinary_breakpoint_here : no_breakpoint_here;
4281 /* See breakpoint.h. */
4284 breakpoint_in_range_p (struct address_space *aspace,
4285 CORE_ADDR addr, ULONGEST len)
4287 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
4289 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
4291 if (bl->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint
4292 && bl->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
4295 if ((breakpoint_enabled (bl->owner)
4297 && breakpoint_location_address_range_overlap (bl, aspace,
4300 if (overlay_debugging
4301 && section_is_overlay (bl->section)
4302 && !section_is_mapped (bl->section))
4304 /* Unmapped overlay -- can't be a match. */
4315 /* Return true if there's a moribund breakpoint at PC. */
4318 moribund_breakpoint_here_p (struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
4320 struct bp_location *loc;
4323 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (bp_location_p, moribund_locations, ix, loc); ++ix)
4324 if (breakpoint_location_address_match (loc, aspace, pc))
4330 /* Returns non-zero iff BL is inserted at PC, in address space
4334 bp_location_inserted_here_p (struct bp_location *bl,
4335 struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
4338 && breakpoint_address_match (bl->pspace->aspace, bl->address,
4341 if (overlay_debugging
4342 && section_is_overlay (bl->section)
4343 && !section_is_mapped (bl->section))
4344 return 0; /* unmapped overlay -- can't be a match */
4351 /* Returns non-zero iff there's a breakpoint inserted at PC. */
4354 breakpoint_inserted_here_p (struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
4356 struct bp_location **blp, **blp_tmp = NULL;
4358 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (blp, blp_tmp, pc)
4360 struct bp_location *bl = *blp;
4362 if (bl->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint
4363 && bl->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
4366 if (bp_location_inserted_here_p (bl, aspace, pc))
4372 /* This function returns non-zero iff there is a software breakpoint
4376 software_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (struct address_space *aspace,
4379 struct bp_location **blp, **blp_tmp = NULL;
4381 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (blp, blp_tmp, pc)
4383 struct bp_location *bl = *blp;
4385 if (bl->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint)
4388 if (bp_location_inserted_here_p (bl, aspace, pc))
4395 /* See breakpoint.h. */
4398 hardware_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (struct address_space *aspace,
4401 struct bp_location **blp, **blp_tmp = NULL;
4403 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (blp, blp_tmp, pc)
4405 struct bp_location *bl = *blp;
4407 if (bl->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
4410 if (bp_location_inserted_here_p (bl, aspace, pc))
4418 hardware_watchpoint_inserted_in_range (struct address_space *aspace,
4419 CORE_ADDR addr, ULONGEST len)
4421 struct breakpoint *bpt;
4423 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt)
4425 struct bp_location *loc;
4427 if (bpt->type != bp_hardware_watchpoint
4428 && bpt->type != bp_access_watchpoint)
4431 if (!breakpoint_enabled (bpt))
4434 for (loc = bpt->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
4435 if (loc->pspace->aspace == aspace && loc->inserted)
4439 /* Check for intersection. */
4440 l = std::max<CORE_ADDR> (loc->address, addr);
4441 h = std::min<CORE_ADDR> (loc->address + loc->length, addr + len);
4450 /* bpstat stuff. External routines' interfaces are documented
4454 is_catchpoint (struct breakpoint *ep)
4456 return (ep->type == bp_catchpoint);
4459 /* Frees any storage that is part of a bpstat. Does not walk the
4463 bpstat_free (bpstat bs)
4465 if (bs->old_val != NULL)
4466 value_free (bs->old_val);
4467 decref_counted_command_line (&bs->commands);
4468 decref_bp_location (&bs->bp_location_at);
4472 /* Clear a bpstat so that it says we are not at any breakpoint.
4473 Also free any storage that is part of a bpstat. */
4476 bpstat_clear (bpstat *bsp)
4493 /* Return a copy of a bpstat. Like "bs1 = bs2" but all storage that
4494 is part of the bpstat is copied as well. */
4497 bpstat_copy (bpstat bs)
4501 bpstat retval = NULL;
4506 for (; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
4508 tmp = (bpstat) xmalloc (sizeof (*tmp));
4509 memcpy (tmp, bs, sizeof (*tmp));
4510 incref_counted_command_line (tmp->commands);
4511 incref_bp_location (tmp->bp_location_at);
4512 if (bs->old_val != NULL)
4514 tmp->old_val = value_copy (bs->old_val);
4515 release_value (tmp->old_val);
4519 /* This is the first thing in the chain. */
4529 /* Find the bpstat associated with this breakpoint. */
4532 bpstat_find_breakpoint (bpstat bsp, struct breakpoint *breakpoint)
4537 for (; bsp != NULL; bsp = bsp->next)
4539 if (bsp->breakpoint_at == breakpoint)
4545 /* See breakpoint.h. */
4548 bpstat_explains_signal (bpstat bsp, enum gdb_signal sig)
4550 for (; bsp != NULL; bsp = bsp->next)
4552 if (bsp->breakpoint_at == NULL)
4554 /* A moribund location can never explain a signal other than
4556 if (sig == GDB_SIGNAL_TRAP)
4561 if (bsp->breakpoint_at->ops->explains_signal (bsp->breakpoint_at,
4570 /* Put in *NUM the breakpoint number of the first breakpoint we are
4571 stopped at. *BSP upon return is a bpstat which points to the
4572 remaining breakpoints stopped at (but which is not guaranteed to be
4573 good for anything but further calls to bpstat_num).
4575 Return 0 if passed a bpstat which does not indicate any breakpoints.
4576 Return -1 if stopped at a breakpoint that has been deleted since
4578 Return 1 otherwise. */
4581 bpstat_num (bpstat *bsp, int *num)
4583 struct breakpoint *b;
4586 return 0; /* No more breakpoint values */
4588 /* We assume we'll never have several bpstats that correspond to a
4589 single breakpoint -- otherwise, this function might return the
4590 same number more than once and this will look ugly. */
4591 b = (*bsp)->breakpoint_at;
4592 *bsp = (*bsp)->next;
4594 return -1; /* breakpoint that's been deleted since */
4596 *num = b->number; /* We have its number */
4600 /* See breakpoint.h. */
4603 bpstat_clear_actions (void)
4605 struct thread_info *tp;
4608 if (ptid_equal (inferior_ptid, null_ptid))
4611 tp = find_thread_ptid (inferior_ptid);
4615 for (bs = tp->control.stop_bpstat; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
4617 decref_counted_command_line (&bs->commands);
4619 if (bs->old_val != NULL)
4621 value_free (bs->old_val);
4627 /* Called when a command is about to proceed the inferior. */
4630 breakpoint_about_to_proceed (void)
4632 if (!ptid_equal (inferior_ptid, null_ptid))
4634 struct thread_info *tp = inferior_thread ();
4636 /* Allow inferior function calls in breakpoint commands to not
4637 interrupt the command list. When the call finishes
4638 successfully, the inferior will be standing at the same
4639 breakpoint as if nothing happened. */
4640 if (tp->control.in_infcall)
4644 breakpoint_proceeded = 1;
4647 /* Stub for cleaning up our state if we error-out of a breakpoint
4650 cleanup_executing_breakpoints (void *ignore)
4652 executing_breakpoint_commands = 0;
4655 /* Return non-zero iff CMD as the first line of a command sequence is `silent'
4656 or its equivalent. */
4659 command_line_is_silent (struct command_line *cmd)
4661 return cmd && (strcmp ("silent", cmd->line) == 0);
4664 /* Execute all the commands associated with all the breakpoints at
4665 this location. Any of these commands could cause the process to
4666 proceed beyond this point, etc. We look out for such changes by
4667 checking the global "breakpoint_proceeded" after each command.
4669 Returns true if a breakpoint command resumed the inferior. In that
4670 case, it is the caller's responsibility to recall it again with the
4671 bpstat of the current thread. */
4674 bpstat_do_actions_1 (bpstat *bsp)
4677 struct cleanup *old_chain;
4680 /* Avoid endless recursion if a `source' command is contained
4682 if (executing_breakpoint_commands)
4685 executing_breakpoint_commands = 1;
4686 old_chain = make_cleanup (cleanup_executing_breakpoints, 0);
4688 prevent_dont_repeat ();
4690 /* This pointer will iterate over the list of bpstat's. */
4693 breakpoint_proceeded = 0;
4694 for (; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
4696 struct counted_command_line *ccmd;
4697 struct command_line *cmd;
4698 struct cleanup *this_cmd_tree_chain;
4700 /* Take ownership of the BSP's command tree, if it has one.
4702 The command tree could legitimately contain commands like
4703 'step' and 'next', which call clear_proceed_status, which
4704 frees stop_bpstat's command tree. To make sure this doesn't
4705 free the tree we're executing out from under us, we need to
4706 take ownership of the tree ourselves. Since a given bpstat's
4707 commands are only executed once, we don't need to copy it; we
4708 can clear the pointer in the bpstat, and make sure we free
4709 the tree when we're done. */
4710 ccmd = bs->commands;
4711 bs->commands = NULL;
4712 this_cmd_tree_chain = make_cleanup_decref_counted_command_line (&ccmd);
4713 cmd = ccmd ? ccmd->commands : NULL;
4714 if (command_line_is_silent (cmd))
4716 /* The action has been already done by bpstat_stop_status. */
4722 execute_control_command (cmd);
4724 if (breakpoint_proceeded)
4730 /* We can free this command tree now. */
4731 do_cleanups (this_cmd_tree_chain);
4733 if (breakpoint_proceeded)
4735 if (current_ui->async)
4736 /* If we are in async mode, then the target might be still
4737 running, not stopped at any breakpoint, so nothing for
4738 us to do here -- just return to the event loop. */
4741 /* In sync mode, when execute_control_command returns
4742 we're already standing on the next breakpoint.
4743 Breakpoint commands for that stop were not run, since
4744 execute_command does not run breakpoint commands --
4745 only command_line_handler does, but that one is not
4746 involved in execution of breakpoint commands. So, we
4747 can now execute breakpoint commands. It should be
4748 noted that making execute_command do bpstat actions is
4749 not an option -- in this case we'll have recursive
4750 invocation of bpstat for each breakpoint with a
4751 command, and can easily blow up GDB stack. Instead, we
4752 return true, which will trigger the caller to recall us
4753 with the new stop_bpstat. */
4758 do_cleanups (old_chain);
4763 bpstat_do_actions (void)
4765 struct cleanup *cleanup_if_error = make_bpstat_clear_actions_cleanup ();
4767 /* Do any commands attached to breakpoint we are stopped at. */
4768 while (!ptid_equal (inferior_ptid, null_ptid)
4769 && target_has_execution
4770 && !is_exited (inferior_ptid)
4771 && !is_executing (inferior_ptid))
4772 /* Since in sync mode, bpstat_do_actions may resume the inferior,
4773 and only return when it is stopped at the next breakpoint, we
4774 keep doing breakpoint actions until it returns false to
4775 indicate the inferior was not resumed. */
4776 if (!bpstat_do_actions_1 (&inferior_thread ()->control.stop_bpstat))
4779 discard_cleanups (cleanup_if_error);
4782 /* Print out the (old or new) value associated with a watchpoint. */
4785 watchpoint_value_print (struct value *val, struct ui_file *stream)
4788 fprintf_unfiltered (stream, _("<unreadable>"));
4791 struct value_print_options opts;
4792 get_user_print_options (&opts);
4793 value_print (val, stream, &opts);
4797 /* Print the "Thread ID hit" part of "Thread ID hit Breakpoint N" if
4798 debugging multiple threads. */
4801 maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (struct ui_out *uiout)
4803 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
4806 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
4808 if (show_thread_that_caused_stop ())
4811 struct thread_info *thr = inferior_thread ();
4813 ui_out_text (uiout, "Thread ");
4814 ui_out_field_fmt (uiout, "thread-id", "%s", print_thread_id (thr));
4816 name = thr->name != NULL ? thr->name : target_thread_name (thr);
4819 ui_out_text (uiout, " \"");
4820 ui_out_field_fmt (uiout, "name", "%s", name);
4821 ui_out_text (uiout, "\"");
4824 ui_out_text (uiout, " hit ");
4828 /* Generic routine for printing messages indicating why we
4829 stopped. The behavior of this function depends on the value
4830 'print_it' in the bpstat structure. Under some circumstances we
4831 may decide not to print anything here and delegate the task to
4834 static enum print_stop_action
4835 print_bp_stop_message (bpstat bs)
4837 switch (bs->print_it)
4840 /* Nothing should be printed for this bpstat entry. */
4841 return PRINT_UNKNOWN;
4845 /* We still want to print the frame, but we already printed the
4846 relevant messages. */
4847 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
4850 case print_it_normal:
4852 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
4854 /* bs->breakpoint_at can be NULL if it was a momentary breakpoint
4855 which has since been deleted. */
4857 return PRINT_UNKNOWN;
4859 /* Normal case. Call the breakpoint's print_it method. */
4860 return b->ops->print_it (bs);
4865 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
4866 _("print_bp_stop_message: unrecognized enum value"));
4871 /* A helper function that prints a shared library stopped event. */
4874 print_solib_event (int is_catchpoint)
4877 = !VEC_empty (char_ptr, current_program_space->deleted_solibs);
4879 = !VEC_empty (so_list_ptr, current_program_space->added_solibs);
4883 if (any_added || any_deleted)
4884 ui_out_text (current_uiout,
4885 _("Stopped due to shared library event:\n"));
4887 ui_out_text (current_uiout,
4888 _("Stopped due to shared library event (no "
4889 "libraries added or removed)\n"));
4892 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (current_uiout))
4893 ui_out_field_string (current_uiout, "reason",
4894 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_SOLIB_EVENT));
4898 struct cleanup *cleanup;
4902 ui_out_text (current_uiout, _(" Inferior unloaded "));
4903 cleanup = make_cleanup_ui_out_list_begin_end (current_uiout,
4906 VEC_iterate (char_ptr, current_program_space->deleted_solibs,
4911 ui_out_text (current_uiout, " ");
4912 ui_out_field_string (current_uiout, "library", name);
4913 ui_out_text (current_uiout, "\n");
4916 do_cleanups (cleanup);
4921 struct so_list *iter;
4923 struct cleanup *cleanup;
4925 ui_out_text (current_uiout, _(" Inferior loaded "));
4926 cleanup = make_cleanup_ui_out_list_begin_end (current_uiout,
4929 VEC_iterate (so_list_ptr, current_program_space->added_solibs,
4934 ui_out_text (current_uiout, " ");
4935 ui_out_field_string (current_uiout, "library", iter->so_name);
4936 ui_out_text (current_uiout, "\n");
4939 do_cleanups (cleanup);
4943 /* Print a message indicating what happened. This is called from
4944 normal_stop(). The input to this routine is the head of the bpstat
4945 list - a list of the eventpoints that caused this stop. KIND is
4946 the target_waitkind for the stopping event. This
4947 routine calls the generic print routine for printing a message
4948 about reasons for stopping. This will print (for example) the
4949 "Breakpoint n," part of the output. The return value of this
4952 PRINT_UNKNOWN: Means we printed nothing.
4953 PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC: Means we printed something, and expect subsequent
4954 code to print the location. An example is
4955 "Breakpoint 1, " which should be followed by
4957 PRINT_SRC_ONLY: Means we printed something, but there is no need
4958 to also print the location part of the message.
4959 An example is the catch/throw messages, which
4960 don't require a location appended to the end.
4961 PRINT_NOTHING: We have done some printing and we don't need any
4962 further info to be printed. */
4964 enum print_stop_action
4965 bpstat_print (bpstat bs, int kind)
4967 enum print_stop_action val;
4969 /* Maybe another breakpoint in the chain caused us to stop.
4970 (Currently all watchpoints go on the bpstat whether hit or not.
4971 That probably could (should) be changed, provided care is taken
4972 with respect to bpstat_explains_signal). */
4973 for (; bs; bs = bs->next)
4975 val = print_bp_stop_message (bs);
4976 if (val == PRINT_SRC_ONLY
4977 || val == PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC
4978 || val == PRINT_NOTHING)
4982 /* If we had hit a shared library event breakpoint,
4983 print_bp_stop_message would print out this message. If we hit an
4984 OS-level shared library event, do the same thing. */
4985 if (kind == TARGET_WAITKIND_LOADED)
4987 print_solib_event (0);
4988 return PRINT_NOTHING;
4991 /* We reached the end of the chain, or we got a null BS to start
4992 with and nothing was printed. */
4993 return PRINT_UNKNOWN;
4996 /* Evaluate the expression EXP and return 1 if value is zero.
4997 This returns the inverse of the condition because it is called
4998 from catch_errors which returns 0 if an exception happened, and if an
4999 exception happens we want execution to stop.
5000 The argument is a "struct expression *" that has been cast to a
5001 "void *" to make it pass through catch_errors. */
5004 breakpoint_cond_eval (void *exp)
5006 struct value *mark = value_mark ();
5007 int i = !value_true (evaluate_expression ((struct expression *) exp));
5009 value_free_to_mark (mark);
5013 /* Allocate a new bpstat. Link it to the FIFO list by BS_LINK_POINTER. */
5016 bpstat_alloc (struct bp_location *bl, bpstat **bs_link_pointer)
5020 bs = (bpstat) xmalloc (sizeof (*bs));
5022 **bs_link_pointer = bs;
5023 *bs_link_pointer = &bs->next;
5024 bs->breakpoint_at = bl->owner;
5025 bs->bp_location_at = bl;
5026 incref_bp_location (bl);
5027 /* If the condition is false, etc., don't do the commands. */
5028 bs->commands = NULL;
5030 bs->print_it = print_it_normal;
5034 /* The target has stopped with waitstatus WS. Check if any hardware
5035 watchpoints have triggered, according to the target. */
5038 watchpoints_triggered (struct target_waitstatus *ws)
5040 int stopped_by_watchpoint = target_stopped_by_watchpoint ();
5042 struct breakpoint *b;
5044 if (!stopped_by_watchpoint)
5046 /* We were not stopped by a watchpoint. Mark all watchpoints
5047 as not triggered. */
5049 if (is_hardware_watchpoint (b))
5051 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
5053 w->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_no;
5059 if (!target_stopped_data_address (¤t_target, &addr))
5061 /* We were stopped by a watchpoint, but we don't know where.
5062 Mark all watchpoints as unknown. */
5064 if (is_hardware_watchpoint (b))
5066 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
5068 w->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_unknown;
5074 /* The target could report the data address. Mark watchpoints
5075 affected by this data address as triggered, and all others as not
5079 if (is_hardware_watchpoint (b))
5081 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
5082 struct bp_location *loc;
5084 w->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_no;
5085 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
5087 if (is_masked_watchpoint (b))
5089 CORE_ADDR newaddr = addr & w->hw_wp_mask;
5090 CORE_ADDR start = loc->address & w->hw_wp_mask;
5092 if (newaddr == start)
5094 w->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_yes;
5098 /* Exact match not required. Within range is sufficient. */
5099 else if (target_watchpoint_addr_within_range (¤t_target,
5103 w->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_yes;
5112 /* Possible return values for watchpoint_check (this can't be an enum
5113 because of check_errors). */
5114 /* The watchpoint has been deleted. */
5115 #define WP_DELETED 1
5116 /* The value has changed. */
5117 #define WP_VALUE_CHANGED 2
5118 /* The value has not changed. */
5119 #define WP_VALUE_NOT_CHANGED 3
5120 /* Ignore this watchpoint, no matter if the value changed or not. */
5123 #define BP_TEMPFLAG 1
5124 #define BP_HARDWAREFLAG 2
5126 /* Evaluate watchpoint condition expression and check if its value
5129 P should be a pointer to struct bpstat, but is defined as a void *
5130 in order for this function to be usable with catch_errors. */
5133 watchpoint_check (void *p)
5135 bpstat bs = (bpstat) p;
5136 struct watchpoint *b;
5137 struct frame_info *fr;
5138 int within_current_scope;
5140 /* BS is built from an existing struct breakpoint. */
5141 gdb_assert (bs->breakpoint_at != NULL);
5142 b = (struct watchpoint *) bs->breakpoint_at;
5144 /* If this is a local watchpoint, we only want to check if the
5145 watchpoint frame is in scope if the current thread is the thread
5146 that was used to create the watchpoint. */
5147 if (!watchpoint_in_thread_scope (b))
5150 if (b->exp_valid_block == NULL)
5151 within_current_scope = 1;
5154 struct frame_info *frame = get_current_frame ();
5155 struct gdbarch *frame_arch = get_frame_arch (frame);
5156 CORE_ADDR frame_pc = get_frame_pc (frame);
5158 /* stack_frame_destroyed_p() returns a non-zero value if we're
5159 still in the function but the stack frame has already been
5160 invalidated. Since we can't rely on the values of local
5161 variables after the stack has been destroyed, we are treating
5162 the watchpoint in that state as `not changed' without further
5163 checking. Don't mark watchpoints as changed if the current
5164 frame is in an epilogue - even if they are in some other
5165 frame, our view of the stack is likely to be wrong and
5166 frame_find_by_id could error out. */
5167 if (gdbarch_stack_frame_destroyed_p (frame_arch, frame_pc))
5170 fr = frame_find_by_id (b->watchpoint_frame);
5171 within_current_scope = (fr != NULL);
5173 /* If we've gotten confused in the unwinder, we might have
5174 returned a frame that can't describe this variable. */
5175 if (within_current_scope)
5177 struct symbol *function;
5179 function = get_frame_function (fr);
5180 if (function == NULL
5181 || !contained_in (b->exp_valid_block,
5182 SYMBOL_BLOCK_VALUE (function)))
5183 within_current_scope = 0;
5186 if (within_current_scope)
5187 /* If we end up stopping, the current frame will get selected
5188 in normal_stop. So this call to select_frame won't affect
5193 if (within_current_scope)
5195 /* We use value_{,free_to_}mark because it could be a *long*
5196 time before we return to the command level and call
5197 free_all_values. We can't call free_all_values because we
5198 might be in the middle of evaluating a function call. */
5202 struct value *new_val;
5204 if (is_masked_watchpoint (&b->base))
5205 /* Since we don't know the exact trigger address (from
5206 stopped_data_address), just tell the user we've triggered
5207 a mask watchpoint. */
5208 return WP_VALUE_CHANGED;
5210 mark = value_mark ();
5211 fetch_subexp_value (b->exp.get (), &pc, &new_val, NULL, NULL, 0);
5213 if (b->val_bitsize != 0)
5214 new_val = extract_bitfield_from_watchpoint_value (b, new_val);
5216 /* We use value_equal_contents instead of value_equal because
5217 the latter coerces an array to a pointer, thus comparing just
5218 the address of the array instead of its contents. This is
5219 not what we want. */
5220 if ((b->val != NULL) != (new_val != NULL)
5221 || (b->val != NULL && !value_equal_contents (b->val, new_val)))
5223 if (new_val != NULL)
5225 release_value (new_val);
5226 value_free_to_mark (mark);
5228 bs->old_val = b->val;
5231 return WP_VALUE_CHANGED;
5235 /* Nothing changed. */
5236 value_free_to_mark (mark);
5237 return WP_VALUE_NOT_CHANGED;
5242 /* This seems like the only logical thing to do because
5243 if we temporarily ignored the watchpoint, then when
5244 we reenter the block in which it is valid it contains
5245 garbage (in the case of a function, it may have two
5246 garbage values, one before and one after the prologue).
5247 So we can't even detect the first assignment to it and
5248 watch after that (since the garbage may or may not equal
5249 the first value assigned). */
5250 /* We print all the stop information in
5251 breakpoint_ops->print_it, but in this case, by the time we
5252 call breakpoint_ops->print_it this bp will be deleted
5253 already. So we have no choice but print the information
5256 SWITCH_THRU_ALL_UIS ()
5258 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
5260 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
5262 (uiout, "reason", async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_WATCHPOINT_SCOPE));
5263 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nWatchpoint ");
5264 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "wpnum", b->base.number);
5266 " deleted because the program has left the block in\n"
5267 "which its expression is valid.\n");
5270 /* Make sure the watchpoint's commands aren't executed. */
5271 decref_counted_command_line (&b->base.commands);
5272 watchpoint_del_at_next_stop (b);
5278 /* Return true if it looks like target has stopped due to hitting
5279 breakpoint location BL. This function does not check if we should
5280 stop, only if BL explains the stop. */
5283 bpstat_check_location (const struct bp_location *bl,
5284 struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
5285 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
5287 struct breakpoint *b = bl->owner;
5289 /* BL is from an existing breakpoint. */
5290 gdb_assert (b != NULL);
5292 return b->ops->breakpoint_hit (bl, aspace, bp_addr, ws);
5295 /* Determine if the watched values have actually changed, and we
5296 should stop. If not, set BS->stop to 0. */
5299 bpstat_check_watchpoint (bpstat bs)
5301 const struct bp_location *bl;
5302 struct watchpoint *b;
5304 /* BS is built for existing struct breakpoint. */
5305 bl = bs->bp_location_at;
5306 gdb_assert (bl != NULL);
5307 b = (struct watchpoint *) bs->breakpoint_at;
5308 gdb_assert (b != NULL);
5311 int must_check_value = 0;
5313 if (b->base.type == bp_watchpoint)
5314 /* For a software watchpoint, we must always check the
5316 must_check_value = 1;
5317 else if (b->watchpoint_triggered == watch_triggered_yes)
5318 /* We have a hardware watchpoint (read, write, or access)
5319 and the target earlier reported an address watched by
5321 must_check_value = 1;
5322 else if (b->watchpoint_triggered == watch_triggered_unknown
5323 && b->base.type == bp_hardware_watchpoint)
5324 /* We were stopped by a hardware watchpoint, but the target could
5325 not report the data address. We must check the watchpoint's
5326 value. Access and read watchpoints are out of luck; without
5327 a data address, we can't figure it out. */
5328 must_check_value = 1;
5330 if (must_check_value)
5333 = xstrprintf ("Error evaluating expression for watchpoint %d\n",
5335 struct cleanup *cleanups = make_cleanup (xfree, message);
5336 int e = catch_errors (watchpoint_check, bs, message,
5338 do_cleanups (cleanups);
5342 /* We've already printed what needs to be printed. */
5343 bs->print_it = print_it_done;
5347 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
5350 case WP_VALUE_CHANGED:
5351 if (b->base.type == bp_read_watchpoint)
5353 /* There are two cases to consider here:
5355 1. We're watching the triggered memory for reads.
5356 In that case, trust the target, and always report
5357 the watchpoint hit to the user. Even though
5358 reads don't cause value changes, the value may
5359 have changed since the last time it was read, and
5360 since we're not trapping writes, we will not see
5361 those, and as such we should ignore our notion of
5364 2. We're watching the triggered memory for both
5365 reads and writes. There are two ways this may
5368 2.1. This is a target that can't break on data
5369 reads only, but can break on accesses (reads or
5370 writes), such as e.g., x86. We detect this case
5371 at the time we try to insert read watchpoints.
5373 2.2. Otherwise, the target supports read
5374 watchpoints, but, the user set an access or write
5375 watchpoint watching the same memory as this read
5378 If we're watching memory writes as well as reads,
5379 ignore watchpoint hits when we find that the
5380 value hasn't changed, as reads don't cause
5381 changes. This still gives false positives when
5382 the program writes the same value to memory as
5383 what there was already in memory (we will confuse
5384 it for a read), but it's much better than
5387 int other_write_watchpoint = 0;
5389 if (bl->watchpoint_type == hw_read)
5391 struct breakpoint *other_b;
5393 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (other_b)
5394 if (other_b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
5395 || other_b->type == bp_access_watchpoint)
5397 struct watchpoint *other_w =
5398 (struct watchpoint *) other_b;
5400 if (other_w->watchpoint_triggered
5401 == watch_triggered_yes)
5403 other_write_watchpoint = 1;
5409 if (other_write_watchpoint
5410 || bl->watchpoint_type == hw_access)
5412 /* We're watching the same memory for writes,
5413 and the value changed since the last time we
5414 updated it, so this trap must be for a write.
5416 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
5421 case WP_VALUE_NOT_CHANGED:
5422 if (b->base.type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
5423 || b->base.type == bp_watchpoint)
5425 /* Don't stop: write watchpoints shouldn't fire if
5426 the value hasn't changed. */
5427 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
5435 /* Error from catch_errors. */
5437 SWITCH_THRU_ALL_UIS ()
5439 printf_filtered (_("Watchpoint %d deleted.\n"),
5442 watchpoint_del_at_next_stop (b);
5443 /* We've already printed what needs to be printed. */
5444 bs->print_it = print_it_done;
5449 else /* must_check_value == 0 */
5451 /* This is a case where some watchpoint(s) triggered, but
5452 not at the address of this watchpoint, or else no
5453 watchpoint triggered after all. So don't print
5454 anything for this watchpoint. */
5455 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
5461 /* For breakpoints that are currently marked as telling gdb to stop,
5462 check conditions (condition proper, frame, thread and ignore count)
5463 of breakpoint referred to by BS. If we should not stop for this
5464 breakpoint, set BS->stop to 0. */
5467 bpstat_check_breakpoint_conditions (bpstat bs, ptid_t ptid)
5469 const struct bp_location *bl;
5470 struct breakpoint *b;
5471 int value_is_zero = 0;
5472 struct expression *cond;
5474 gdb_assert (bs->stop);
5476 /* BS is built for existing struct breakpoint. */
5477 bl = bs->bp_location_at;
5478 gdb_assert (bl != NULL);
5479 b = bs->breakpoint_at;
5480 gdb_assert (b != NULL);
5482 /* Even if the target evaluated the condition on its end and notified GDB, we
5483 need to do so again since GDB does not know if we stopped due to a
5484 breakpoint or a single step breakpoint. */
5486 if (frame_id_p (b->frame_id)
5487 && !frame_id_eq (b->frame_id, get_stack_frame_id (get_current_frame ())))
5493 /* If this is a thread/task-specific breakpoint, don't waste cpu
5494 evaluating the condition if this isn't the specified
5496 if ((b->thread != -1 && b->thread != ptid_to_global_thread_id (ptid))
5497 || (b->task != 0 && b->task != ada_get_task_number (ptid)))
5504 /* Evaluate extension language breakpoints that have a "stop" method
5506 bs->stop = breakpoint_ext_lang_cond_says_stop (b);
5508 if (is_watchpoint (b))
5510 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
5512 cond = w->cond_exp.get ();
5515 cond = bl->cond.get ();
5517 if (cond && b->disposition != disp_del_at_next_stop)
5519 int within_current_scope = 1;
5520 struct watchpoint * w;
5522 /* We use value_mark and value_free_to_mark because it could
5523 be a long time before we return to the command level and
5524 call free_all_values. We can't call free_all_values
5525 because we might be in the middle of evaluating a
5527 struct value *mark = value_mark ();
5529 if (is_watchpoint (b))
5530 w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
5534 /* Need to select the frame, with all that implies so that
5535 the conditions will have the right context. Because we
5536 use the frame, we will not see an inlined function's
5537 variables when we arrive at a breakpoint at the start
5538 of the inlined function; the current frame will be the
5540 if (w == NULL || w->cond_exp_valid_block == NULL)
5541 select_frame (get_current_frame ());
5544 struct frame_info *frame;
5546 /* For local watchpoint expressions, which particular
5547 instance of a local is being watched matters, so we
5548 keep track of the frame to evaluate the expression
5549 in. To evaluate the condition however, it doesn't
5550 really matter which instantiation of the function
5551 where the condition makes sense triggers the
5552 watchpoint. This allows an expression like "watch
5553 global if q > 10" set in `func', catch writes to
5554 global on all threads that call `func', or catch
5555 writes on all recursive calls of `func' by a single
5556 thread. We simply always evaluate the condition in
5557 the innermost frame that's executing where it makes
5558 sense to evaluate the condition. It seems
5560 frame = block_innermost_frame (w->cond_exp_valid_block);
5562 select_frame (frame);
5564 within_current_scope = 0;
5566 if (within_current_scope)
5568 = catch_errors (breakpoint_cond_eval, cond,
5569 "Error in testing breakpoint condition:\n",
5573 warning (_("Watchpoint condition cannot be tested "
5574 "in the current scope"));
5575 /* If we failed to set the right context for this
5576 watchpoint, unconditionally report it. */
5579 /* FIXME-someday, should give breakpoint #. */
5580 value_free_to_mark (mark);
5583 if (cond && value_is_zero)
5587 else if (b->ignore_count > 0)
5591 /* Increase the hit count even though we don't stop. */
5593 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b);
5597 /* Returns true if we need to track moribund locations of LOC's type
5598 on the current target. */
5601 need_moribund_for_location_type (struct bp_location *loc)
5603 return ((loc->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
5604 && !target_supports_stopped_by_sw_breakpoint ())
5605 || (loc->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint
5606 && !target_supports_stopped_by_hw_breakpoint ()));
5610 /* Get a bpstat associated with having just stopped at address
5611 BP_ADDR in thread PTID.
5613 Determine whether we stopped at a breakpoint, etc, or whether we
5614 don't understand this stop. Result is a chain of bpstat's such
5617 if we don't understand the stop, the result is a null pointer.
5619 if we understand why we stopped, the result is not null.
5621 Each element of the chain refers to a particular breakpoint or
5622 watchpoint at which we have stopped. (We may have stopped for
5623 several reasons concurrently.)
5625 Each element of the chain has valid next, breakpoint_at,
5626 commands, FIXME??? fields. */
5629 bpstat_stop_status (struct address_space *aspace,
5630 CORE_ADDR bp_addr, ptid_t ptid,
5631 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
5633 struct breakpoint *b = NULL;
5634 struct bp_location *bl;
5635 struct bp_location *loc;
5636 /* First item of allocated bpstat's. */
5637 bpstat bs_head = NULL, *bs_link = &bs_head;
5638 /* Pointer to the last thing in the chain currently. */
5641 int need_remove_insert;
5644 /* First, build the bpstat chain with locations that explain a
5645 target stop, while being careful to not set the target running,
5646 as that may invalidate locations (in particular watchpoint
5647 locations are recreated). Resuming will happen here with
5648 breakpoint conditions or watchpoint expressions that include
5649 inferior function calls. */
5653 if (!breakpoint_enabled (b))
5656 for (bl = b->loc; bl != NULL; bl = bl->next)
5658 /* For hardware watchpoints, we look only at the first
5659 location. The watchpoint_check function will work on the
5660 entire expression, not the individual locations. For
5661 read watchpoints, the watchpoints_triggered function has
5662 checked all locations already. */
5663 if (b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint && bl != b->loc)
5666 if (!bl->enabled || bl->shlib_disabled)
5669 if (!bpstat_check_location (bl, aspace, bp_addr, ws))
5672 /* Come here if it's a watchpoint, or if the break address
5675 bs = bpstat_alloc (bl, &bs_link); /* Alloc a bpstat to
5678 /* Assume we stop. Should we find a watchpoint that is not
5679 actually triggered, or if the condition of the breakpoint
5680 evaluates as false, we'll reset 'stop' to 0. */
5684 /* If this is a scope breakpoint, mark the associated
5685 watchpoint as triggered so that we will handle the
5686 out-of-scope event. We'll get to the watchpoint next
5688 if (b->type == bp_watchpoint_scope && b->related_breakpoint != b)
5690 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b->related_breakpoint;
5692 w->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_yes;
5697 /* Check if a moribund breakpoint explains the stop. */
5698 if (!target_supports_stopped_by_sw_breakpoint ()
5699 || !target_supports_stopped_by_hw_breakpoint ())
5701 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (bp_location_p, moribund_locations, ix, loc); ++ix)
5703 if (breakpoint_location_address_match (loc, aspace, bp_addr)
5704 && need_moribund_for_location_type (loc))
5706 bs = bpstat_alloc (loc, &bs_link);
5707 /* For hits of moribund locations, we should just proceed. */
5710 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
5715 /* A bit of special processing for shlib breakpoints. We need to
5716 process solib loading here, so that the lists of loaded and
5717 unloaded libraries are correct before we handle "catch load" and
5719 for (bs = bs_head; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
5721 if (bs->breakpoint_at && bs->breakpoint_at->type == bp_shlib_event)
5723 handle_solib_event ();
5728 /* Now go through the locations that caused the target to stop, and
5729 check whether we're interested in reporting this stop to higher
5730 layers, or whether we should resume the target transparently. */
5734 for (bs = bs_head; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
5739 b = bs->breakpoint_at;
5740 b->ops->check_status (bs);
5743 bpstat_check_breakpoint_conditions (bs, ptid);
5748 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b);
5750 /* We will stop here. */
5751 if (b->disposition == disp_disable)
5753 --(b->enable_count);
5754 if (b->enable_count <= 0)
5755 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
5760 bs->commands = b->commands;
5761 incref_counted_command_line (bs->commands);
5762 if (command_line_is_silent (bs->commands
5763 ? bs->commands->commands : NULL))
5766 b->ops->after_condition_true (bs);
5771 /* Print nothing for this entry if we don't stop or don't
5773 if (!bs->stop || !bs->print)
5774 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
5777 /* If we aren't stopping, the value of some hardware watchpoint may
5778 not have changed, but the intermediate memory locations we are
5779 watching may have. Don't bother if we're stopping; this will get
5781 need_remove_insert = 0;
5782 if (! bpstat_causes_stop (bs_head))
5783 for (bs = bs_head; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
5785 && bs->breakpoint_at
5786 && is_hardware_watchpoint (bs->breakpoint_at))
5788 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bs->breakpoint_at;
5790 update_watchpoint (w, 0 /* don't reparse. */);
5791 need_remove_insert = 1;
5794 if (need_remove_insert)
5795 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
5796 else if (removed_any)
5797 update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT);
5803 handle_jit_event (void)
5805 struct frame_info *frame;
5806 struct gdbarch *gdbarch;
5809 fprintf_unfiltered (gdb_stdlog, "handling bp_jit_event\n");
5811 /* Switch terminal for any messages produced by
5812 breakpoint_re_set. */
5813 target_terminal_ours_for_output ();
5815 frame = get_current_frame ();
5816 gdbarch = get_frame_arch (frame);
5818 jit_event_handler (gdbarch);
5820 target_terminal_inferior ();
5823 /* Prepare WHAT final decision for infrun. */
5825 /* Decide what infrun needs to do with this bpstat. */
5828 bpstat_what (bpstat bs_head)
5830 struct bpstat_what retval;
5833 retval.main_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_KEEP_CHECKING;
5834 retval.call_dummy = STOP_NONE;
5835 retval.is_longjmp = 0;
5837 for (bs = bs_head; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
5839 /* Extract this BS's action. After processing each BS, we check
5840 if its action overrides all we've seem so far. */
5841 enum bpstat_what_main_action this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_KEEP_CHECKING;
5844 if (bs->breakpoint_at == NULL)
5846 /* I suspect this can happen if it was a momentary
5847 breakpoint which has since been deleted. */
5851 bptype = bs->breakpoint_at->type;
5858 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
5859 case bp_single_step:
5862 case bp_shlib_event:
5866 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_NOISY;
5868 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT;
5871 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5874 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
5875 case bp_read_watchpoint:
5876 case bp_access_watchpoint:
5880 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_NOISY;
5882 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT;
5886 /* There was a watchpoint, but we're not stopping.
5887 This requires no further action. */
5891 case bp_longjmp_call_dummy:
5895 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SET_LONGJMP_RESUME;
5896 retval.is_longjmp = bptype != bp_exception;
5899 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5901 case bp_longjmp_resume:
5902 case bp_exception_resume:
5905 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_CLEAR_LONGJMP_RESUME;
5906 retval.is_longjmp = bptype == bp_longjmp_resume;
5909 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5911 case bp_step_resume:
5913 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STEP_RESUME;
5916 /* It is for the wrong frame. */
5917 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5920 case bp_hp_step_resume:
5922 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_HP_STEP_RESUME;
5925 /* It is for the wrong frame. */
5926 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5929 case bp_watchpoint_scope:
5930 case bp_thread_event:
5931 case bp_overlay_event:
5932 case bp_longjmp_master:
5933 case bp_std_terminate_master:
5934 case bp_exception_master:
5935 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5941 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_NOISY;
5943 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT;
5947 /* There was a catchpoint, but we're not stopping.
5948 This requires no further action. */
5952 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5955 /* Make sure the action is stop (silent or noisy),
5956 so infrun.c pops the dummy frame. */
5957 retval.call_dummy = STOP_STACK_DUMMY;
5958 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT;
5960 case bp_std_terminate:
5961 /* Make sure the action is stop (silent or noisy),
5962 so infrun.c pops the dummy frame. */
5963 retval.call_dummy = STOP_STD_TERMINATE;
5964 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT;
5967 case bp_fast_tracepoint:
5968 case bp_static_tracepoint:
5969 /* Tracepoint hits should not be reported back to GDB, and
5970 if one got through somehow, it should have been filtered
5972 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
5973 _("bpstat_what: tracepoint encountered"));
5975 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver:
5976 /* Step over it (and insert bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver_return). */
5977 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5979 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver_return:
5980 /* The breakpoint will be removed, execution will restart from the
5981 PC of the former breakpoint. */
5982 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_KEEP_CHECKING;
5987 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT;
5989 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5993 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
5994 _("bpstat_what: unhandled bptype %d"), (int) bptype);
5997 retval.main_action = std::max (retval.main_action, this_action);
6004 bpstat_run_callbacks (bpstat bs_head)
6008 for (bs = bs_head; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
6010 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
6017 handle_jit_event ();
6019 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver:
6020 gnu_ifunc_resolver_stop (b);
6022 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver_return:
6023 gnu_ifunc_resolver_return_stop (b);
6029 /* Nonzero if we should step constantly (e.g. watchpoints on machines
6030 without hardware support). This isn't related to a specific bpstat,
6031 just to things like whether watchpoints are set. */
6034 bpstat_should_step (void)
6036 struct breakpoint *b;
6039 if (breakpoint_enabled (b) && b->type == bp_watchpoint && b->loc != NULL)
6045 bpstat_causes_stop (bpstat bs)
6047 for (; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
6056 /* Compute a string of spaces suitable to indent the next line
6057 so it starts at the position corresponding to the table column
6058 named COL_NAME in the currently active table of UIOUT. */
6061 wrap_indent_at_field (struct ui_out *uiout, const char *col_name)
6063 static char wrap_indent[80];
6064 int i, total_width, width, align;
6068 for (i = 1; ui_out_query_field (uiout, i, &width, &align, &text); i++)
6070 if (strcmp (text, col_name) == 0)
6072 gdb_assert (total_width < sizeof wrap_indent);
6073 memset (wrap_indent, ' ', total_width);
6074 wrap_indent[total_width] = 0;
6079 total_width += width + 1;
6085 /* Determine if the locations of this breakpoint will have their conditions
6086 evaluated by the target, host or a mix of both. Returns the following:
6088 "host": Host evals condition.
6089 "host or target": Host or Target evals condition.
6090 "target": Target evals condition.
6094 bp_condition_evaluator (struct breakpoint *b)
6096 struct bp_location *bl;
6097 char host_evals = 0;
6098 char target_evals = 0;
6103 if (!is_breakpoint (b))
6106 if (gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p ()
6107 || !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
6108 return condition_evaluation_host;
6110 for (bl = b->loc; bl; bl = bl->next)
6112 if (bl->cond_bytecode)
6118 if (host_evals && target_evals)
6119 return condition_evaluation_both;
6120 else if (target_evals)
6121 return condition_evaluation_target;
6123 return condition_evaluation_host;
6126 /* Determine the breakpoint location's condition evaluator. This is
6127 similar to bp_condition_evaluator, but for locations. */
6130 bp_location_condition_evaluator (struct bp_location *bl)
6132 if (bl && !is_breakpoint (bl->owner))
6135 if (gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p ()
6136 || !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
6137 return condition_evaluation_host;
6139 if (bl && bl->cond_bytecode)
6140 return condition_evaluation_target;
6142 return condition_evaluation_host;
6145 /* Print the LOC location out of the list of B->LOC locations. */
6148 print_breakpoint_location (struct breakpoint *b,
6149 struct bp_location *loc)
6151 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
6152 struct cleanup *old_chain = save_current_program_space ();
6154 if (loc != NULL && loc->shlib_disabled)
6158 set_current_program_space (loc->pspace);
6160 if (b->display_canonical)
6161 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "what",
6162 event_location_to_string (b->location));
6163 else if (loc && loc->symtab)
6166 = find_pc_sect_function (loc->address, loc->section);
6169 ui_out_text (uiout, "in ");
6170 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "func",
6171 SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (sym));
6172 ui_out_text (uiout, " ");
6173 ui_out_wrap_hint (uiout, wrap_indent_at_field (uiout, "what"));
6174 ui_out_text (uiout, "at ");
6176 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "file",
6177 symtab_to_filename_for_display (loc->symtab));
6178 ui_out_text (uiout, ":");
6180 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
6181 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "fullname",
6182 symtab_to_fullname (loc->symtab));
6184 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "line", loc->line_number);
6188 struct ui_file *stb = mem_fileopen ();
6189 struct cleanup *stb_chain = make_cleanup_ui_file_delete (stb);
6191 print_address_symbolic (loc->gdbarch, loc->address, stb,
6193 ui_out_field_stream (uiout, "at", stb);
6195 do_cleanups (stb_chain);
6199 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "pending",
6200 event_location_to_string (b->location));
6201 /* If extra_string is available, it could be holding a condition
6202 or dprintf arguments. In either case, make sure it is printed,
6203 too, but only for non-MI streams. */
6204 if (!ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout) && b->extra_string != NULL)
6206 if (b->type == bp_dprintf)
6207 ui_out_text (uiout, ",");
6209 ui_out_text (uiout, " ");
6210 ui_out_text (uiout, b->extra_string);
6214 if (loc && is_breakpoint (b)
6215 && breakpoint_condition_evaluation_mode () == condition_evaluation_target
6216 && bp_condition_evaluator (b) == condition_evaluation_both)
6218 ui_out_text (uiout, " (");
6219 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "evaluated-by",
6220 bp_location_condition_evaluator (loc));
6221 ui_out_text (uiout, ")");
6224 do_cleanups (old_chain);
6228 bptype_string (enum bptype type)
6230 struct ep_type_description
6235 static struct ep_type_description bptypes[] =
6237 {bp_none, "?deleted?"},
6238 {bp_breakpoint, "breakpoint"},
6239 {bp_hardware_breakpoint, "hw breakpoint"},
6240 {bp_single_step, "sw single-step"},
6241 {bp_until, "until"},
6242 {bp_finish, "finish"},
6243 {bp_watchpoint, "watchpoint"},
6244 {bp_hardware_watchpoint, "hw watchpoint"},
6245 {bp_read_watchpoint, "read watchpoint"},
6246 {bp_access_watchpoint, "acc watchpoint"},
6247 {bp_longjmp, "longjmp"},
6248 {bp_longjmp_resume, "longjmp resume"},
6249 {bp_longjmp_call_dummy, "longjmp for call dummy"},
6250 {bp_exception, "exception"},
6251 {bp_exception_resume, "exception resume"},
6252 {bp_step_resume, "step resume"},
6253 {bp_hp_step_resume, "high-priority step resume"},
6254 {bp_watchpoint_scope, "watchpoint scope"},
6255 {bp_call_dummy, "call dummy"},
6256 {bp_std_terminate, "std::terminate"},
6257 {bp_shlib_event, "shlib events"},
6258 {bp_thread_event, "thread events"},
6259 {bp_overlay_event, "overlay events"},
6260 {bp_longjmp_master, "longjmp master"},
6261 {bp_std_terminate_master, "std::terminate master"},
6262 {bp_exception_master, "exception master"},
6263 {bp_catchpoint, "catchpoint"},
6264 {bp_tracepoint, "tracepoint"},
6265 {bp_fast_tracepoint, "fast tracepoint"},
6266 {bp_static_tracepoint, "static tracepoint"},
6267 {bp_dprintf, "dprintf"},
6268 {bp_jit_event, "jit events"},
6269 {bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver, "STT_GNU_IFUNC resolver"},
6270 {bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver_return, "STT_GNU_IFUNC resolver return"},
6273 if (((int) type >= (sizeof (bptypes) / sizeof (bptypes[0])))
6274 || ((int) type != bptypes[(int) type].type))
6275 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
6276 _("bptypes table does not describe type #%d."),
6279 return bptypes[(int) type].description;
6282 /* For MI, output a field named 'thread-groups' with a list as the value.
6283 For CLI, prefix the list with the string 'inf'. */
6286 output_thread_groups (struct ui_out *uiout,
6287 const char *field_name,
6291 struct cleanup *back_to;
6292 int is_mi = ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout);
6296 /* For backward compatibility, don't display inferiors in CLI unless
6297 there are several. Always display them for MI. */
6298 if (!is_mi && mi_only)
6301 back_to = make_cleanup_ui_out_list_begin_end (uiout, field_name);
6303 for (i = 0; VEC_iterate (int, inf_num, i, inf); ++i)
6309 xsnprintf (mi_group, sizeof (mi_group), "i%d", inf);
6310 ui_out_field_string (uiout, NULL, mi_group);
6315 ui_out_text (uiout, " inf ");
6317 ui_out_text (uiout, ", ");
6319 ui_out_text (uiout, plongest (inf));
6323 do_cleanups (back_to);
6326 /* Print B to gdb_stdout. */
6329 print_one_breakpoint_location (struct breakpoint *b,
6330 struct bp_location *loc,
6332 struct bp_location **last_loc,
6335 struct command_line *l;
6336 static char bpenables[] = "nynny";
6338 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
6339 int header_of_multiple = 0;
6340 int part_of_multiple = (loc != NULL);
6341 struct value_print_options opts;
6343 get_user_print_options (&opts);
6345 gdb_assert (!loc || loc_number != 0);
6346 /* See comment in print_one_breakpoint concerning treatment of
6347 breakpoints with single disabled location. */
6350 && (b->loc->next != NULL || !b->loc->enabled)))
6351 header_of_multiple = 1;
6359 if (part_of_multiple)
6362 formatted = xstrprintf ("%d.%d", b->number, loc_number);
6363 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "number", formatted);
6368 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "number", b->number);
6373 if (part_of_multiple)
6374 ui_out_field_skip (uiout, "type");
6376 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "type", bptype_string (b->type));
6380 if (part_of_multiple)
6381 ui_out_field_skip (uiout, "disp");
6383 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
6388 if (part_of_multiple)
6389 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "enabled", loc->enabled ? "y" : "n");
6391 ui_out_field_fmt (uiout, "enabled", "%c",
6392 bpenables[(int) b->enable_state]);
6393 ui_out_spaces (uiout, 2);
6397 if (b->ops != NULL && b->ops->print_one != NULL)
6399 /* Although the print_one can possibly print all locations,
6400 calling it here is not likely to get any nice result. So,
6401 make sure there's just one location. */
6402 gdb_assert (b->loc == NULL || b->loc->next == NULL);
6403 b->ops->print_one (b, last_loc);
6409 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
6410 _("print_one_breakpoint: bp_none encountered\n"));
6414 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
6415 case bp_read_watchpoint:
6416 case bp_access_watchpoint:
6418 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
6420 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns
6421 not line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect
6422 is relatively readable). */
6423 if (opts.addressprint)
6424 ui_out_field_skip (uiout, "addr");
6426 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "what", w->exp_string);
6431 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
6432 case bp_single_step:
6436 case bp_longjmp_resume:
6437 case bp_longjmp_call_dummy:
6439 case bp_exception_resume:
6440 case bp_step_resume:
6441 case bp_hp_step_resume:
6442 case bp_watchpoint_scope:
6444 case bp_std_terminate:
6445 case bp_shlib_event:
6446 case bp_thread_event:
6447 case bp_overlay_event:
6448 case bp_longjmp_master:
6449 case bp_std_terminate_master:
6450 case bp_exception_master:
6452 case bp_fast_tracepoint:
6453 case bp_static_tracepoint:
6456 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver:
6457 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver_return:
6458 if (opts.addressprint)
6461 if (header_of_multiple)
6462 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "addr", "<MULTIPLE>");
6463 else if (b->loc == NULL || loc->shlib_disabled)
6464 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "addr", "<PENDING>");
6466 ui_out_field_core_addr (uiout, "addr",
6467 loc->gdbarch, loc->address);
6470 if (!header_of_multiple)
6471 print_breakpoint_location (b, loc);
6478 if (loc != NULL && !header_of_multiple)
6480 struct inferior *inf;
6481 VEC(int) *inf_num = NULL;
6486 if (inf->pspace == loc->pspace)
6487 VEC_safe_push (int, inf_num, inf->num);
6490 /* For backward compatibility, don't display inferiors in CLI unless
6491 there are several. Always display for MI. */
6493 || (!gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ())
6494 && (number_of_program_spaces () > 1
6495 || number_of_inferiors () > 1)
6496 /* LOC is for existing B, it cannot be in
6497 moribund_locations and thus having NULL OWNER. */
6498 && loc->owner->type != bp_catchpoint))
6500 output_thread_groups (uiout, "thread-groups", inf_num, mi_only);
6501 VEC_free (int, inf_num);
6504 if (!part_of_multiple)
6506 if (b->thread != -1)
6508 /* FIXME: This seems to be redundant and lost here; see the
6509 "stop only in" line a little further down. */
6510 ui_out_text (uiout, " thread ");
6511 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "thread", b->thread);
6513 else if (b->task != 0)
6515 ui_out_text (uiout, " task ");
6516 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "task", b->task);
6520 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
6522 if (!part_of_multiple)
6523 b->ops->print_one_detail (b, uiout);
6525 if (part_of_multiple && frame_id_p (b->frame_id))
6528 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tstop only in stack frame at ");
6529 /* FIXME: cagney/2002-12-01: Shouldn't be poking around inside
6531 ui_out_field_core_addr (uiout, "frame",
6532 b->gdbarch, b->frame_id.stack_addr);
6533 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
6536 if (!part_of_multiple && b->cond_string)
6539 if (is_tracepoint (b))
6540 ui_out_text (uiout, "\ttrace only if ");
6542 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tstop only if ");
6543 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "cond", b->cond_string);
6545 /* Print whether the target is doing the breakpoint's condition
6546 evaluation. If GDB is doing the evaluation, don't print anything. */
6547 if (is_breakpoint (b)
6548 && breakpoint_condition_evaluation_mode ()
6549 == condition_evaluation_target)
6551 ui_out_text (uiout, " (");
6552 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "evaluated-by",
6553 bp_condition_evaluator (b));
6554 ui_out_text (uiout, " evals)");
6556 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
6559 if (!part_of_multiple && b->thread != -1)
6561 /* FIXME should make an annotation for this. */
6562 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tstop only in thread ");
6563 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
6564 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "thread", b->thread);
6567 struct thread_info *thr = find_thread_global_id (b->thread);
6569 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "thread", print_thread_id (thr));
6571 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
6574 if (!part_of_multiple)
6578 /* FIXME should make an annotation for this. */
6579 if (is_catchpoint (b))
6580 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tcatchpoint");
6581 else if (is_tracepoint (b))
6582 ui_out_text (uiout, "\ttracepoint");
6584 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tbreakpoint");
6585 ui_out_text (uiout, " already hit ");
6586 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "times", b->hit_count);
6587 if (b->hit_count == 1)
6588 ui_out_text (uiout, " time\n");
6590 ui_out_text (uiout, " times\n");
6594 /* Output the count also if it is zero, but only if this is mi. */
6595 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
6596 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "times", b->hit_count);
6600 if (!part_of_multiple && b->ignore_count)
6603 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tignore next ");
6604 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "ignore", b->ignore_count);
6605 ui_out_text (uiout, " hits\n");
6608 /* Note that an enable count of 1 corresponds to "enable once"
6609 behavior, which is reported by the combination of enablement and
6610 disposition, so we don't need to mention it here. */
6611 if (!part_of_multiple && b->enable_count > 1)
6614 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tdisable after ");
6615 /* Tweak the wording to clarify that ignore and enable counts
6616 are distinct, and have additive effect. */
6617 if (b->ignore_count)
6618 ui_out_text (uiout, "additional ");
6620 ui_out_text (uiout, "next ");
6621 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "enable", b->enable_count);
6622 ui_out_text (uiout, " hits\n");
6625 if (!part_of_multiple && is_tracepoint (b))
6627 struct tracepoint *tp = (struct tracepoint *) b;
6629 if (tp->traceframe_usage)
6631 ui_out_text (uiout, "\ttrace buffer usage ");
6632 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "traceframe-usage", tp->traceframe_usage);
6633 ui_out_text (uiout, " bytes\n");
6637 l = b->commands ? b->commands->commands : NULL;
6638 if (!part_of_multiple && l)
6640 struct cleanup *script_chain;
6643 script_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "script");
6644 print_command_lines (uiout, l, 4);
6645 do_cleanups (script_chain);
6648 if (is_tracepoint (b))
6650 struct tracepoint *t = (struct tracepoint *) b;
6652 if (!part_of_multiple && t->pass_count)
6654 annotate_field (10);
6655 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tpass count ");
6656 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "pass", t->pass_count);
6657 ui_out_text (uiout, " \n");
6660 /* Don't display it when tracepoint or tracepoint location is
6662 if (!header_of_multiple && loc != NULL && !loc->shlib_disabled)
6664 annotate_field (11);
6666 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
6667 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "installed",
6668 loc->inserted ? "y" : "n");
6672 ui_out_text (uiout, "\t");
6674 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tnot ");
6675 ui_out_text (uiout, "installed on target\n");
6680 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout) && !part_of_multiple)
6682 if (is_watchpoint (b))
6684 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
6686 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "original-location", w->exp_string);
6688 else if (b->location != NULL
6689 && event_location_to_string (b->location) != NULL)
6690 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "original-location",
6691 event_location_to_string (b->location));
6696 print_one_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b,
6697 struct bp_location **last_loc,
6700 struct cleanup *bkpt_chain;
6701 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
6703 bkpt_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "bkpt");
6705 print_one_breakpoint_location (b, NULL, 0, last_loc, allflag);
6706 do_cleanups (bkpt_chain);
6708 /* If this breakpoint has custom print function,
6709 it's already printed. Otherwise, print individual
6710 locations, if any. */
6711 if (b->ops == NULL || b->ops->print_one == NULL)
6713 /* If breakpoint has a single location that is disabled, we
6714 print it as if it had several locations, since otherwise it's
6715 hard to represent "breakpoint enabled, location disabled"
6718 Note that while hardware watchpoints have several locations
6719 internally, that's not a property exposed to user. */
6721 && !is_hardware_watchpoint (b)
6722 && (b->loc->next || !b->loc->enabled))
6724 struct bp_location *loc;
6727 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next, ++n)
6729 struct cleanup *inner2 =
6730 make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, NULL);
6731 print_one_breakpoint_location (b, loc, n, last_loc, allflag);
6732 do_cleanups (inner2);
6739 breakpoint_address_bits (struct breakpoint *b)
6741 int print_address_bits = 0;
6742 struct bp_location *loc;
6744 /* Software watchpoints that aren't watching memory don't have an
6745 address to print. */
6746 if (is_no_memory_software_watchpoint (b))
6749 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
6753 addr_bit = gdbarch_addr_bit (loc->gdbarch);
6754 if (addr_bit > print_address_bits)
6755 print_address_bits = addr_bit;
6758 return print_address_bits;
6761 struct captured_breakpoint_query_args
6767 do_captured_breakpoint_query (struct ui_out *uiout, void *data)
6769 struct captured_breakpoint_query_args *args
6770 = (struct captured_breakpoint_query_args *) data;
6771 struct breakpoint *b;
6772 struct bp_location *dummy_loc = NULL;
6776 if (args->bnum == b->number)
6778 print_one_breakpoint (b, &dummy_loc, 0);
6786 gdb_breakpoint_query (struct ui_out *uiout, int bnum,
6787 char **error_message)
6789 struct captured_breakpoint_query_args args;
6792 /* For the moment we don't trust print_one_breakpoint() to not throw
6794 if (catch_exceptions_with_msg (uiout, do_captured_breakpoint_query, &args,
6795 error_message, RETURN_MASK_ALL) < 0)
6801 /* Return true if this breakpoint was set by the user, false if it is
6802 internal or momentary. */
6805 user_breakpoint_p (struct breakpoint *b)
6807 return b->number > 0;
6810 /* See breakpoint.h. */
6813 pending_breakpoint_p (struct breakpoint *b)
6815 return b->loc == NULL;
6818 /* Print information on user settable breakpoint (watchpoint, etc)
6819 number BNUM. If BNUM is -1 print all user-settable breakpoints.
6820 If ALLFLAG is non-zero, include non-user-settable breakpoints. If
6821 FILTER is non-NULL, call it on each breakpoint and only include the
6822 ones for which it returns non-zero. Return the total number of
6823 breakpoints listed. */
6826 breakpoint_1 (char *args, int allflag,
6827 int (*filter) (const struct breakpoint *))
6829 struct breakpoint *b;
6830 struct bp_location *last_loc = NULL;
6831 int nr_printable_breakpoints;
6832 struct cleanup *bkpttbl_chain;
6833 struct value_print_options opts;
6834 int print_address_bits = 0;
6835 int print_type_col_width = 14;
6836 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
6838 get_user_print_options (&opts);
6840 /* Compute the number of rows in the table, as well as the size
6841 required for address fields. */
6842 nr_printable_breakpoints = 0;
6845 /* If we have a filter, only list the breakpoints it accepts. */
6846 if (filter && !filter (b))
6849 /* If we have an "args" string, it is a list of breakpoints to
6850 accept. Skip the others. */
6851 if (args != NULL && *args != '\0')
6853 if (allflag && parse_and_eval_long (args) != b->number)
6855 if (!allflag && !number_is_in_list (args, b->number))
6859 if (allflag || user_breakpoint_p (b))
6861 int addr_bit, type_len;
6863 addr_bit = breakpoint_address_bits (b);
6864 if (addr_bit > print_address_bits)
6865 print_address_bits = addr_bit;
6867 type_len = strlen (bptype_string (b->type));
6868 if (type_len > print_type_col_width)
6869 print_type_col_width = type_len;
6871 nr_printable_breakpoints++;
6875 if (opts.addressprint)
6877 = make_cleanup_ui_out_table_begin_end (uiout, 6,
6878 nr_printable_breakpoints,
6882 = make_cleanup_ui_out_table_begin_end (uiout, 5,
6883 nr_printable_breakpoints,
6886 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
6887 annotate_breakpoints_headers ();
6888 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
6890 ui_out_table_header (uiout, 7, ui_left, "number", "Num"); /* 1 */
6891 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
6893 ui_out_table_header (uiout, print_type_col_width, ui_left,
6894 "type", "Type"); /* 2 */
6895 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
6897 ui_out_table_header (uiout, 4, ui_left, "disp", "Disp"); /* 3 */
6898 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
6900 ui_out_table_header (uiout, 3, ui_left, "enabled", "Enb"); /* 4 */
6901 if (opts.addressprint)
6903 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
6905 if (print_address_bits <= 32)
6906 ui_out_table_header (uiout, 10, ui_left,
6907 "addr", "Address"); /* 5 */
6909 ui_out_table_header (uiout, 18, ui_left,
6910 "addr", "Address"); /* 5 */
6912 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
6914 ui_out_table_header (uiout, 40, ui_noalign, "what", "What"); /* 6 */
6915 ui_out_table_body (uiout);
6916 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
6917 annotate_breakpoints_table ();
6922 /* If we have a filter, only list the breakpoints it accepts. */
6923 if (filter && !filter (b))
6926 /* If we have an "args" string, it is a list of breakpoints to
6927 accept. Skip the others. */
6929 if (args != NULL && *args != '\0')
6931 if (allflag) /* maintenance info breakpoint */
6933 if (parse_and_eval_long (args) != b->number)
6936 else /* all others */
6938 if (!number_is_in_list (args, b->number))
6942 /* We only print out user settable breakpoints unless the
6944 if (allflag || user_breakpoint_p (b))
6945 print_one_breakpoint (b, &last_loc, allflag);
6948 do_cleanups (bkpttbl_chain);
6950 if (nr_printable_breakpoints == 0)
6952 /* If there's a filter, let the caller decide how to report
6956 if (args == NULL || *args == '\0')
6957 ui_out_message (uiout, "No breakpoints or watchpoints.\n");
6959 ui_out_message (uiout,
6960 "No breakpoint or watchpoint matching '%s'.\n",
6966 if (last_loc && !server_command)
6967 set_next_address (last_loc->gdbarch, last_loc->address);
6970 /* FIXME? Should this be moved up so that it is only called when
6971 there have been breakpoints? */
6972 annotate_breakpoints_table_end ();
6974 return nr_printable_breakpoints;
6977 /* Display the value of default-collect in a way that is generally
6978 compatible with the breakpoint list. */
6981 default_collect_info (void)
6983 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
6985 /* If it has no value (which is frequently the case), say nothing; a
6986 message like "No default-collect." gets in user's face when it's
6988 if (!*default_collect)
6991 /* The following phrase lines up nicely with per-tracepoint collect
6993 ui_out_text (uiout, "default collect ");
6994 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "default-collect", default_collect);
6995 ui_out_text (uiout, " \n");
6999 breakpoints_info (char *args, int from_tty)
7001 breakpoint_1 (args, 0, NULL);
7003 default_collect_info ();
7007 watchpoints_info (char *args, int from_tty)
7009 int num_printed = breakpoint_1 (args, 0, is_watchpoint);
7010 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
7012 if (num_printed == 0)
7014 if (args == NULL || *args == '\0')
7015 ui_out_message (uiout, "No watchpoints.\n");
7017 ui_out_message (uiout, "No watchpoint matching '%s'.\n", args);
7022 maintenance_info_breakpoints (char *args, int from_tty)
7024 breakpoint_1 (args, 1, NULL);
7026 default_collect_info ();
7030 breakpoint_has_pc (struct breakpoint *b,
7031 struct program_space *pspace,
7032 CORE_ADDR pc, struct obj_section *section)
7034 struct bp_location *bl = b->loc;
7036 for (; bl; bl = bl->next)
7038 if (bl->pspace == pspace
7039 && bl->address == pc
7040 && (!overlay_debugging || bl->section == section))
7046 /* Print a message describing any user-breakpoints set at PC. This
7047 concerns with logical breakpoints, so we match program spaces, not
7051 describe_other_breakpoints (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
7052 struct program_space *pspace, CORE_ADDR pc,
7053 struct obj_section *section, int thread)
7056 struct breakpoint *b;
7059 others += (user_breakpoint_p (b)
7060 && breakpoint_has_pc (b, pspace, pc, section));
7064 printf_filtered (_("Note: breakpoint "));
7065 else /* if (others == ???) */
7066 printf_filtered (_("Note: breakpoints "));
7068 if (user_breakpoint_p (b) && breakpoint_has_pc (b, pspace, pc, section))
7071 printf_filtered ("%d", b->number);
7072 if (b->thread == -1 && thread != -1)
7073 printf_filtered (" (all threads)");
7074 else if (b->thread != -1)
7075 printf_filtered (" (thread %d)", b->thread);
7076 printf_filtered ("%s%s ",
7077 ((b->enable_state == bp_disabled
7078 || b->enable_state == bp_call_disabled)
7082 : ((others == 1) ? " and" : ""));
7084 printf_filtered (_("also set at pc "));
7085 fputs_filtered (paddress (gdbarch, pc), gdb_stdout);
7086 printf_filtered (".\n");
7091 /* Return true iff it is meaningful to use the address member of
7092 BPT locations. For some breakpoint types, the locations' address members
7093 are irrelevant and it makes no sense to attempt to compare them to other
7094 addresses (or use them for any other purpose either).
7096 More specifically, each of the following breakpoint types will
7097 always have a zero valued location address and we don't want to mark
7098 breakpoints of any of these types to be a duplicate of an actual
7099 breakpoint location at address zero:
7107 breakpoint_address_is_meaningful (struct breakpoint *bpt)
7109 enum bptype type = bpt->type;
7111 return (type != bp_watchpoint && type != bp_catchpoint);
7114 /* Assuming LOC1 and LOC2's owners are hardware watchpoints, returns
7115 true if LOC1 and LOC2 represent the same watchpoint location. */
7118 watchpoint_locations_match (struct bp_location *loc1,
7119 struct bp_location *loc2)
7121 struct watchpoint *w1 = (struct watchpoint *) loc1->owner;
7122 struct watchpoint *w2 = (struct watchpoint *) loc2->owner;
7124 /* Both of them must exist. */
7125 gdb_assert (w1 != NULL);
7126 gdb_assert (w2 != NULL);
7128 /* If the target can evaluate the condition expression in hardware,
7129 then we we need to insert both watchpoints even if they are at
7130 the same place. Otherwise the watchpoint will only trigger when
7131 the condition of whichever watchpoint was inserted evaluates to
7132 true, not giving a chance for GDB to check the condition of the
7133 other watchpoint. */
7135 && target_can_accel_watchpoint_condition (loc1->address,
7137 loc1->watchpoint_type,
7138 w1->cond_exp.get ()))
7140 && target_can_accel_watchpoint_condition (loc2->address,
7142 loc2->watchpoint_type,
7143 w2->cond_exp.get ())))
7146 /* Note that this checks the owner's type, not the location's. In
7147 case the target does not support read watchpoints, but does
7148 support access watchpoints, we'll have bp_read_watchpoint
7149 watchpoints with hw_access locations. Those should be considered
7150 duplicates of hw_read locations. The hw_read locations will
7151 become hw_access locations later. */
7152 return (loc1->owner->type == loc2->owner->type
7153 && loc1->pspace->aspace == loc2->pspace->aspace
7154 && loc1->address == loc2->address
7155 && loc1->length == loc2->length);
7158 /* See breakpoint.h. */
7161 breakpoint_address_match (struct address_space *aspace1, CORE_ADDR addr1,
7162 struct address_space *aspace2, CORE_ADDR addr2)
7164 return ((gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ())
7165 || aspace1 == aspace2)
7169 /* Returns true if {ASPACE2,ADDR2} falls within the range determined by
7170 {ASPACE1,ADDR1,LEN1}. In most targets, this can only be true if ASPACE1
7171 matches ASPACE2. On targets that have global breakpoints, the address
7172 space doesn't really matter. */
7175 breakpoint_address_match_range (struct address_space *aspace1, CORE_ADDR addr1,
7176 int len1, struct address_space *aspace2,
7179 return ((gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ())
7180 || aspace1 == aspace2)
7181 && addr2 >= addr1 && addr2 < addr1 + len1);
7184 /* Returns true if {ASPACE,ADDR} matches the breakpoint BL. BL may be
7185 a ranged breakpoint. In most targets, a match happens only if ASPACE
7186 matches the breakpoint's address space. On targets that have global
7187 breakpoints, the address space doesn't really matter. */
7190 breakpoint_location_address_match (struct bp_location *bl,
7191 struct address_space *aspace,
7194 return (breakpoint_address_match (bl->pspace->aspace, bl->address,
7197 && breakpoint_address_match_range (bl->pspace->aspace,
7198 bl->address, bl->length,
7202 /* Returns true if the [ADDR,ADDR+LEN) range in ASPACE overlaps
7203 breakpoint BL. BL may be a ranged breakpoint. In most targets, a
7204 match happens only if ASPACE matches the breakpoint's address
7205 space. On targets that have global breakpoints, the address space
7206 doesn't really matter. */
7209 breakpoint_location_address_range_overlap (struct bp_location *bl,
7210 struct address_space *aspace,
7211 CORE_ADDR addr, int len)
7213 if (gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ())
7214 || bl->pspace->aspace == aspace)
7216 int bl_len = bl->length != 0 ? bl->length : 1;
7218 if (mem_ranges_overlap (addr, len, bl->address, bl_len))
7224 /* If LOC1 and LOC2's owners are not tracepoints, returns false directly.
7225 Then, if LOC1 and LOC2 represent the same tracepoint location, returns
7226 true, otherwise returns false. */
7229 tracepoint_locations_match (struct bp_location *loc1,
7230 struct bp_location *loc2)
7232 if (is_tracepoint (loc1->owner) && is_tracepoint (loc2->owner))
7233 /* Since tracepoint locations are never duplicated with others', tracepoint
7234 locations at the same address of different tracepoints are regarded as
7235 different locations. */
7236 return (loc1->address == loc2->address && loc1->owner == loc2->owner);
7241 /* Assuming LOC1 and LOC2's types' have meaningful target addresses
7242 (breakpoint_address_is_meaningful), returns true if LOC1 and LOC2
7243 represent the same location. */
7246 breakpoint_locations_match (struct bp_location *loc1,
7247 struct bp_location *loc2)
7249 int hw_point1, hw_point2;
7251 /* Both of them must not be in moribund_locations. */
7252 gdb_assert (loc1->owner != NULL);
7253 gdb_assert (loc2->owner != NULL);
7255 hw_point1 = is_hardware_watchpoint (loc1->owner);
7256 hw_point2 = is_hardware_watchpoint (loc2->owner);
7258 if (hw_point1 != hw_point2)
7261 return watchpoint_locations_match (loc1, loc2);
7262 else if (is_tracepoint (loc1->owner) || is_tracepoint (loc2->owner))
7263 return tracepoint_locations_match (loc1, loc2);
7265 /* We compare bp_location.length in order to cover ranged breakpoints. */
7266 return (breakpoint_address_match (loc1->pspace->aspace, loc1->address,
7267 loc2->pspace->aspace, loc2->address)
7268 && loc1->length == loc2->length);
7272 breakpoint_adjustment_warning (CORE_ADDR from_addr, CORE_ADDR to_addr,
7273 int bnum, int have_bnum)
7275 /* The longest string possibly returned by hex_string_custom
7276 is 50 chars. These must be at least that big for safety. */
7280 strcpy (astr1, hex_string_custom ((unsigned long) from_addr, 8));
7281 strcpy (astr2, hex_string_custom ((unsigned long) to_addr, 8));
7283 warning (_("Breakpoint %d address previously adjusted from %s to %s."),
7284 bnum, astr1, astr2);
7286 warning (_("Breakpoint address adjusted from %s to %s."), astr1, astr2);
7289 /* Adjust a breakpoint's address to account for architectural
7290 constraints on breakpoint placement. Return the adjusted address.
7291 Note: Very few targets require this kind of adjustment. For most
7292 targets, this function is simply the identity function. */
7295 adjust_breakpoint_address (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
7296 CORE_ADDR bpaddr, enum bptype bptype)
7298 if (!gdbarch_adjust_breakpoint_address_p (gdbarch))
7300 /* Very few targets need any kind of breakpoint adjustment. */
7303 else if (bptype == bp_watchpoint
7304 || bptype == bp_hardware_watchpoint
7305 || bptype == bp_read_watchpoint
7306 || bptype == bp_access_watchpoint
7307 || bptype == bp_catchpoint)
7309 /* Watchpoints and the various bp_catch_* eventpoints should not
7310 have their addresses modified. */
7313 else if (bptype == bp_single_step)
7315 /* Single-step breakpoints should not have their addresses
7316 modified. If there's any architectural constrain that
7317 applies to this address, then it should have already been
7318 taken into account when the breakpoint was created in the
7319 first place. If we didn't do this, stepping through e.g.,
7320 Thumb-2 IT blocks would break. */
7325 CORE_ADDR adjusted_bpaddr;
7327 /* Some targets have architectural constraints on the placement
7328 of breakpoint instructions. Obtain the adjusted address. */
7329 adjusted_bpaddr = gdbarch_adjust_breakpoint_address (gdbarch, bpaddr);
7331 /* An adjusted breakpoint address can significantly alter
7332 a user's expectations. Print a warning if an adjustment
7334 if (adjusted_bpaddr != bpaddr)
7335 breakpoint_adjustment_warning (bpaddr, adjusted_bpaddr, 0, 0);
7337 return adjusted_bpaddr;
7342 init_bp_location (struct bp_location *loc, const struct bp_location_ops *ops,
7343 struct breakpoint *owner)
7345 memset (loc, 0, sizeof (*loc));
7347 gdb_assert (ops != NULL);
7351 loc->cond_bytecode = NULL;
7352 loc->shlib_disabled = 0;
7355 switch (owner->type)
7358 case bp_single_step:
7362 case bp_longjmp_resume:
7363 case bp_longjmp_call_dummy:
7365 case bp_exception_resume:
7366 case bp_step_resume:
7367 case bp_hp_step_resume:
7368 case bp_watchpoint_scope:
7370 case bp_std_terminate:
7371 case bp_shlib_event:
7372 case bp_thread_event:
7373 case bp_overlay_event:
7375 case bp_longjmp_master:
7376 case bp_std_terminate_master:
7377 case bp_exception_master:
7378 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver:
7379 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver_return:
7381 loc->loc_type = bp_loc_software_breakpoint;
7382 mark_breakpoint_location_modified (loc);
7384 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
7385 loc->loc_type = bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint;
7386 mark_breakpoint_location_modified (loc);
7388 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
7389 case bp_read_watchpoint:
7390 case bp_access_watchpoint:
7391 loc->loc_type = bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint;
7396 case bp_fast_tracepoint:
7397 case bp_static_tracepoint:
7398 loc->loc_type = bp_loc_other;
7401 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__, _("unknown breakpoint type"));
7407 /* Allocate a struct bp_location. */
7409 static struct bp_location *
7410 allocate_bp_location (struct breakpoint *bpt)
7412 return bpt->ops->allocate_location (bpt);
7416 free_bp_location (struct bp_location *loc)
7418 loc->ops->dtor (loc);
7422 /* Increment reference count. */
7425 incref_bp_location (struct bp_location *bl)
7430 /* Decrement reference count. If the reference count reaches 0,
7431 destroy the bp_location. Sets *BLP to NULL. */
7434 decref_bp_location (struct bp_location **blp)
7436 gdb_assert ((*blp)->refc > 0);
7438 if (--(*blp)->refc == 0)
7439 free_bp_location (*blp);
7443 /* Add breakpoint B at the end of the global breakpoint chain. */
7446 add_to_breakpoint_chain (struct breakpoint *b)
7448 struct breakpoint *b1;
7450 /* Add this breakpoint to the end of the chain so that a list of
7451 breakpoints will come out in order of increasing numbers. */
7453 b1 = breakpoint_chain;
7455 breakpoint_chain = b;
7464 /* Initializes breakpoint B with type BPTYPE and no locations yet. */
7467 init_raw_breakpoint_without_location (struct breakpoint *b,
7468 struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
7470 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
7472 memset (b, 0, sizeof (*b));
7474 gdb_assert (ops != NULL);
7478 b->gdbarch = gdbarch;
7479 b->language = current_language->la_language;
7480 b->input_radix = input_radix;
7482 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
7485 b->ignore_count = 0;
7487 b->frame_id = null_frame_id;
7488 b->condition_not_parsed = 0;
7489 b->py_bp_object = NULL;
7490 b->related_breakpoint = b;
7494 /* Helper to set_raw_breakpoint below. Creates a breakpoint
7495 that has type BPTYPE and has no locations as yet. */
7497 static struct breakpoint *
7498 set_raw_breakpoint_without_location (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
7500 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
7502 struct breakpoint *b = new breakpoint ();
7504 init_raw_breakpoint_without_location (b, gdbarch, bptype, ops);
7505 add_to_breakpoint_chain (b);
7509 /* Initialize loc->function_name. EXPLICIT_LOC says no indirect function
7510 resolutions should be made as the user specified the location explicitly
7514 set_breakpoint_location_function (struct bp_location *loc, int explicit_loc)
7516 gdb_assert (loc->owner != NULL);
7518 if (loc->owner->type == bp_breakpoint
7519 || loc->owner->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint
7520 || is_tracepoint (loc->owner))
7523 const char *function_name;
7524 CORE_ADDR func_addr;
7526 find_pc_partial_function_gnu_ifunc (loc->address, &function_name,
7527 &func_addr, NULL, &is_gnu_ifunc);
7529 if (is_gnu_ifunc && !explicit_loc)
7531 struct breakpoint *b = loc->owner;
7533 gdb_assert (loc->pspace == current_program_space);
7534 if (gnu_ifunc_resolve_name (function_name,
7535 &loc->requested_address))
7537 /* Recalculate ADDRESS based on new REQUESTED_ADDRESS. */
7538 loc->address = adjust_breakpoint_address (loc->gdbarch,
7539 loc->requested_address,
7542 else if (b->type == bp_breakpoint && b->loc == loc
7543 && loc->next == NULL && b->related_breakpoint == b)
7545 /* Create only the whole new breakpoint of this type but do not
7546 mess more complicated breakpoints with multiple locations. */
7547 b->type = bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver;
7548 /* Remember the resolver's address for use by the return
7550 loc->related_address = func_addr;
7555 loc->function_name = xstrdup (function_name);
7559 /* Attempt to determine architecture of location identified by SAL. */
7561 get_sal_arch (struct symtab_and_line sal)
7564 return get_objfile_arch (sal.section->objfile);
7566 return get_objfile_arch (SYMTAB_OBJFILE (sal.symtab));
7571 /* Low level routine for partially initializing a breakpoint of type
7572 BPTYPE. The newly created breakpoint's address, section, source
7573 file name, and line number are provided by SAL.
7575 It is expected that the caller will complete the initialization of
7576 the newly created breakpoint struct as well as output any status
7577 information regarding the creation of a new breakpoint. */
7580 init_raw_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b, struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
7581 struct symtab_and_line sal, enum bptype bptype,
7582 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
7584 init_raw_breakpoint_without_location (b, gdbarch, bptype, ops);
7586 add_location_to_breakpoint (b, &sal);
7588 if (bptype != bp_catchpoint)
7589 gdb_assert (sal.pspace != NULL);
7591 /* Store the program space that was used to set the breakpoint,
7592 except for ordinary breakpoints, which are independent of the
7594 if (bptype != bp_breakpoint && bptype != bp_hardware_breakpoint)
7595 b->pspace = sal.pspace;
7598 /* set_raw_breakpoint is a low level routine for allocating and
7599 partially initializing a breakpoint of type BPTYPE. The newly
7600 created breakpoint's address, section, source file name, and line
7601 number are provided by SAL. The newly created and partially
7602 initialized breakpoint is added to the breakpoint chain and
7603 is also returned as the value of this function.
7605 It is expected that the caller will complete the initialization of
7606 the newly created breakpoint struct as well as output any status
7607 information regarding the creation of a new breakpoint. In
7608 particular, set_raw_breakpoint does NOT set the breakpoint
7609 number! Care should be taken to not allow an error to occur
7610 prior to completing the initialization of the breakpoint. If this
7611 should happen, a bogus breakpoint will be left on the chain. */
7614 set_raw_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
7615 struct symtab_and_line sal, enum bptype bptype,
7616 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
7618 struct breakpoint *b = new breakpoint ();
7620 init_raw_breakpoint (b, gdbarch, sal, bptype, ops);
7621 add_to_breakpoint_chain (b);
7625 /* Call this routine when stepping and nexting to enable a breakpoint
7626 if we do a longjmp() or 'throw' in TP. FRAME is the frame which
7627 initiated the operation. */
7630 set_longjmp_breakpoint (struct thread_info *tp, struct frame_id frame)
7632 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
7633 int thread = tp->global_num;
7635 /* To avoid having to rescan all objfile symbols at every step,
7636 we maintain a list of continually-inserted but always disabled
7637 longjmp "master" breakpoints. Here, we simply create momentary
7638 clones of those and enable them for the requested thread. */
7639 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
7640 if (b->pspace == current_program_space
7641 && (b->type == bp_longjmp_master
7642 || b->type == bp_exception_master))
7644 enum bptype type = b->type == bp_longjmp_master ? bp_longjmp : bp_exception;
7645 struct breakpoint *clone;
7647 /* longjmp_breakpoint_ops ensures INITIATING_FRAME is cleared again
7648 after their removal. */
7649 clone = momentary_breakpoint_from_master (b, type,
7650 &longjmp_breakpoint_ops, 1);
7651 clone->thread = thread;
7654 tp->initiating_frame = frame;
7657 /* Delete all longjmp breakpoints from THREAD. */
7659 delete_longjmp_breakpoint (int thread)
7661 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
7663 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
7664 if (b->type == bp_longjmp || b->type == bp_exception)
7666 if (b->thread == thread)
7667 delete_breakpoint (b);
7672 delete_longjmp_breakpoint_at_next_stop (int thread)
7674 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
7676 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
7677 if (b->type == bp_longjmp || b->type == bp_exception)
7679 if (b->thread == thread)
7680 b->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
7684 /* Place breakpoints of type bp_longjmp_call_dummy to catch longjmp for
7685 INFERIOR_PTID thread. Chain them all by RELATED_BREAKPOINT and return
7686 pointer to any of them. Return NULL if this system cannot place longjmp
7690 set_longjmp_breakpoint_for_call_dummy (void)
7692 struct breakpoint *b, *retval = NULL;
7695 if (b->pspace == current_program_space && b->type == bp_longjmp_master)
7697 struct breakpoint *new_b;
7699 new_b = momentary_breakpoint_from_master (b, bp_longjmp_call_dummy,
7700 &momentary_breakpoint_ops,
7702 new_b->thread = ptid_to_global_thread_id (inferior_ptid);
7704 /* Link NEW_B into the chain of RETVAL breakpoints. */
7706 gdb_assert (new_b->related_breakpoint == new_b);
7709 new_b->related_breakpoint = retval;
7710 while (retval->related_breakpoint != new_b->related_breakpoint)
7711 retval = retval->related_breakpoint;
7712 retval->related_breakpoint = new_b;
7718 /* Verify all existing dummy frames and their associated breakpoints for
7719 TP. Remove those which can no longer be found in the current frame
7722 You should call this function only at places where it is safe to currently
7723 unwind the whole stack. Failed stack unwind would discard live dummy
7727 check_longjmp_breakpoint_for_call_dummy (struct thread_info *tp)
7729 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
7731 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
7732 if (b->type == bp_longjmp_call_dummy && b->thread == tp->global_num)
7734 struct breakpoint *dummy_b = b->related_breakpoint;
7736 while (dummy_b != b && dummy_b->type != bp_call_dummy)
7737 dummy_b = dummy_b->related_breakpoint;
7738 if (dummy_b->type != bp_call_dummy
7739 || frame_find_by_id (dummy_b->frame_id) != NULL)
7742 dummy_frame_discard (dummy_b->frame_id, tp->ptid);
7744 while (b->related_breakpoint != b)
7746 if (b_tmp == b->related_breakpoint)
7747 b_tmp = b->related_breakpoint->next;
7748 delete_breakpoint (b->related_breakpoint);
7750 delete_breakpoint (b);
7755 enable_overlay_breakpoints (void)
7757 struct breakpoint *b;
7760 if (b->type == bp_overlay_event)
7762 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
7763 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
7764 overlay_events_enabled = 1;
7769 disable_overlay_breakpoints (void)
7771 struct breakpoint *b;
7774 if (b->type == bp_overlay_event)
7776 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
7777 update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT);
7778 overlay_events_enabled = 0;
7782 /* Set an active std::terminate breakpoint for each std::terminate
7783 master breakpoint. */
7785 set_std_terminate_breakpoint (void)
7787 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
7789 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
7790 if (b->pspace == current_program_space
7791 && b->type == bp_std_terminate_master)
7793 momentary_breakpoint_from_master (b, bp_std_terminate,
7794 &momentary_breakpoint_ops, 1);
7798 /* Delete all the std::terminate breakpoints. */
7800 delete_std_terminate_breakpoint (void)
7802 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
7804 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
7805 if (b->type == bp_std_terminate)
7806 delete_breakpoint (b);
7810 create_thread_event_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address)
7812 struct breakpoint *b;
7814 b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, address, bp_thread_event,
7815 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
7817 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
7818 /* location has to be used or breakpoint_re_set will delete me. */
7819 b->location = new_address_location (b->loc->address, NULL, 0);
7821 update_global_location_list_nothrow (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
7826 struct lang_and_radix
7832 /* Create a breakpoint for JIT code registration and unregistration. */
7835 create_jit_event_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address)
7837 return create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, address, bp_jit_event,
7838 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
7841 /* Remove JIT code registration and unregistration breakpoint(s). */
7844 remove_jit_event_breakpoints (void)
7846 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
7848 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
7849 if (b->type == bp_jit_event
7850 && b->loc->pspace == current_program_space)
7851 delete_breakpoint (b);
7855 remove_solib_event_breakpoints (void)
7857 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
7859 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
7860 if (b->type == bp_shlib_event
7861 && b->loc->pspace == current_program_space)
7862 delete_breakpoint (b);
7865 /* See breakpoint.h. */
7868 remove_solib_event_breakpoints_at_next_stop (void)
7870 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
7872 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
7873 if (b->type == bp_shlib_event
7874 && b->loc->pspace == current_program_space)
7875 b->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
7878 /* Helper for create_solib_event_breakpoint /
7879 create_and_insert_solib_event_breakpoint. Allows specifying which
7880 INSERT_MODE to pass through to update_global_location_list. */
7882 static struct breakpoint *
7883 create_solib_event_breakpoint_1 (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address,
7884 enum ugll_insert_mode insert_mode)
7886 struct breakpoint *b;
7888 b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, address, bp_shlib_event,
7889 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
7890 update_global_location_list_nothrow (insert_mode);
7895 create_solib_event_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address)
7897 return create_solib_event_breakpoint_1 (gdbarch, address, UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
7900 /* See breakpoint.h. */
7903 create_and_insert_solib_event_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address)
7905 struct breakpoint *b;
7907 /* Explicitly tell update_global_location_list to insert
7909 b = create_solib_event_breakpoint_1 (gdbarch, address, UGLL_INSERT);
7910 if (!b->loc->inserted)
7912 delete_breakpoint (b);
7918 /* Disable any breakpoints that are on code in shared libraries. Only
7919 apply to enabled breakpoints, disabled ones can just stay disabled. */
7922 disable_breakpoints_in_shlibs (void)
7924 struct bp_location *loc, **locp_tmp;
7926 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, locp_tmp)
7928 /* ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location has LOC->OWNER always non-NULL. */
7929 struct breakpoint *b = loc->owner;
7931 /* We apply the check to all breakpoints, including disabled for
7932 those with loc->duplicate set. This is so that when breakpoint
7933 becomes enabled, or the duplicate is removed, gdb will try to
7934 insert all breakpoints. If we don't set shlib_disabled here,
7935 we'll try to insert those breakpoints and fail. */
7936 if (((b->type == bp_breakpoint)
7937 || (b->type == bp_jit_event)
7938 || (b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
7939 || (is_tracepoint (b)))
7940 && loc->pspace == current_program_space
7941 && !loc->shlib_disabled
7942 && solib_name_from_address (loc->pspace, loc->address)
7945 loc->shlib_disabled = 1;
7950 /* Disable any breakpoints and tracepoints that are in SOLIB upon
7951 notification of unloaded_shlib. Only apply to enabled breakpoints,
7952 disabled ones can just stay disabled. */
7955 disable_breakpoints_in_unloaded_shlib (struct so_list *solib)
7957 struct bp_location *loc, **locp_tmp;
7958 int disabled_shlib_breaks = 0;
7960 /* SunOS a.out shared libraries are always mapped, so do not
7961 disable breakpoints; they will only be reported as unloaded
7962 through clear_solib when GDB discards its shared library
7963 list. See clear_solib for more information. */
7964 if (exec_bfd != NULL
7965 && bfd_get_flavour (exec_bfd) == bfd_target_aout_flavour)
7968 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, locp_tmp)
7970 /* ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location has LOC->OWNER always non-NULL. */
7971 struct breakpoint *b = loc->owner;
7973 if (solib->pspace == loc->pspace
7974 && !loc->shlib_disabled
7975 && (((b->type == bp_breakpoint
7976 || b->type == bp_jit_event
7977 || b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
7978 && (loc->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint
7979 || loc->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint))
7980 || is_tracepoint (b))
7981 && solib_contains_address_p (solib, loc->address))
7983 loc->shlib_disabled = 1;
7984 /* At this point, we cannot rely on remove_breakpoint
7985 succeeding so we must mark the breakpoint as not inserted
7986 to prevent future errors occurring in remove_breakpoints. */
7989 /* This may cause duplicate notifications for the same breakpoint. */
7990 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b);
7992 if (!disabled_shlib_breaks)
7994 target_terminal_ours_for_output ();
7995 warning (_("Temporarily disabling breakpoints "
7996 "for unloaded shared library \"%s\""),
7999 disabled_shlib_breaks = 1;
8004 /* Disable any breakpoints and tracepoints in OBJFILE upon
8005 notification of free_objfile. Only apply to enabled breakpoints,
8006 disabled ones can just stay disabled. */
8009 disable_breakpoints_in_freed_objfile (struct objfile *objfile)
8011 struct breakpoint *b;
8013 if (objfile == NULL)
8016 /* OBJF_SHARED|OBJF_USERLOADED objfiles are dynamic modules manually
8017 managed by the user with add-symbol-file/remove-symbol-file.
8018 Similarly to how breakpoints in shared libraries are handled in
8019 response to "nosharedlibrary", mark breakpoints in such modules
8020 shlib_disabled so they end up uninserted on the next global
8021 location list update. Shared libraries not loaded by the user
8022 aren't handled here -- they're already handled in
8023 disable_breakpoints_in_unloaded_shlib, called by solib.c's
8024 solib_unloaded observer. We skip objfiles that are not
8025 OBJF_SHARED as those aren't considered dynamic objects (e.g. the
8027 if ((objfile->flags & OBJF_SHARED) == 0
8028 || (objfile->flags & OBJF_USERLOADED) == 0)
8033 struct bp_location *loc;
8034 int bp_modified = 0;
8036 if (!is_breakpoint (b) && !is_tracepoint (b))
8039 for (loc = b->loc; loc != NULL; loc = loc->next)
8041 CORE_ADDR loc_addr = loc->address;
8043 if (loc->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint
8044 && loc->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint)
8047 if (loc->shlib_disabled != 0)
8050 if (objfile->pspace != loc->pspace)
8053 if (loc->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint
8054 && loc->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint)
8057 if (is_addr_in_objfile (loc_addr, objfile))
8059 loc->shlib_disabled = 1;
8060 /* At this point, we don't know whether the object was
8061 unmapped from the inferior or not, so leave the
8062 inserted flag alone. We'll handle failure to
8063 uninsert quietly, in case the object was indeed
8066 mark_breakpoint_location_modified (loc);
8073 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b);
8077 /* FORK & VFORK catchpoints. */
8079 /* An instance of this type is used to represent a fork or vfork
8080 catchpoint. It includes a "struct breakpoint" as a kind of base
8081 class; users downcast to "struct breakpoint *" when needed. A
8082 breakpoint is really of this type iff its ops pointer points to
8083 CATCH_FORK_BREAKPOINT_OPS. */
8085 struct fork_catchpoint
8087 /* The base class. */
8088 struct breakpoint base;
8090 /* Process id of a child process whose forking triggered this
8091 catchpoint. This field is only valid immediately after this
8092 catchpoint has triggered. */
8093 ptid_t forked_inferior_pid;
8096 /* Implement the "insert" breakpoint_ops method for fork
8100 insert_catch_fork (struct bp_location *bl)
8102 return target_insert_fork_catchpoint (ptid_get_pid (inferior_ptid));
8105 /* Implement the "remove" breakpoint_ops method for fork
8109 remove_catch_fork (struct bp_location *bl, enum remove_bp_reason reason)
8111 return target_remove_fork_catchpoint (ptid_get_pid (inferior_ptid));
8114 /* Implement the "breakpoint_hit" breakpoint_ops method for fork
8118 breakpoint_hit_catch_fork (const struct bp_location *bl,
8119 struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
8120 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
8122 struct fork_catchpoint *c = (struct fork_catchpoint *) bl->owner;
8124 if (ws->kind != TARGET_WAITKIND_FORKED)
8127 c->forked_inferior_pid = ws->value.related_pid;
8131 /* Implement the "print_it" breakpoint_ops method for fork
8134 static enum print_stop_action
8135 print_it_catch_fork (bpstat bs)
8137 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
8138 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
8139 struct fork_catchpoint *c = (struct fork_catchpoint *) bs->breakpoint_at;
8141 annotate_catchpoint (b->number);
8142 maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (uiout);
8143 if (b->disposition == disp_del)
8144 ui_out_text (uiout, "Temporary catchpoint ");
8146 ui_out_text (uiout, "Catchpoint ");
8147 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
8149 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "reason",
8150 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_FORK));
8151 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
8153 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "bkptno", b->number);
8154 ui_out_text (uiout, " (forked process ");
8155 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "newpid", ptid_get_pid (c->forked_inferior_pid));
8156 ui_out_text (uiout, "), ");
8157 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
8160 /* Implement the "print_one" breakpoint_ops method for fork
8164 print_one_catch_fork (struct breakpoint *b, struct bp_location **last_loc)
8166 struct fork_catchpoint *c = (struct fork_catchpoint *) b;
8167 struct value_print_options opts;
8168 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
8170 get_user_print_options (&opts);
8172 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns not
8173 line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect is relatively
8175 if (opts.addressprint)
8176 ui_out_field_skip (uiout, "addr");
8178 ui_out_text (uiout, "fork");
8179 if (!ptid_equal (c->forked_inferior_pid, null_ptid))
8181 ui_out_text (uiout, ", process ");
8182 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "what",
8183 ptid_get_pid (c->forked_inferior_pid));
8184 ui_out_spaces (uiout, 1);
8187 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
8188 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "catch-type", "fork");
8191 /* Implement the "print_mention" breakpoint_ops method for fork
8195 print_mention_catch_fork (struct breakpoint *b)
8197 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (fork)"), b->number);
8200 /* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for fork
8204 print_recreate_catch_fork (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
8206 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "catch fork");
8207 print_recreate_thread (b, fp);
8210 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in fork catchpoints. */
8212 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_fork_breakpoint_ops;
8214 /* Implement the "insert" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
8218 insert_catch_vfork (struct bp_location *bl)
8220 return target_insert_vfork_catchpoint (ptid_get_pid (inferior_ptid));
8223 /* Implement the "remove" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
8227 remove_catch_vfork (struct bp_location *bl, enum remove_bp_reason reason)
8229 return target_remove_vfork_catchpoint (ptid_get_pid (inferior_ptid));
8232 /* Implement the "breakpoint_hit" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
8236 breakpoint_hit_catch_vfork (const struct bp_location *bl,
8237 struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
8238 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
8240 struct fork_catchpoint *c = (struct fork_catchpoint *) bl->owner;
8242 if (ws->kind != TARGET_WAITKIND_VFORKED)
8245 c->forked_inferior_pid = ws->value.related_pid;
8249 /* Implement the "print_it" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
8252 static enum print_stop_action
8253 print_it_catch_vfork (bpstat bs)
8255 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
8256 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
8257 struct fork_catchpoint *c = (struct fork_catchpoint *) b;
8259 annotate_catchpoint (b->number);
8260 maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (uiout);
8261 if (b->disposition == disp_del)
8262 ui_out_text (uiout, "Temporary catchpoint ");
8264 ui_out_text (uiout, "Catchpoint ");
8265 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
8267 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "reason",
8268 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_VFORK));
8269 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
8271 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "bkptno", b->number);
8272 ui_out_text (uiout, " (vforked process ");
8273 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "newpid", ptid_get_pid (c->forked_inferior_pid));
8274 ui_out_text (uiout, "), ");
8275 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
8278 /* Implement the "print_one" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
8282 print_one_catch_vfork (struct breakpoint *b, struct bp_location **last_loc)
8284 struct fork_catchpoint *c = (struct fork_catchpoint *) b;
8285 struct value_print_options opts;
8286 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
8288 get_user_print_options (&opts);
8289 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns not
8290 line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect is relatively
8292 if (opts.addressprint)
8293 ui_out_field_skip (uiout, "addr");
8295 ui_out_text (uiout, "vfork");
8296 if (!ptid_equal (c->forked_inferior_pid, null_ptid))
8298 ui_out_text (uiout, ", process ");
8299 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "what",
8300 ptid_get_pid (c->forked_inferior_pid));
8301 ui_out_spaces (uiout, 1);
8304 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
8305 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "catch-type", "vfork");
8308 /* Implement the "print_mention" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
8312 print_mention_catch_vfork (struct breakpoint *b)
8314 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (vfork)"), b->number);
8317 /* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
8321 print_recreate_catch_vfork (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
8323 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "catch vfork");
8324 print_recreate_thread (b, fp);
8327 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in vfork catchpoints. */
8329 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_vfork_breakpoint_ops;
8331 /* An instance of this type is used to represent an solib catchpoint.
8332 It includes a "struct breakpoint" as a kind of base class; users
8333 downcast to "struct breakpoint *" when needed. A breakpoint is
8334 really of this type iff its ops pointer points to
8335 CATCH_SOLIB_BREAKPOINT_OPS. */
8337 struct solib_catchpoint
8339 /* The base class. */
8340 struct breakpoint base;
8342 /* True for "catch load", false for "catch unload". */
8343 unsigned char is_load;
8345 /* Regular expression to match, if any. COMPILED is only valid when
8346 REGEX is non-NULL. */
8352 dtor_catch_solib (struct breakpoint *b)
8354 struct solib_catchpoint *self = (struct solib_catchpoint *) b;
8357 regfree (&self->compiled);
8358 xfree (self->regex);
8360 base_breakpoint_ops.dtor (b);
8364 insert_catch_solib (struct bp_location *ignore)
8370 remove_catch_solib (struct bp_location *ignore, enum remove_bp_reason reason)
8376 breakpoint_hit_catch_solib (const struct bp_location *bl,
8377 struct address_space *aspace,
8379 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
8381 struct solib_catchpoint *self = (struct solib_catchpoint *) bl->owner;
8382 struct breakpoint *other;
8384 if (ws->kind == TARGET_WAITKIND_LOADED)
8387 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (other)
8389 struct bp_location *other_bl;
8391 if (other == bl->owner)
8394 if (other->type != bp_shlib_event)
8397 if (self->base.pspace != NULL && other->pspace != self->base.pspace)
8400 for (other_bl = other->loc; other_bl != NULL; other_bl = other_bl->next)
8402 if (other->ops->breakpoint_hit (other_bl, aspace, bp_addr, ws))
8411 check_status_catch_solib (struct bpstats *bs)
8413 struct solib_catchpoint *self
8414 = (struct solib_catchpoint *) bs->breakpoint_at;
8419 struct so_list *iter;
8422 VEC_iterate (so_list_ptr, current_program_space->added_solibs,
8427 || regexec (&self->compiled, iter->so_name, 0, NULL, 0) == 0)
8436 VEC_iterate (char_ptr, current_program_space->deleted_solibs,
8441 || regexec (&self->compiled, iter, 0, NULL, 0) == 0)
8447 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
8450 static enum print_stop_action
8451 print_it_catch_solib (bpstat bs)
8453 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
8454 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
8456 annotate_catchpoint (b->number);
8457 maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (uiout);
8458 if (b->disposition == disp_del)
8459 ui_out_text (uiout, "Temporary catchpoint ");
8461 ui_out_text (uiout, "Catchpoint ");
8462 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "bkptno", b->number);
8463 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
8464 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
8465 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
8466 print_solib_event (1);
8467 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
8471 print_one_catch_solib (struct breakpoint *b, struct bp_location **locs)
8473 struct solib_catchpoint *self = (struct solib_catchpoint *) b;
8474 struct value_print_options opts;
8475 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
8478 get_user_print_options (&opts);
8479 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns not
8480 line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect is relatively
8482 if (opts.addressprint)
8485 ui_out_field_skip (uiout, "addr");
8492 msg = xstrprintf (_("load of library matching %s"), self->regex);
8494 msg = xstrdup (_("load of library"));
8499 msg = xstrprintf (_("unload of library matching %s"), self->regex);
8501 msg = xstrdup (_("unload of library"));
8503 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "what", msg);
8506 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
8507 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "catch-type",
8508 self->is_load ? "load" : "unload");
8512 print_mention_catch_solib (struct breakpoint *b)
8514 struct solib_catchpoint *self = (struct solib_catchpoint *) b;
8516 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (%s)"), b->number,
8517 self->is_load ? "load" : "unload");
8521 print_recreate_catch_solib (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
8523 struct solib_catchpoint *self = (struct solib_catchpoint *) b;
8525 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "%s %s",
8526 b->disposition == disp_del ? "tcatch" : "catch",
8527 self->is_load ? "load" : "unload");
8529 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " %s", self->regex);
8530 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "\n");
8533 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_solib_breakpoint_ops;
8535 /* Shared helper function (MI and CLI) for creating and installing
8536 a shared object event catchpoint. If IS_LOAD is non-zero then
8537 the events to be caught are load events, otherwise they are
8538 unload events. If IS_TEMP is non-zero the catchpoint is a
8539 temporary one. If ENABLED is non-zero the catchpoint is
8540 created in an enabled state. */
8543 add_solib_catchpoint (char *arg, int is_load, int is_temp, int enabled)
8545 struct solib_catchpoint *c;
8546 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
8547 struct cleanup *cleanup;
8551 arg = skip_spaces (arg);
8553 c = new solib_catchpoint ();
8554 cleanup = make_cleanup (xfree, c);
8560 errcode = regcomp (&c->compiled, arg, REG_NOSUB);
8563 char *err = get_regcomp_error (errcode, &c->compiled);
8565 make_cleanup (xfree, err);
8566 error (_("Invalid regexp (%s): %s"), err, arg);
8568 c->regex = xstrdup (arg);
8571 c->is_load = is_load;
8572 init_catchpoint (&c->base, gdbarch, is_temp, NULL,
8573 &catch_solib_breakpoint_ops);
8575 c->base.enable_state = enabled ? bp_enabled : bp_disabled;
8577 discard_cleanups (cleanup);
8578 install_breakpoint (0, &c->base, 1);
8581 /* A helper function that does all the work for "catch load" and
8585 catch_load_or_unload (char *arg, int from_tty, int is_load,
8586 struct cmd_list_element *command)
8589 const int enabled = 1;
8591 tempflag = get_cmd_context (command) == CATCH_TEMPORARY;
8593 add_solib_catchpoint (arg, is_load, tempflag, enabled);
8597 catch_load_command_1 (char *arg, int from_tty,
8598 struct cmd_list_element *command)
8600 catch_load_or_unload (arg, from_tty, 1, command);
8604 catch_unload_command_1 (char *arg, int from_tty,
8605 struct cmd_list_element *command)
8607 catch_load_or_unload (arg, from_tty, 0, command);
8610 /* Initialize a new breakpoint of the bp_catchpoint kind. If TEMPFLAG
8611 is non-zero, then make the breakpoint temporary. If COND_STRING is
8612 not NULL, then store it in the breakpoint. OPS, if not NULL, is
8613 the breakpoint_ops structure associated to the catchpoint. */
8616 init_catchpoint (struct breakpoint *b,
8617 struct gdbarch *gdbarch, int tempflag,
8619 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
8621 struct symtab_and_line sal;
8624 sal.pspace = current_program_space;
8626 init_raw_breakpoint (b, gdbarch, sal, bp_catchpoint, ops);
8628 b->cond_string = (cond_string == NULL) ? NULL : xstrdup (cond_string);
8629 b->disposition = tempflag ? disp_del : disp_donttouch;
8633 install_breakpoint (int internal, struct breakpoint *b, int update_gll)
8635 add_to_breakpoint_chain (b);
8636 set_breakpoint_number (internal, b);
8637 if (is_tracepoint (b))
8638 set_tracepoint_count (breakpoint_count);
8641 observer_notify_breakpoint_created (b);
8644 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
8648 create_fork_vfork_event_catchpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
8649 int tempflag, char *cond_string,
8650 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
8652 struct fork_catchpoint *c = new fork_catchpoint ();
8654 init_catchpoint (&c->base, gdbarch, tempflag, cond_string, ops);
8656 c->forked_inferior_pid = null_ptid;
8658 install_breakpoint (0, &c->base, 1);
8661 /* Exec catchpoints. */
8663 /* An instance of this type is used to represent an exec catchpoint.
8664 It includes a "struct breakpoint" as a kind of base class; users
8665 downcast to "struct breakpoint *" when needed. A breakpoint is
8666 really of this type iff its ops pointer points to
8667 CATCH_EXEC_BREAKPOINT_OPS. */
8669 struct exec_catchpoint
8671 /* The base class. */
8672 struct breakpoint base;
8674 /* Filename of a program whose exec triggered this catchpoint.
8675 This field is only valid immediately after this catchpoint has
8677 char *exec_pathname;
8680 /* Implement the "dtor" breakpoint_ops method for exec
8684 dtor_catch_exec (struct breakpoint *b)
8686 struct exec_catchpoint *c = (struct exec_catchpoint *) b;
8688 xfree (c->exec_pathname);
8690 base_breakpoint_ops.dtor (b);
8694 insert_catch_exec (struct bp_location *bl)
8696 return target_insert_exec_catchpoint (ptid_get_pid (inferior_ptid));
8700 remove_catch_exec (struct bp_location *bl, enum remove_bp_reason reason)
8702 return target_remove_exec_catchpoint (ptid_get_pid (inferior_ptid));
8706 breakpoint_hit_catch_exec (const struct bp_location *bl,
8707 struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
8708 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
8710 struct exec_catchpoint *c = (struct exec_catchpoint *) bl->owner;
8712 if (ws->kind != TARGET_WAITKIND_EXECD)
8715 c->exec_pathname = xstrdup (ws->value.execd_pathname);
8719 static enum print_stop_action
8720 print_it_catch_exec (bpstat bs)
8722 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
8723 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
8724 struct exec_catchpoint *c = (struct exec_catchpoint *) b;
8726 annotate_catchpoint (b->number);
8727 maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (uiout);
8728 if (b->disposition == disp_del)
8729 ui_out_text (uiout, "Temporary catchpoint ");
8731 ui_out_text (uiout, "Catchpoint ");
8732 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
8734 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "reason",
8735 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_EXEC));
8736 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
8738 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "bkptno", b->number);
8739 ui_out_text (uiout, " (exec'd ");
8740 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "new-exec", c->exec_pathname);
8741 ui_out_text (uiout, "), ");
8743 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
8747 print_one_catch_exec (struct breakpoint *b, struct bp_location **last_loc)
8749 struct exec_catchpoint *c = (struct exec_catchpoint *) b;
8750 struct value_print_options opts;
8751 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
8753 get_user_print_options (&opts);
8755 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns
8756 not line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect
8757 is relatively readable). */
8758 if (opts.addressprint)
8759 ui_out_field_skip (uiout, "addr");
8761 ui_out_text (uiout, "exec");
8762 if (c->exec_pathname != NULL)
8764 ui_out_text (uiout, ", program \"");
8765 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "what", c->exec_pathname);
8766 ui_out_text (uiout, "\" ");
8769 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
8770 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "catch-type", "exec");
8774 print_mention_catch_exec (struct breakpoint *b)
8776 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (exec)"), b->number);
8779 /* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for exec
8783 print_recreate_catch_exec (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
8785 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "catch exec");
8786 print_recreate_thread (b, fp);
8789 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_exec_breakpoint_ops;
8792 hw_breakpoint_used_count (void)
8795 struct breakpoint *b;
8796 struct bp_location *bl;
8800 if (b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint && breakpoint_enabled (b))
8801 for (bl = b->loc; bl; bl = bl->next)
8803 /* Special types of hardware breakpoints may use more than
8805 i += b->ops->resources_needed (bl);
8812 /* Returns the resources B would use if it were a hardware
8816 hw_watchpoint_use_count (struct breakpoint *b)
8819 struct bp_location *bl;
8821 if (!breakpoint_enabled (b))
8824 for (bl = b->loc; bl; bl = bl->next)
8826 /* Special types of hardware watchpoints may use more than
8828 i += b->ops->resources_needed (bl);
8834 /* Returns the sum the used resources of all hardware watchpoints of
8835 type TYPE in the breakpoints list. Also returns in OTHER_TYPE_USED
8836 the sum of the used resources of all hardware watchpoints of other
8837 types _not_ TYPE. */
8840 hw_watchpoint_used_count_others (struct breakpoint *except,
8841 enum bptype type, int *other_type_used)
8844 struct breakpoint *b;
8846 *other_type_used = 0;
8851 if (!breakpoint_enabled (b))
8854 if (b->type == type)
8855 i += hw_watchpoint_use_count (b);
8856 else if (is_hardware_watchpoint (b))
8857 *other_type_used = 1;
8864 disable_watchpoints_before_interactive_call_start (void)
8866 struct breakpoint *b;
8870 if (is_watchpoint (b) && breakpoint_enabled (b))
8872 b->enable_state = bp_call_disabled;
8873 update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT);
8879 enable_watchpoints_after_interactive_call_stop (void)
8881 struct breakpoint *b;
8885 if (is_watchpoint (b) && b->enable_state == bp_call_disabled)
8887 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
8888 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
8894 disable_breakpoints_before_startup (void)
8896 current_program_space->executing_startup = 1;
8897 update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT);
8901 enable_breakpoints_after_startup (void)
8903 current_program_space->executing_startup = 0;
8904 breakpoint_re_set ();
8907 /* Create a new single-step breakpoint for thread THREAD, with no
8910 static struct breakpoint *
8911 new_single_step_breakpoint (int thread, struct gdbarch *gdbarch)
8913 struct breakpoint *b = new breakpoint ();
8915 init_raw_breakpoint_without_location (b, gdbarch, bp_single_step,
8916 &momentary_breakpoint_ops);
8918 b->disposition = disp_donttouch;
8919 b->frame_id = null_frame_id;
8922 gdb_assert (b->thread != 0);
8924 add_to_breakpoint_chain (b);
8929 /* Set a momentary breakpoint of type TYPE at address specified by
8930 SAL. If FRAME_ID is valid, the breakpoint is restricted to that
8934 set_momentary_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, struct symtab_and_line sal,
8935 struct frame_id frame_id, enum bptype type)
8937 struct breakpoint *b;
8939 /* If FRAME_ID is valid, it should be a real frame, not an inlined or
8941 gdb_assert (!frame_id_artificial_p (frame_id));
8943 b = set_raw_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, type, &momentary_breakpoint_ops);
8944 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
8945 b->disposition = disp_donttouch;
8946 b->frame_id = frame_id;
8948 /* If we're debugging a multi-threaded program, then we want
8949 momentary breakpoints to be active in only a single thread of
8951 if (in_thread_list (inferior_ptid))
8952 b->thread = ptid_to_global_thread_id (inferior_ptid);
8954 update_global_location_list_nothrow (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
8959 /* Make a momentary breakpoint based on the master breakpoint ORIG.
8960 The new breakpoint will have type TYPE, use OPS as its
8961 breakpoint_ops, and will set enabled to LOC_ENABLED. */
8963 static struct breakpoint *
8964 momentary_breakpoint_from_master (struct breakpoint *orig,
8966 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
8969 struct breakpoint *copy;
8971 copy = set_raw_breakpoint_without_location (orig->gdbarch, type, ops);
8972 copy->loc = allocate_bp_location (copy);
8973 set_breakpoint_location_function (copy->loc, 1);
8975 copy->loc->gdbarch = orig->loc->gdbarch;
8976 copy->loc->requested_address = orig->loc->requested_address;
8977 copy->loc->address = orig->loc->address;
8978 copy->loc->section = orig->loc->section;
8979 copy->loc->pspace = orig->loc->pspace;
8980 copy->loc->probe = orig->loc->probe;
8981 copy->loc->line_number = orig->loc->line_number;
8982 copy->loc->symtab = orig->loc->symtab;
8983 copy->loc->enabled = loc_enabled;
8984 copy->frame_id = orig->frame_id;
8985 copy->thread = orig->thread;
8986 copy->pspace = orig->pspace;
8988 copy->enable_state = bp_enabled;
8989 copy->disposition = disp_donttouch;
8990 copy->number = internal_breakpoint_number--;
8992 update_global_location_list_nothrow (UGLL_DONT_INSERT);
8996 /* Make a deep copy of momentary breakpoint ORIG. Returns NULL if
9000 clone_momentary_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *orig)
9002 /* If there's nothing to clone, then return nothing. */
9006 return momentary_breakpoint_from_master (orig, orig->type, orig->ops, 0);
9010 set_momentary_breakpoint_at_pc (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR pc,
9013 struct symtab_and_line sal;
9015 sal = find_pc_line (pc, 0);
9017 sal.section = find_pc_overlay (pc);
9018 sal.explicit_pc = 1;
9020 return set_momentary_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, null_frame_id, type);
9024 /* Tell the user we have just set a breakpoint B. */
9027 mention (struct breakpoint *b)
9029 b->ops->print_mention (b);
9030 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (current_uiout))
9032 printf_filtered ("\n");
9036 static int bp_loc_is_permanent (struct bp_location *loc);
9038 static struct bp_location *
9039 add_location_to_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b,
9040 const struct symtab_and_line *sal)
9042 struct bp_location *loc, **tmp;
9043 CORE_ADDR adjusted_address;
9044 struct gdbarch *loc_gdbarch = get_sal_arch (*sal);
9046 if (loc_gdbarch == NULL)
9047 loc_gdbarch = b->gdbarch;
9049 /* Adjust the breakpoint's address prior to allocating a location.
9050 Once we call allocate_bp_location(), that mostly uninitialized
9051 location will be placed on the location chain. Adjustment of the
9052 breakpoint may cause target_read_memory() to be called and we do
9053 not want its scan of the location chain to find a breakpoint and
9054 location that's only been partially initialized. */
9055 adjusted_address = adjust_breakpoint_address (loc_gdbarch,
9058 /* Sort the locations by their ADDRESS. */
9059 loc = allocate_bp_location (b);
9060 for (tmp = &(b->loc); *tmp != NULL && (*tmp)->address <= adjusted_address;
9061 tmp = &((*tmp)->next))
9066 loc->requested_address = sal->pc;
9067 loc->address = adjusted_address;
9068 loc->pspace = sal->pspace;
9069 loc->probe.probe = sal->probe;
9070 loc->probe.objfile = sal->objfile;
9071 gdb_assert (loc->pspace != NULL);
9072 loc->section = sal->section;
9073 loc->gdbarch = loc_gdbarch;
9074 loc->line_number = sal->line;
9075 loc->symtab = sal->symtab;
9077 set_breakpoint_location_function (loc,
9078 sal->explicit_pc || sal->explicit_line);
9080 /* While by definition, permanent breakpoints are already present in the
9081 code, we don't mark the location as inserted. Normally one would expect
9082 that GDB could rely on that breakpoint instruction to stop the program,
9083 thus removing the need to insert its own breakpoint, except that executing
9084 the breakpoint instruction can kill the target instead of reporting a
9085 SIGTRAP. E.g., on SPARC, when interrupts are disabled, executing the
9086 instruction resets the CPU, so QEMU 2.0.0 for SPARC correspondingly dies
9087 with "Trap 0x02 while interrupts disabled, Error state". Letting the
9088 breakpoint be inserted normally results in QEMU knowing about the GDB
9089 breakpoint, and thus trap before the breakpoint instruction is executed.
9090 (If GDB later needs to continue execution past the permanent breakpoint,
9091 it manually increments the PC, thus avoiding executing the breakpoint
9093 if (bp_loc_is_permanent (loc))
9100 /* See breakpoint.h. */
9103 program_breakpoint_here_p (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address)
9107 const gdb_byte *bpoint;
9108 gdb_byte *target_mem;
9109 struct cleanup *cleanup;
9113 bpoint = gdbarch_breakpoint_from_pc (gdbarch, &addr, &len);
9115 /* Software breakpoints unsupported? */
9119 target_mem = (gdb_byte *) alloca (len);
9121 /* Enable the automatic memory restoration from breakpoints while
9122 we read the memory. Otherwise we could say about our temporary
9123 breakpoints they are permanent. */
9124 cleanup = make_show_memory_breakpoints_cleanup (0);
9126 if (target_read_memory (address, target_mem, len) == 0
9127 && memcmp (target_mem, bpoint, len) == 0)
9130 do_cleanups (cleanup);
9135 /* Return 1 if LOC is pointing to a permanent breakpoint,
9136 return 0 otherwise. */
9139 bp_loc_is_permanent (struct bp_location *loc)
9141 struct cleanup *cleanup;
9144 gdb_assert (loc != NULL);
9146 /* If we have a catchpoint or a watchpoint, just return 0. We should not
9147 attempt to read from the addresses the locations of these breakpoint types
9148 point to. program_breakpoint_here_p, below, will attempt to read
9150 if (!breakpoint_address_is_meaningful (loc->owner))
9153 cleanup = save_current_space_and_thread ();
9154 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (loc->pspace);
9156 retval = program_breakpoint_here_p (loc->gdbarch, loc->address);
9158 do_cleanups (cleanup);
9163 /* Build a command list for the dprintf corresponding to the current
9164 settings of the dprintf style options. */
9167 update_dprintf_command_list (struct breakpoint *b)
9169 char *dprintf_args = b->extra_string;
9170 char *printf_line = NULL;
9175 dprintf_args = skip_spaces (dprintf_args);
9177 /* Allow a comma, as it may have terminated a location, but don't
9179 if (*dprintf_args == ',')
9181 dprintf_args = skip_spaces (dprintf_args);
9183 if (*dprintf_args != '"')
9184 error (_("Bad format string, missing '\"'."));
9186 if (strcmp (dprintf_style, dprintf_style_gdb) == 0)
9187 printf_line = xstrprintf ("printf %s", dprintf_args);
9188 else if (strcmp (dprintf_style, dprintf_style_call) == 0)
9190 if (!dprintf_function)
9191 error (_("No function supplied for dprintf call"));
9193 if (dprintf_channel && strlen (dprintf_channel) > 0)
9194 printf_line = xstrprintf ("call (void) %s (%s,%s)",
9199 printf_line = xstrprintf ("call (void) %s (%s)",
9203 else if (strcmp (dprintf_style, dprintf_style_agent) == 0)
9205 if (target_can_run_breakpoint_commands ())
9206 printf_line = xstrprintf ("agent-printf %s", dprintf_args);
9209 warning (_("Target cannot run dprintf commands, falling back to GDB printf"));
9210 printf_line = xstrprintf ("printf %s", dprintf_args);
9214 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
9215 _("Invalid dprintf style."));
9217 gdb_assert (printf_line != NULL);
9218 /* Manufacture a printf sequence. */
9220 struct command_line *printf_cmd_line = XNEW (struct command_line);
9222 printf_cmd_line->control_type = simple_control;
9223 printf_cmd_line->body_count = 0;
9224 printf_cmd_line->body_list = NULL;
9225 printf_cmd_line->next = NULL;
9226 printf_cmd_line->line = printf_line;
9228 breakpoint_set_commands (b, printf_cmd_line);
9232 /* Update all dprintf commands, making their command lists reflect
9233 current style settings. */
9236 update_dprintf_commands (char *args, int from_tty,
9237 struct cmd_list_element *c)
9239 struct breakpoint *b;
9243 if (b->type == bp_dprintf)
9244 update_dprintf_command_list (b);
9248 /* Create a breakpoint with SAL as location. Use LOCATION
9249 as a description of the location, and COND_STRING
9250 as condition expression. If LOCATION is NULL then create an
9251 "address location" from the address in the SAL. */
9254 init_breakpoint_sal (struct breakpoint *b, struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
9255 struct symtabs_and_lines sals,
9256 struct event_location *location,
9257 char *filter, char *cond_string,
9259 enum bptype type, enum bpdisp disposition,
9260 int thread, int task, int ignore_count,
9261 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops, int from_tty,
9262 int enabled, int internal, unsigned flags,
9263 int display_canonical)
9267 if (type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
9269 int target_resources_ok;
9271 i = hw_breakpoint_used_count ();
9272 target_resources_ok =
9273 target_can_use_hardware_watchpoint (bp_hardware_breakpoint,
9275 if (target_resources_ok == 0)
9276 error (_("No hardware breakpoint support in the target."));
9277 else if (target_resources_ok < 0)
9278 error (_("Hardware breakpoints used exceeds limit."));
9281 gdb_assert (sals.nelts > 0);
9283 for (i = 0; i < sals.nelts; ++i)
9285 struct symtab_and_line sal = sals.sals[i];
9286 struct bp_location *loc;
9290 struct gdbarch *loc_gdbarch = get_sal_arch (sal);
9292 loc_gdbarch = gdbarch;
9294 describe_other_breakpoints (loc_gdbarch,
9295 sal.pspace, sal.pc, sal.section, thread);
9300 init_raw_breakpoint (b, gdbarch, sal, type, ops);
9304 b->cond_string = cond_string;
9305 b->extra_string = extra_string;
9306 b->ignore_count = ignore_count;
9307 b->enable_state = enabled ? bp_enabled : bp_disabled;
9308 b->disposition = disposition;
9310 if ((flags & CREATE_BREAKPOINT_FLAGS_INSERTED) != 0)
9311 b->loc->inserted = 1;
9313 if (type == bp_static_tracepoint)
9315 struct tracepoint *t = (struct tracepoint *) b;
9316 struct static_tracepoint_marker marker;
9318 if (strace_marker_p (b))
9320 /* We already know the marker exists, otherwise, we
9321 wouldn't see a sal for it. */
9322 const char *p = &event_location_to_string (b->location)[3];
9326 p = skip_spaces_const (p);
9328 endp = skip_to_space_const (p);
9330 marker_str = savestring (p, endp - p);
9331 t->static_trace_marker_id = marker_str;
9333 printf_filtered (_("Probed static tracepoint "
9335 t->static_trace_marker_id);
9337 else if (target_static_tracepoint_marker_at (sal.pc, &marker))
9339 t->static_trace_marker_id = xstrdup (marker.str_id);
9340 release_static_tracepoint_marker (&marker);
9342 printf_filtered (_("Probed static tracepoint "
9344 t->static_trace_marker_id);
9347 warning (_("Couldn't determine the static "
9348 "tracepoint marker to probe"));
9355 loc = add_location_to_breakpoint (b, &sal);
9356 if ((flags & CREATE_BREAKPOINT_FLAGS_INSERTED) != 0)
9362 const char *arg = b->cond_string;
9364 loc->cond = parse_exp_1 (&arg, loc->address,
9365 block_for_pc (loc->address), 0);
9367 error (_("Garbage '%s' follows condition"), arg);
9370 /* Dynamic printf requires and uses additional arguments on the
9371 command line, otherwise it's an error. */
9372 if (type == bp_dprintf)
9374 if (b->extra_string)
9375 update_dprintf_command_list (b);
9377 error (_("Format string required"));
9379 else if (b->extra_string)
9380 error (_("Garbage '%s' at end of command"), b->extra_string);
9383 b->display_canonical = display_canonical;
9384 if (location != NULL)
9385 b->location = location;
9388 const char *addr_string = NULL;
9389 int addr_string_len = 0;
9391 if (location != NULL)
9392 addr_string = event_location_to_string (location);
9393 if (addr_string != NULL)
9394 addr_string_len = strlen (addr_string);
9396 b->location = new_address_location (b->loc->address,
9397 addr_string, addr_string_len);
9403 create_breakpoint_sal (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
9404 struct symtabs_and_lines sals,
9405 struct event_location *location,
9406 char *filter, char *cond_string,
9408 enum bptype type, enum bpdisp disposition,
9409 int thread, int task, int ignore_count,
9410 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops, int from_tty,
9411 int enabled, int internal, unsigned flags,
9412 int display_canonical)
9414 struct breakpoint *b;
9415 struct cleanup *old_chain;
9417 if (is_tracepoint_type (type))
9419 struct tracepoint *t;
9421 t = new tracepoint ();
9425 b = new breakpoint ();
9427 old_chain = make_cleanup (xfree, b);
9429 init_breakpoint_sal (b, gdbarch,
9431 filter, cond_string, extra_string,
9433 thread, task, ignore_count,
9435 enabled, internal, flags,
9437 discard_cleanups (old_chain);
9439 install_breakpoint (internal, b, 0);
9442 /* Add SALS.nelts breakpoints to the breakpoint table. For each
9443 SALS.sal[i] breakpoint, include the corresponding ADDR_STRING[i]
9444 value. COND_STRING, if not NULL, specified the condition to be
9445 used for all breakpoints. Essentially the only case where
9446 SALS.nelts is not 1 is when we set a breakpoint on an overloaded
9447 function. In that case, it's still not possible to specify
9448 separate conditions for different overloaded functions, so
9449 we take just a single condition string.
9451 NOTE: If the function succeeds, the caller is expected to cleanup
9452 the arrays ADDR_STRING, COND_STRING, and SALS (but not the
9453 array contents). If the function fails (error() is called), the
9454 caller is expected to cleanups both the ADDR_STRING, COND_STRING,
9455 COND and SALS arrays and each of those arrays contents. */
9458 create_breakpoints_sal (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
9459 struct linespec_result *canonical,
9460 char *cond_string, char *extra_string,
9461 enum bptype type, enum bpdisp disposition,
9462 int thread, int task, int ignore_count,
9463 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops, int from_tty,
9464 int enabled, int internal, unsigned flags)
9467 struct linespec_sals *lsal;
9469 if (canonical->pre_expanded)
9470 gdb_assert (VEC_length (linespec_sals, canonical->sals) == 1);
9472 for (i = 0; VEC_iterate (linespec_sals, canonical->sals, i, lsal); ++i)
9474 /* Note that 'location' can be NULL in the case of a plain
9475 'break', without arguments. */
9476 struct event_location *location
9477 = (canonical->location != NULL
9478 ? copy_event_location (canonical->location) : NULL);
9479 char *filter_string = lsal->canonical ? xstrdup (lsal->canonical) : NULL;
9480 struct cleanup *inner = make_cleanup_delete_event_location (location);
9482 make_cleanup (xfree, filter_string);
9483 create_breakpoint_sal (gdbarch, lsal->sals,
9486 cond_string, extra_string,
9488 thread, task, ignore_count, ops,
9489 from_tty, enabled, internal, flags,
9490 canonical->special_display);
9491 discard_cleanups (inner);
9495 /* Parse LOCATION which is assumed to be a SAL specification possibly
9496 followed by conditionals. On return, SALS contains an array of SAL
9497 addresses found. LOCATION points to the end of the SAL (for
9498 linespec locations).
9500 The array and the line spec strings are allocated on the heap, it is
9501 the caller's responsibility to free them. */
9504 parse_breakpoint_sals (const struct event_location *location,
9505 struct linespec_result *canonical)
9507 struct symtab_and_line cursal;
9509 if (event_location_type (location) == LINESPEC_LOCATION)
9511 const char *address = get_linespec_location (location);
9513 if (address == NULL)
9515 /* The last displayed codepoint, if it's valid, is our default
9516 breakpoint address. */
9517 if (last_displayed_sal_is_valid ())
9519 struct linespec_sals lsal;
9520 struct symtab_and_line sal;
9523 init_sal (&sal); /* Initialize to zeroes. */
9524 lsal.sals.sals = XNEW (struct symtab_and_line);
9526 /* Set sal's pspace, pc, symtab, and line to the values
9527 corresponding to the last call to print_frame_info.
9528 Be sure to reinitialize LINE with NOTCURRENT == 0
9529 as the breakpoint line number is inappropriate otherwise.
9530 find_pc_line would adjust PC, re-set it back. */
9531 get_last_displayed_sal (&sal);
9533 sal = find_pc_line (pc, 0);
9535 /* "break" without arguments is equivalent to "break *PC"
9536 where PC is the last displayed codepoint's address. So
9537 make sure to set sal.explicit_pc to prevent GDB from
9538 trying to expand the list of sals to include all other
9539 instances with the same symtab and line. */
9541 sal.explicit_pc = 1;
9543 lsal.sals.sals[0] = sal;
9544 lsal.sals.nelts = 1;
9545 lsal.canonical = NULL;
9547 VEC_safe_push (linespec_sals, canonical->sals, &lsal);
9551 error (_("No default breakpoint address now."));
9555 /* Force almost all breakpoints to be in terms of the
9556 current_source_symtab (which is decode_line_1's default).
9557 This should produce the results we want almost all of the
9558 time while leaving default_breakpoint_* alone.
9560 ObjC: However, don't match an Objective-C method name which
9561 may have a '+' or '-' succeeded by a '['. */
9562 cursal = get_current_source_symtab_and_line ();
9563 if (last_displayed_sal_is_valid ())
9565 const char *address = NULL;
9567 if (event_location_type (location) == LINESPEC_LOCATION)
9568 address = get_linespec_location (location);
9572 && strchr ("+-", address[0]) != NULL
9573 && address[1] != '['))
9575 decode_line_full (location, DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE, NULL,
9576 get_last_displayed_symtab (),
9577 get_last_displayed_line (),
9578 canonical, NULL, NULL);
9583 decode_line_full (location, DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE, NULL,
9584 cursal.symtab, cursal.line, canonical, NULL, NULL);
9588 /* Convert each SAL into a real PC. Verify that the PC can be
9589 inserted as a breakpoint. If it can't throw an error. */
9592 breakpoint_sals_to_pc (struct symtabs_and_lines *sals)
9596 for (i = 0; i < sals->nelts; i++)
9597 resolve_sal_pc (&sals->sals[i]);
9600 /* Fast tracepoints may have restrictions on valid locations. For
9601 instance, a fast tracepoint using a jump instead of a trap will
9602 likely have to overwrite more bytes than a trap would, and so can
9603 only be placed where the instruction is longer than the jump, or a
9604 multi-instruction sequence does not have a jump into the middle of
9608 check_fast_tracepoint_sals (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
9609 struct symtabs_and_lines *sals)
9612 struct symtab_and_line *sal;
9614 struct cleanup *old_chain;
9616 for (i = 0; i < sals->nelts; i++)
9618 struct gdbarch *sarch;
9620 sal = &sals->sals[i];
9622 sarch = get_sal_arch (*sal);
9623 /* We fall back to GDBARCH if there is no architecture
9624 associated with SAL. */
9627 rslt = gdbarch_fast_tracepoint_valid_at (sarch, sal->pc, &msg);
9628 old_chain = make_cleanup (xfree, msg);
9631 error (_("May not have a fast tracepoint at %s%s"),
9632 paddress (sarch, sal->pc), (msg ? msg : ""));
9634 do_cleanups (old_chain);
9638 /* Given TOK, a string specification of condition and thread, as
9639 accepted by the 'break' command, extract the condition
9640 string and thread number and set *COND_STRING and *THREAD.
9641 PC identifies the context at which the condition should be parsed.
9642 If no condition is found, *COND_STRING is set to NULL.
9643 If no thread is found, *THREAD is set to -1. */
9646 find_condition_and_thread (const char *tok, CORE_ADDR pc,
9647 char **cond_string, int *thread, int *task,
9650 *cond_string = NULL;
9657 const char *end_tok;
9659 const char *cond_start = NULL;
9660 const char *cond_end = NULL;
9662 tok = skip_spaces_const (tok);
9664 if ((*tok == '"' || *tok == ',') && rest)
9666 *rest = savestring (tok, strlen (tok));
9670 end_tok = skip_to_space_const (tok);
9672 toklen = end_tok - tok;
9674 if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "if", toklen) == 0)
9676 tok = cond_start = end_tok + 1;
9677 parse_exp_1 (&tok, pc, block_for_pc (pc), 0);
9679 *cond_string = savestring (cond_start, cond_end - cond_start);
9681 else if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "thread", toklen) == 0)
9684 struct thread_info *thr;
9687 thr = parse_thread_id (tok, &tmptok);
9689 error (_("Junk after thread keyword."));
9690 *thread = thr->global_num;
9693 else if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "task", toklen) == 0)
9698 *task = strtol (tok, &tmptok, 0);
9700 error (_("Junk after task keyword."));
9701 if (!valid_task_id (*task))
9702 error (_("Unknown task %d."), *task);
9707 *rest = savestring (tok, strlen (tok));
9711 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
9715 /* Decode a static tracepoint marker spec. */
9717 static struct symtabs_and_lines
9718 decode_static_tracepoint_spec (const char **arg_p)
9720 VEC(static_tracepoint_marker_p) *markers = NULL;
9721 struct symtabs_and_lines sals;
9722 struct cleanup *old_chain;
9723 const char *p = &(*arg_p)[3];
9728 p = skip_spaces_const (p);
9730 endp = skip_to_space_const (p);
9732 marker_str = savestring (p, endp - p);
9733 old_chain = make_cleanup (xfree, marker_str);
9735 markers = target_static_tracepoint_markers_by_strid (marker_str);
9736 if (VEC_empty(static_tracepoint_marker_p, markers))
9737 error (_("No known static tracepoint marker named %s"), marker_str);
9739 sals.nelts = VEC_length(static_tracepoint_marker_p, markers);
9740 sals.sals = XNEWVEC (struct symtab_and_line, sals.nelts);
9742 for (i = 0; i < sals.nelts; i++)
9744 struct static_tracepoint_marker *marker;
9746 marker = VEC_index (static_tracepoint_marker_p, markers, i);
9748 init_sal (&sals.sals[i]);
9750 sals.sals[i] = find_pc_line (marker->address, 0);
9751 sals.sals[i].pc = marker->address;
9753 release_static_tracepoint_marker (marker);
9756 do_cleanups (old_chain);
9762 /* See breakpoint.h. */
9765 create_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
9766 const struct event_location *location, char *cond_string,
9767 int thread, char *extra_string,
9769 int tempflag, enum bptype type_wanted,
9771 enum auto_boolean pending_break_support,
9772 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
9773 int from_tty, int enabled, int internal,
9776 struct linespec_result canonical;
9777 struct cleanup *old_chain;
9778 struct cleanup *bkpt_chain = NULL;
9781 int prev_bkpt_count = breakpoint_count;
9783 gdb_assert (ops != NULL);
9785 /* If extra_string isn't useful, set it to NULL. */
9786 if (extra_string != NULL && *extra_string == '\0')
9787 extra_string = NULL;
9789 init_linespec_result (&canonical);
9793 ops->create_sals_from_location (location, &canonical, type_wanted);
9795 CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ERROR)
9797 /* If caller is interested in rc value from parse, set
9799 if (e.error == NOT_FOUND_ERROR)
9801 /* If pending breakpoint support is turned off, throw
9804 if (pending_break_support == AUTO_BOOLEAN_FALSE)
9805 throw_exception (e);
9807 exception_print (gdb_stderr, e);
9809 /* If pending breakpoint support is auto query and the user
9810 selects no, then simply return the error code. */
9811 if (pending_break_support == AUTO_BOOLEAN_AUTO
9812 && !nquery (_("Make %s pending on future shared library load? "),
9813 bptype_string (type_wanted)))
9816 /* At this point, either the user was queried about setting
9817 a pending breakpoint and selected yes, or pending
9818 breakpoint behavior is on and thus a pending breakpoint
9819 is defaulted on behalf of the user. */
9823 throw_exception (e);
9827 if (!pending && VEC_empty (linespec_sals, canonical.sals))
9830 /* Create a chain of things that always need to be cleaned up. */
9831 old_chain = make_cleanup_destroy_linespec_result (&canonical);
9833 /* ----------------------------- SNIP -----------------------------
9834 Anything added to the cleanup chain beyond this point is assumed
9835 to be part of a breakpoint. If the breakpoint create succeeds
9836 then the memory is not reclaimed. */
9837 bkpt_chain = make_cleanup (null_cleanup, 0);
9839 /* Resolve all line numbers to PC's and verify that the addresses
9840 are ok for the target. */
9844 struct linespec_sals *iter;
9846 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (linespec_sals, canonical.sals, ix, iter); ++ix)
9847 breakpoint_sals_to_pc (&iter->sals);
9850 /* Fast tracepoints may have additional restrictions on location. */
9851 if (!pending && type_wanted == bp_fast_tracepoint)
9854 struct linespec_sals *iter;
9856 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (linespec_sals, canonical.sals, ix, iter); ++ix)
9857 check_fast_tracepoint_sals (gdbarch, &iter->sals);
9860 /* Verify that condition can be parsed, before setting any
9861 breakpoints. Allocate a separate condition expression for each
9868 struct linespec_sals *lsal;
9870 lsal = VEC_index (linespec_sals, canonical.sals, 0);
9872 /* Here we only parse 'arg' to separate condition
9873 from thread number, so parsing in context of first
9874 sal is OK. When setting the breakpoint we'll
9875 re-parse it in context of each sal. */
9877 find_condition_and_thread (extra_string, lsal->sals.sals[0].pc,
9878 &cond_string, &thread, &task, &rest);
9880 make_cleanup (xfree, cond_string);
9882 make_cleanup (xfree, rest);
9884 extra_string = rest;
9886 extra_string = NULL;
9890 if (type_wanted != bp_dprintf
9891 && extra_string != NULL && *extra_string != '\0')
9892 error (_("Garbage '%s' at end of location"), extra_string);
9894 /* Create a private copy of condition string. */
9897 cond_string = xstrdup (cond_string);
9898 make_cleanup (xfree, cond_string);
9900 /* Create a private copy of any extra string. */
9903 extra_string = xstrdup (extra_string);
9904 make_cleanup (xfree, extra_string);
9908 ops->create_breakpoints_sal (gdbarch, &canonical,
9909 cond_string, extra_string, type_wanted,
9910 tempflag ? disp_del : disp_donttouch,
9911 thread, task, ignore_count, ops,
9912 from_tty, enabled, internal, flags);
9916 struct breakpoint *b;
9918 if (is_tracepoint_type (type_wanted))
9920 struct tracepoint *t;
9922 t = new tracepoint ();
9926 b = new breakpoint ();
9928 init_raw_breakpoint_without_location (b, gdbarch, type_wanted, ops);
9929 b->location = copy_event_location (location);
9932 b->cond_string = NULL;
9935 /* Create a private copy of condition string. */
9938 cond_string = xstrdup (cond_string);
9939 make_cleanup (xfree, cond_string);
9941 b->cond_string = cond_string;
9945 /* Create a private copy of any extra string. */
9946 if (extra_string != NULL)
9948 extra_string = xstrdup (extra_string);
9949 make_cleanup (xfree, extra_string);
9951 b->extra_string = extra_string;
9952 b->ignore_count = ignore_count;
9953 b->disposition = tempflag ? disp_del : disp_donttouch;
9954 b->condition_not_parsed = 1;
9955 b->enable_state = enabled ? bp_enabled : bp_disabled;
9956 if ((type_wanted != bp_breakpoint
9957 && type_wanted != bp_hardware_breakpoint) || thread != -1)
9958 b->pspace = current_program_space;
9960 install_breakpoint (internal, b, 0);
9963 if (VEC_length (linespec_sals, canonical.sals) > 1)
9965 warning (_("Multiple breakpoints were set.\nUse the "
9966 "\"delete\" command to delete unwanted breakpoints."));
9967 prev_breakpoint_count = prev_bkpt_count;
9970 /* That's it. Discard the cleanups for data inserted into the
9972 discard_cleanups (bkpt_chain);
9973 /* But cleanup everything else. */
9974 do_cleanups (old_chain);
9976 /* error call may happen here - have BKPT_CHAIN already discarded. */
9977 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
9982 /* Set a breakpoint.
9983 ARG is a string describing breakpoint address,
9984 condition, and thread.
9985 FLAG specifies if a breakpoint is hardware on,
9986 and if breakpoint is temporary, using BP_HARDWARE_FLAG
9990 break_command_1 (char *arg, int flag, int from_tty)
9992 int tempflag = flag & BP_TEMPFLAG;
9993 enum bptype type_wanted = (flag & BP_HARDWAREFLAG
9994 ? bp_hardware_breakpoint
9996 struct breakpoint_ops *ops;
9997 struct event_location *location;
9998 struct cleanup *cleanup;
10000 location = string_to_event_location (&arg, current_language);
10001 cleanup = make_cleanup_delete_event_location (location);
10003 /* Matching breakpoints on probes. */
10004 if (location != NULL
10005 && event_location_type (location) == PROBE_LOCATION)
10006 ops = &bkpt_probe_breakpoint_ops;
10008 ops = &bkpt_breakpoint_ops;
10010 create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
10012 NULL, 0, arg, 1 /* parse arg */,
10013 tempflag, type_wanted,
10014 0 /* Ignore count */,
10015 pending_break_support,
10021 do_cleanups (cleanup);
10024 /* Helper function for break_command_1 and disassemble_command. */
10027 resolve_sal_pc (struct symtab_and_line *sal)
10031 if (sal->pc == 0 && sal->symtab != NULL)
10033 if (!find_line_pc (sal->symtab, sal->line, &pc))
10034 error (_("No line %d in file \"%s\"."),
10035 sal->line, symtab_to_filename_for_display (sal->symtab));
10038 /* If this SAL corresponds to a breakpoint inserted using a line
10039 number, then skip the function prologue if necessary. */
10040 if (sal->explicit_line)
10041 skip_prologue_sal (sal);
10044 if (sal->section == 0 && sal->symtab != NULL)
10046 const struct blockvector *bv;
10047 const struct block *b;
10048 struct symbol *sym;
10050 bv = blockvector_for_pc_sect (sal->pc, 0, &b,
10051 SYMTAB_COMPUNIT (sal->symtab));
10054 sym = block_linkage_function (b);
10057 fixup_symbol_section (sym, SYMTAB_OBJFILE (sal->symtab));
10058 sal->section = SYMBOL_OBJ_SECTION (SYMTAB_OBJFILE (sal->symtab),
10063 /* It really is worthwhile to have the section, so we'll
10064 just have to look harder. This case can be executed
10065 if we have line numbers but no functions (as can
10066 happen in assembly source). */
10068 struct bound_minimal_symbol msym;
10069 struct cleanup *old_chain = save_current_space_and_thread ();
10071 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (sal->pspace);
10073 msym = lookup_minimal_symbol_by_pc (sal->pc);
10075 sal->section = MSYMBOL_OBJ_SECTION (msym.objfile, msym.minsym);
10077 do_cleanups (old_chain);
10084 break_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
10086 break_command_1 (arg, 0, from_tty);
10090 tbreak_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
10092 break_command_1 (arg, BP_TEMPFLAG, from_tty);
10096 hbreak_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
10098 break_command_1 (arg, BP_HARDWAREFLAG, from_tty);
10102 thbreak_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
10104 break_command_1 (arg, (BP_TEMPFLAG | BP_HARDWAREFLAG), from_tty);
10108 stop_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
10110 printf_filtered (_("Specify the type of breakpoint to set.\n\
10111 Usage: stop in <function | address>\n\
10112 stop at <line>\n"));
10116 stopin_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
10120 if (arg == (char *) NULL)
10122 else if (*arg != '*')
10124 char *argptr = arg;
10127 /* Look for a ':'. If this is a line number specification, then
10128 say it is bad, otherwise, it should be an address or
10129 function/method name. */
10130 while (*argptr && !hasColon)
10132 hasColon = (*argptr == ':');
10137 badInput = (*argptr != ':'); /* Not a class::method */
10139 badInput = isdigit (*arg); /* a simple line number */
10143 printf_filtered (_("Usage: stop in <function | address>\n"));
10145 break_command_1 (arg, 0, from_tty);
10149 stopat_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
10153 if (arg == (char *) NULL || *arg == '*') /* no line number */
10157 char *argptr = arg;
10160 /* Look for a ':'. If there is a '::' then get out, otherwise
10161 it is probably a line number. */
10162 while (*argptr && !hasColon)
10164 hasColon = (*argptr == ':');
10169 badInput = (*argptr == ':'); /* we have class::method */
10171 badInput = !isdigit (*arg); /* not a line number */
10175 printf_filtered (_("Usage: stop at <line>\n"));
10177 break_command_1 (arg, 0, from_tty);
10180 /* The dynamic printf command is mostly like a regular breakpoint, but
10181 with a prewired command list consisting of a single output command,
10182 built from extra arguments supplied on the dprintf command
10186 dprintf_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
10188 struct event_location *location;
10189 struct cleanup *cleanup;
10191 location = string_to_event_location (&arg, current_language);
10192 cleanup = make_cleanup_delete_event_location (location);
10194 /* If non-NULL, ARG should have been advanced past the location;
10195 the next character must be ','. */
10198 if (arg[0] != ',' || arg[1] == '\0')
10199 error (_("Format string required"));
10202 /* Skip the comma. */
10207 create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
10209 NULL, 0, arg, 1 /* parse arg */,
10211 0 /* Ignore count */,
10212 pending_break_support,
10213 &dprintf_breakpoint_ops,
10218 do_cleanups (cleanup);
10222 agent_printf_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
10224 error (_("May only run agent-printf on the target"));
10227 /* Implement the "breakpoint_hit" breakpoint_ops method for
10228 ranged breakpoints. */
10231 breakpoint_hit_ranged_breakpoint (const struct bp_location *bl,
10232 struct address_space *aspace,
10234 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
10236 if (ws->kind != TARGET_WAITKIND_STOPPED
10237 || ws->value.sig != GDB_SIGNAL_TRAP)
10240 return breakpoint_address_match_range (bl->pspace->aspace, bl->address,
10241 bl->length, aspace, bp_addr);
10244 /* Implement the "resources_needed" breakpoint_ops method for
10245 ranged breakpoints. */
10248 resources_needed_ranged_breakpoint (const struct bp_location *bl)
10250 return target_ranged_break_num_registers ();
10253 /* Implement the "print_it" breakpoint_ops method for
10254 ranged breakpoints. */
10256 static enum print_stop_action
10257 print_it_ranged_breakpoint (bpstat bs)
10259 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
10260 struct bp_location *bl = b->loc;
10261 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
10263 gdb_assert (b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint);
10265 /* Ranged breakpoints have only one location. */
10266 gdb_assert (bl && bl->next == NULL);
10268 annotate_breakpoint (b->number);
10270 maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (uiout);
10272 if (b->disposition == disp_del)
10273 ui_out_text (uiout, "Temporary ranged breakpoint ");
10275 ui_out_text (uiout, "Ranged breakpoint ");
10276 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
10278 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "reason",
10279 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_BREAKPOINT_HIT));
10280 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
10282 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "bkptno", b->number);
10283 ui_out_text (uiout, ", ");
10285 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
10288 /* Implement the "print_one" breakpoint_ops method for
10289 ranged breakpoints. */
10292 print_one_ranged_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b,
10293 struct bp_location **last_loc)
10295 struct bp_location *bl = b->loc;
10296 struct value_print_options opts;
10297 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
10299 /* Ranged breakpoints have only one location. */
10300 gdb_assert (bl && bl->next == NULL);
10302 get_user_print_options (&opts);
10304 if (opts.addressprint)
10305 /* We don't print the address range here, it will be printed later
10306 by print_one_detail_ranged_breakpoint. */
10307 ui_out_field_skip (uiout, "addr");
10308 annotate_field (5);
10309 print_breakpoint_location (b, bl);
10313 /* Implement the "print_one_detail" breakpoint_ops method for
10314 ranged breakpoints. */
10317 print_one_detail_ranged_breakpoint (const struct breakpoint *b,
10318 struct ui_out *uiout)
10320 CORE_ADDR address_start, address_end;
10321 struct bp_location *bl = b->loc;
10322 struct ui_file *stb = mem_fileopen ();
10323 struct cleanup *cleanup = make_cleanup_ui_file_delete (stb);
10327 address_start = bl->address;
10328 address_end = address_start + bl->length - 1;
10330 ui_out_text (uiout, "\taddress range: ");
10331 fprintf_unfiltered (stb, "[%s, %s]",
10332 print_core_address (bl->gdbarch, address_start),
10333 print_core_address (bl->gdbarch, address_end));
10334 ui_out_field_stream (uiout, "addr", stb);
10335 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
10337 do_cleanups (cleanup);
10340 /* Implement the "print_mention" breakpoint_ops method for
10341 ranged breakpoints. */
10344 print_mention_ranged_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b)
10346 struct bp_location *bl = b->loc;
10347 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
10350 gdb_assert (b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint);
10352 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
10355 printf_filtered (_("Hardware assisted ranged breakpoint %d from %s to %s."),
10356 b->number, paddress (bl->gdbarch, bl->address),
10357 paddress (bl->gdbarch, bl->address + bl->length - 1));
10360 /* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for
10361 ranged breakpoints. */
10364 print_recreate_ranged_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
10366 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "break-range %s, %s",
10367 event_location_to_string (b->location),
10368 event_location_to_string (b->location_range_end));
10369 print_recreate_thread (b, fp);
10372 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in ranged breakpoints. */
10374 static struct breakpoint_ops ranged_breakpoint_ops;
10376 /* Find the address where the end of the breakpoint range should be
10377 placed, given the SAL of the end of the range. This is so that if
10378 the user provides a line number, the end of the range is set to the
10379 last instruction of the given line. */
10382 find_breakpoint_range_end (struct symtab_and_line sal)
10386 /* If the user provided a PC value, use it. Otherwise,
10387 find the address of the end of the given location. */
10388 if (sal.explicit_pc)
10395 ret = find_line_pc_range (sal, &start, &end);
10397 error (_("Could not find location of the end of the range."));
10399 /* find_line_pc_range returns the start of the next line. */
10406 /* Implement the "break-range" CLI command. */
10409 break_range_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
10411 char *arg_start, *addr_string_start;
10412 struct linespec_result canonical_start, canonical_end;
10413 int bp_count, can_use_bp, length;
10415 struct breakpoint *b;
10416 struct symtab_and_line sal_start, sal_end;
10417 struct cleanup *cleanup_bkpt;
10418 struct linespec_sals *lsal_start, *lsal_end;
10419 struct event_location *start_location, *end_location;
10421 /* We don't support software ranged breakpoints. */
10422 if (target_ranged_break_num_registers () < 0)
10423 error (_("This target does not support hardware ranged breakpoints."));
10425 bp_count = hw_breakpoint_used_count ();
10426 bp_count += target_ranged_break_num_registers ();
10427 can_use_bp = target_can_use_hardware_watchpoint (bp_hardware_breakpoint,
10429 if (can_use_bp < 0)
10430 error (_("Hardware breakpoints used exceeds limit."));
10432 arg = skip_spaces (arg);
10433 if (arg == NULL || arg[0] == '\0')
10434 error(_("No address range specified."));
10436 init_linespec_result (&canonical_start);
10439 start_location = string_to_event_location (&arg, current_language);
10440 cleanup_bkpt = make_cleanup_delete_event_location (start_location);
10441 parse_breakpoint_sals (start_location, &canonical_start);
10442 make_cleanup_destroy_linespec_result (&canonical_start);
10445 error (_("Too few arguments."));
10446 else if (VEC_empty (linespec_sals, canonical_start.sals))
10447 error (_("Could not find location of the beginning of the range."));
10449 lsal_start = VEC_index (linespec_sals, canonical_start.sals, 0);
10451 if (VEC_length (linespec_sals, canonical_start.sals) > 1
10452 || lsal_start->sals.nelts != 1)
10453 error (_("Cannot create a ranged breakpoint with multiple locations."));
10455 sal_start = lsal_start->sals.sals[0];
10456 addr_string_start = savestring (arg_start, arg - arg_start);
10457 make_cleanup (xfree, addr_string_start);
10459 arg++; /* Skip the comma. */
10460 arg = skip_spaces (arg);
10462 /* Parse the end location. */
10464 init_linespec_result (&canonical_end);
10467 /* We call decode_line_full directly here instead of using
10468 parse_breakpoint_sals because we need to specify the start location's
10469 symtab and line as the default symtab and line for the end of the
10470 range. This makes it possible to have ranges like "foo.c:27, +14",
10471 where +14 means 14 lines from the start location. */
10472 end_location = string_to_event_location (&arg, current_language);
10473 make_cleanup_delete_event_location (end_location);
10474 decode_line_full (end_location, DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE, NULL,
10475 sal_start.symtab, sal_start.line,
10476 &canonical_end, NULL, NULL);
10478 make_cleanup_destroy_linespec_result (&canonical_end);
10480 if (VEC_empty (linespec_sals, canonical_end.sals))
10481 error (_("Could not find location of the end of the range."));
10483 lsal_end = VEC_index (linespec_sals, canonical_end.sals, 0);
10484 if (VEC_length (linespec_sals, canonical_end.sals) > 1
10485 || lsal_end->sals.nelts != 1)
10486 error (_("Cannot create a ranged breakpoint with multiple locations."));
10488 sal_end = lsal_end->sals.sals[0];
10490 end = find_breakpoint_range_end (sal_end);
10491 if (sal_start.pc > end)
10492 error (_("Invalid address range, end precedes start."));
10494 length = end - sal_start.pc + 1;
10496 /* Length overflowed. */
10497 error (_("Address range too large."));
10498 else if (length == 1)
10500 /* This range is simple enough to be handled by
10501 the `hbreak' command. */
10502 hbreak_command (addr_string_start, 1);
10504 do_cleanups (cleanup_bkpt);
10509 /* Now set up the breakpoint. */
10510 b = set_raw_breakpoint (get_current_arch (), sal_start,
10511 bp_hardware_breakpoint, &ranged_breakpoint_ops);
10512 set_breakpoint_count (breakpoint_count + 1);
10513 b->number = breakpoint_count;
10514 b->disposition = disp_donttouch;
10515 b->location = copy_event_location (start_location);
10516 b->location_range_end = copy_event_location (end_location);
10517 b->loc->length = length;
10519 do_cleanups (cleanup_bkpt);
10522 observer_notify_breakpoint_created (b);
10523 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
10526 /* Return non-zero if EXP is verified as constant. Returned zero
10527 means EXP is variable. Also the constant detection may fail for
10528 some constant expressions and in such case still falsely return
10532 watchpoint_exp_is_const (const struct expression *exp)
10534 int i = exp->nelts;
10540 /* We are only interested in the descriptor of each element. */
10541 operator_length (exp, i, &oplenp, &argsp);
10544 switch (exp->elts[i].opcode)
10554 case BINOP_LOGICAL_AND:
10555 case BINOP_LOGICAL_OR:
10556 case BINOP_BITWISE_AND:
10557 case BINOP_BITWISE_IOR:
10558 case BINOP_BITWISE_XOR:
10560 case BINOP_NOTEQUAL:
10587 case OP_OBJC_NSSTRING:
10590 case UNOP_LOGICAL_NOT:
10591 case UNOP_COMPLEMENT:
10596 case UNOP_CAST_TYPE:
10597 case UNOP_REINTERPRET_CAST:
10598 case UNOP_DYNAMIC_CAST:
10599 /* Unary, binary and ternary operators: We have to check
10600 their operands. If they are constant, then so is the
10601 result of that operation. For instance, if A and B are
10602 determined to be constants, then so is "A + B".
10604 UNOP_IND is one exception to the rule above, because the
10605 value of *ADDR is not necessarily a constant, even when
10610 /* Check whether the associated symbol is a constant.
10612 We use SYMBOL_CLASS rather than TYPE_CONST because it's
10613 possible that a buggy compiler could mark a variable as
10614 constant even when it is not, and TYPE_CONST would return
10615 true in this case, while SYMBOL_CLASS wouldn't.
10617 We also have to check for function symbols because they
10618 are always constant. */
10620 struct symbol *s = exp->elts[i + 2].symbol;
10622 if (SYMBOL_CLASS (s) != LOC_BLOCK
10623 && SYMBOL_CLASS (s) != LOC_CONST
10624 && SYMBOL_CLASS (s) != LOC_CONST_BYTES)
10629 /* The default action is to return 0 because we are using
10630 the optimistic approach here: If we don't know something,
10631 then it is not a constant. */
10640 /* Implement the "dtor" breakpoint_ops method for watchpoints. */
10643 dtor_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *self)
10645 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) self;
10647 xfree (w->exp_string);
10648 xfree (w->exp_string_reparse);
10649 value_free (w->val);
10651 base_breakpoint_ops.dtor (self);
10654 /* Implement the "re_set" breakpoint_ops method for watchpoints. */
10657 re_set_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *b)
10659 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
10661 /* Watchpoint can be either on expression using entirely global
10662 variables, or it can be on local variables.
10664 Watchpoints of the first kind are never auto-deleted, and even
10665 persist across program restarts. Since they can use variables
10666 from shared libraries, we need to reparse expression as libraries
10667 are loaded and unloaded.
10669 Watchpoints on local variables can also change meaning as result
10670 of solib event. For example, if a watchpoint uses both a local
10671 and a global variables in expression, it's a local watchpoint,
10672 but unloading of a shared library will make the expression
10673 invalid. This is not a very common use case, but we still
10674 re-evaluate expression, to avoid surprises to the user.
10676 Note that for local watchpoints, we re-evaluate it only if
10677 watchpoints frame id is still valid. If it's not, it means the
10678 watchpoint is out of scope and will be deleted soon. In fact,
10679 I'm not sure we'll ever be called in this case.
10681 If a local watchpoint's frame id is still valid, then
10682 w->exp_valid_block is likewise valid, and we can safely use it.
10684 Don't do anything about disabled watchpoints, since they will be
10685 reevaluated again when enabled. */
10686 update_watchpoint (w, 1 /* reparse */);
10689 /* Implement the "insert" breakpoint_ops method for hardware watchpoints. */
10692 insert_watchpoint (struct bp_location *bl)
10694 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bl->owner;
10695 int length = w->exact ? 1 : bl->length;
10697 return target_insert_watchpoint (bl->address, length, bl->watchpoint_type,
10698 w->cond_exp.get ());
10701 /* Implement the "remove" breakpoint_ops method for hardware watchpoints. */
10704 remove_watchpoint (struct bp_location *bl, enum remove_bp_reason reason)
10706 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bl->owner;
10707 int length = w->exact ? 1 : bl->length;
10709 return target_remove_watchpoint (bl->address, length, bl->watchpoint_type,
10710 w->cond_exp.get ());
10714 breakpoint_hit_watchpoint (const struct bp_location *bl,
10715 struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
10716 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
10718 struct breakpoint *b = bl->owner;
10719 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
10721 /* Continuable hardware watchpoints are treated as non-existent if the
10722 reason we stopped wasn't a hardware watchpoint (we didn't stop on
10723 some data address). Otherwise gdb won't stop on a break instruction
10724 in the code (not from a breakpoint) when a hardware watchpoint has
10725 been defined. Also skip watchpoints which we know did not trigger
10726 (did not match the data address). */
10727 if (is_hardware_watchpoint (b)
10728 && w->watchpoint_triggered == watch_triggered_no)
10735 check_status_watchpoint (bpstat bs)
10737 gdb_assert (is_watchpoint (bs->breakpoint_at));
10739 bpstat_check_watchpoint (bs);
10742 /* Implement the "resources_needed" breakpoint_ops method for
10743 hardware watchpoints. */
10746 resources_needed_watchpoint (const struct bp_location *bl)
10748 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bl->owner;
10749 int length = w->exact? 1 : bl->length;
10751 return target_region_ok_for_hw_watchpoint (bl->address, length);
10754 /* Implement the "works_in_software_mode" breakpoint_ops method for
10755 hardware watchpoints. */
10758 works_in_software_mode_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *b)
10760 /* Read and access watchpoints only work with hardware support. */
10761 return b->type == bp_watchpoint || b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint;
10764 static enum print_stop_action
10765 print_it_watchpoint (bpstat bs)
10767 struct cleanup *old_chain;
10768 struct breakpoint *b;
10769 struct ui_file *stb;
10770 enum print_stop_action result;
10771 struct watchpoint *w;
10772 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
10774 gdb_assert (bs->bp_location_at != NULL);
10776 b = bs->breakpoint_at;
10777 w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
10779 stb = mem_fileopen ();
10780 old_chain = make_cleanup_ui_file_delete (stb);
10782 annotate_watchpoint (b->number);
10783 maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (uiout);
10787 case bp_watchpoint:
10788 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
10789 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
10790 ui_out_field_string
10792 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
10794 make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "value");
10795 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nOld value = ");
10796 watchpoint_value_print (bs->old_val, stb);
10797 ui_out_field_stream (uiout, "old", stb);
10798 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nNew value = ");
10799 watchpoint_value_print (w->val, stb);
10800 ui_out_field_stream (uiout, "new", stb);
10801 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
10802 /* More than one watchpoint may have been triggered. */
10803 result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
10806 case bp_read_watchpoint:
10807 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
10808 ui_out_field_string
10810 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_READ_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
10812 make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "value");
10813 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nValue = ");
10814 watchpoint_value_print (w->val, stb);
10815 ui_out_field_stream (uiout, "value", stb);
10816 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
10817 result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
10820 case bp_access_watchpoint:
10821 if (bs->old_val != NULL)
10823 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
10824 ui_out_field_string
10826 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_ACCESS_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
10828 make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "value");
10829 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nOld value = ");
10830 watchpoint_value_print (bs->old_val, stb);
10831 ui_out_field_stream (uiout, "old", stb);
10832 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nNew value = ");
10837 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
10838 ui_out_field_string
10840 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_ACCESS_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
10841 make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "value");
10842 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nValue = ");
10844 watchpoint_value_print (w->val, stb);
10845 ui_out_field_stream (uiout, "new", stb);
10846 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
10847 result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
10850 result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
10853 do_cleanups (old_chain);
10857 /* Implement the "print_mention" breakpoint_ops method for hardware
10861 print_mention_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *b)
10863 struct cleanup *ui_out_chain;
10864 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
10865 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
10869 case bp_watchpoint:
10870 ui_out_text (uiout, "Watchpoint ");
10871 ui_out_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "wpt");
10873 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
10874 ui_out_text (uiout, "Hardware watchpoint ");
10875 ui_out_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "wpt");
10877 case bp_read_watchpoint:
10878 ui_out_text (uiout, "Hardware read watchpoint ");
10879 ui_out_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "hw-rwpt");
10881 case bp_access_watchpoint:
10882 ui_out_text (uiout, "Hardware access (read/write) watchpoint ");
10883 ui_out_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "hw-awpt");
10886 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
10887 _("Invalid hardware watchpoint type."));
10890 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "number", b->number);
10891 ui_out_text (uiout, ": ");
10892 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "exp", w->exp_string);
10893 do_cleanups (ui_out_chain);
10896 /* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for
10900 print_recreate_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
10902 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
10906 case bp_watchpoint:
10907 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
10908 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "watch");
10910 case bp_read_watchpoint:
10911 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "rwatch");
10913 case bp_access_watchpoint:
10914 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "awatch");
10917 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
10918 _("Invalid watchpoint type."));
10921 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " %s", w->exp_string);
10922 print_recreate_thread (b, fp);
10925 /* Implement the "explains_signal" breakpoint_ops method for
10929 explains_signal_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *b, enum gdb_signal sig)
10931 /* A software watchpoint cannot cause a signal other than
10932 GDB_SIGNAL_TRAP. */
10933 if (b->type == bp_watchpoint && sig != GDB_SIGNAL_TRAP)
10939 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in hardware watchpoints. */
10941 static struct breakpoint_ops watchpoint_breakpoint_ops;
10943 /* Implement the "insert" breakpoint_ops method for
10944 masked hardware watchpoints. */
10947 insert_masked_watchpoint (struct bp_location *bl)
10949 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bl->owner;
10951 return target_insert_mask_watchpoint (bl->address, w->hw_wp_mask,
10952 bl->watchpoint_type);
10955 /* Implement the "remove" breakpoint_ops method for
10956 masked hardware watchpoints. */
10959 remove_masked_watchpoint (struct bp_location *bl, enum remove_bp_reason reason)
10961 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bl->owner;
10963 return target_remove_mask_watchpoint (bl->address, w->hw_wp_mask,
10964 bl->watchpoint_type);
10967 /* Implement the "resources_needed" breakpoint_ops method for
10968 masked hardware watchpoints. */
10971 resources_needed_masked_watchpoint (const struct bp_location *bl)
10973 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bl->owner;
10975 return target_masked_watch_num_registers (bl->address, w->hw_wp_mask);
10978 /* Implement the "works_in_software_mode" breakpoint_ops method for
10979 masked hardware watchpoints. */
10982 works_in_software_mode_masked_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *b)
10987 /* Implement the "print_it" breakpoint_ops method for
10988 masked hardware watchpoints. */
10990 static enum print_stop_action
10991 print_it_masked_watchpoint (bpstat bs)
10993 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
10994 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
10996 /* Masked watchpoints have only one location. */
10997 gdb_assert (b->loc && b->loc->next == NULL);
10999 annotate_watchpoint (b->number);
11000 maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (uiout);
11004 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
11005 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
11006 ui_out_field_string
11008 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
11011 case bp_read_watchpoint:
11012 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
11013 ui_out_field_string
11015 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_READ_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
11018 case bp_access_watchpoint:
11019 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
11020 ui_out_field_string
11022 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_ACCESS_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
11025 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
11026 _("Invalid hardware watchpoint type."));
11030 ui_out_text (uiout, _("\n\
11031 Check the underlying instruction at PC for the memory\n\
11032 address and value which triggered this watchpoint.\n"));
11033 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
11035 /* More than one watchpoint may have been triggered. */
11036 return PRINT_UNKNOWN;
11039 /* Implement the "print_one_detail" breakpoint_ops method for
11040 masked hardware watchpoints. */
11043 print_one_detail_masked_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *b,
11044 struct ui_out *uiout)
11046 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
11048 /* Masked watchpoints have only one location. */
11049 gdb_assert (b->loc && b->loc->next == NULL);
11051 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tmask ");
11052 ui_out_field_core_addr (uiout, "mask", b->loc->gdbarch, w->hw_wp_mask);
11053 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
11056 /* Implement the "print_mention" breakpoint_ops method for
11057 masked hardware watchpoints. */
11060 print_mention_masked_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *b)
11062 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
11063 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
11064 struct cleanup *ui_out_chain;
11068 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
11069 ui_out_text (uiout, "Masked hardware watchpoint ");
11070 ui_out_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "wpt");
11072 case bp_read_watchpoint:
11073 ui_out_text (uiout, "Masked hardware read watchpoint ");
11074 ui_out_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "hw-rwpt");
11076 case bp_access_watchpoint:
11077 ui_out_text (uiout, "Masked hardware access (read/write) watchpoint ");
11078 ui_out_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "hw-awpt");
11081 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
11082 _("Invalid hardware watchpoint type."));
11085 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "number", b->number);
11086 ui_out_text (uiout, ": ");
11087 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "exp", w->exp_string);
11088 do_cleanups (ui_out_chain);
11091 /* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for
11092 masked hardware watchpoints. */
11095 print_recreate_masked_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
11097 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
11102 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
11103 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "watch");
11105 case bp_read_watchpoint:
11106 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "rwatch");
11108 case bp_access_watchpoint:
11109 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "awatch");
11112 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
11113 _("Invalid hardware watchpoint type."));
11116 sprintf_vma (tmp, w->hw_wp_mask);
11117 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " %s mask 0x%s", w->exp_string, tmp);
11118 print_recreate_thread (b, fp);
11121 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in masked hardware watchpoints. */
11123 static struct breakpoint_ops masked_watchpoint_breakpoint_ops;
11125 /* Tell whether the given watchpoint is a masked hardware watchpoint. */
11128 is_masked_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *b)
11130 return b->ops == &masked_watchpoint_breakpoint_ops;
11133 /* accessflag: hw_write: watch write,
11134 hw_read: watch read,
11135 hw_access: watch access (read or write) */
11137 watch_command_1 (const char *arg, int accessflag, int from_tty,
11138 int just_location, int internal)
11140 struct breakpoint *b, *scope_breakpoint = NULL;
11141 const struct block *exp_valid_block = NULL, *cond_exp_valid_block = NULL;
11142 struct value *val, *mark, *result;
11143 int saved_bitpos = 0, saved_bitsize = 0;
11144 struct frame_info *frame;
11145 const char *exp_start = NULL;
11146 const char *exp_end = NULL;
11147 const char *tok, *end_tok;
11149 const char *cond_start = NULL;
11150 const char *cond_end = NULL;
11151 enum bptype bp_type;
11154 /* Flag to indicate whether we are going to use masks for
11155 the hardware watchpoint. */
11157 CORE_ADDR mask = 0;
11158 struct watchpoint *w;
11160 struct cleanup *back_to;
11162 /* Make sure that we actually have parameters to parse. */
11163 if (arg != NULL && arg[0] != '\0')
11165 const char *value_start;
11167 exp_end = arg + strlen (arg);
11169 /* Look for "parameter value" pairs at the end
11170 of the arguments string. */
11171 for (tok = exp_end - 1; tok > arg; tok--)
11173 /* Skip whitespace at the end of the argument list. */
11174 while (tok > arg && (*tok == ' ' || *tok == '\t'))
11177 /* Find the beginning of the last token.
11178 This is the value of the parameter. */
11179 while (tok > arg && (*tok != ' ' && *tok != '\t'))
11181 value_start = tok + 1;
11183 /* Skip whitespace. */
11184 while (tok > arg && (*tok == ' ' || *tok == '\t'))
11189 /* Find the beginning of the second to last token.
11190 This is the parameter itself. */
11191 while (tok > arg && (*tok != ' ' && *tok != '\t'))
11194 toklen = end_tok - tok + 1;
11196 if (toklen == 6 && startswith (tok, "thread"))
11198 struct thread_info *thr;
11199 /* At this point we've found a "thread" token, which means
11200 the user is trying to set a watchpoint that triggers
11201 only in a specific thread. */
11205 error(_("You can specify only one thread."));
11207 /* Extract the thread ID from the next token. */
11208 thr = parse_thread_id (value_start, &endp);
11210 /* Check if the user provided a valid thread ID. */
11211 if (*endp != ' ' && *endp != '\t' && *endp != '\0')
11212 invalid_thread_id_error (value_start);
11214 thread = thr->global_num;
11216 else if (toklen == 4 && startswith (tok, "mask"))
11218 /* We've found a "mask" token, which means the user wants to
11219 create a hardware watchpoint that is going to have the mask
11221 struct value *mask_value, *mark;
11224 error(_("You can specify only one mask."));
11226 use_mask = just_location = 1;
11228 mark = value_mark ();
11229 mask_value = parse_to_comma_and_eval (&value_start);
11230 mask = value_as_address (mask_value);
11231 value_free_to_mark (mark);
11234 /* We didn't recognize what we found. We should stop here. */
11237 /* Truncate the string and get rid of the "parameter value" pair before
11238 the arguments string is parsed by the parse_exp_1 function. */
11245 /* Parse the rest of the arguments. From here on out, everything
11246 is in terms of a newly allocated string instead of the original
11248 innermost_block = NULL;
11249 expression = savestring (arg, exp_end - arg);
11250 back_to = make_cleanup (xfree, expression);
11251 exp_start = arg = expression;
11252 expression_up exp = parse_exp_1 (&arg, 0, 0, 0);
11254 /* Remove trailing whitespace from the expression before saving it.
11255 This makes the eventual display of the expression string a bit
11257 while (exp_end > exp_start && (exp_end[-1] == ' ' || exp_end[-1] == '\t'))
11260 /* Checking if the expression is not constant. */
11261 if (watchpoint_exp_is_const (exp.get ()))
11265 len = exp_end - exp_start;
11266 while (len > 0 && isspace (exp_start[len - 1]))
11268 error (_("Cannot watch constant value `%.*s'."), len, exp_start);
11271 exp_valid_block = innermost_block;
11272 mark = value_mark ();
11273 fetch_subexp_value (exp.get (), &pc, &val, &result, NULL, just_location);
11275 if (val != NULL && just_location)
11277 saved_bitpos = value_bitpos (val);
11278 saved_bitsize = value_bitsize (val);
11285 exp_valid_block = NULL;
11286 val = value_addr (result);
11287 release_value (val);
11288 value_free_to_mark (mark);
11292 ret = target_masked_watch_num_registers (value_as_address (val),
11295 error (_("This target does not support masked watchpoints."));
11296 else if (ret == -2)
11297 error (_("Invalid mask or memory region."));
11300 else if (val != NULL)
11301 release_value (val);
11303 tok = skip_spaces_const (arg);
11304 end_tok = skip_to_space_const (tok);
11306 toklen = end_tok - tok;
11307 if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "if", toklen) == 0)
11309 innermost_block = NULL;
11310 tok = cond_start = end_tok + 1;
11311 parse_exp_1 (&tok, 0, 0, 0);
11313 /* The watchpoint expression may not be local, but the condition
11314 may still be. E.g.: `watch global if local > 0'. */
11315 cond_exp_valid_block = innermost_block;
11320 error (_("Junk at end of command."));
11322 frame = block_innermost_frame (exp_valid_block);
11324 /* If the expression is "local", then set up a "watchpoint scope"
11325 breakpoint at the point where we've left the scope of the watchpoint
11326 expression. Create the scope breakpoint before the watchpoint, so
11327 that we will encounter it first in bpstat_stop_status. */
11328 if (exp_valid_block && frame)
11330 if (frame_id_p (frame_unwind_caller_id (frame)))
11333 = create_internal_breakpoint (frame_unwind_caller_arch (frame),
11334 frame_unwind_caller_pc (frame),
11335 bp_watchpoint_scope,
11336 &momentary_breakpoint_ops);
11338 scope_breakpoint->enable_state = bp_enabled;
11340 /* Automatically delete the breakpoint when it hits. */
11341 scope_breakpoint->disposition = disp_del;
11343 /* Only break in the proper frame (help with recursion). */
11344 scope_breakpoint->frame_id = frame_unwind_caller_id (frame);
11346 /* Set the address at which we will stop. */
11347 scope_breakpoint->loc->gdbarch
11348 = frame_unwind_caller_arch (frame);
11349 scope_breakpoint->loc->requested_address
11350 = frame_unwind_caller_pc (frame);
11351 scope_breakpoint->loc->address
11352 = adjust_breakpoint_address (scope_breakpoint->loc->gdbarch,
11353 scope_breakpoint->loc->requested_address,
11354 scope_breakpoint->type);
11358 /* Now set up the breakpoint. We create all watchpoints as hardware
11359 watchpoints here even if hardware watchpoints are turned off, a call
11360 to update_watchpoint later in this function will cause the type to
11361 drop back to bp_watchpoint (software watchpoint) if required. */
11363 if (accessflag == hw_read)
11364 bp_type = bp_read_watchpoint;
11365 else if (accessflag == hw_access)
11366 bp_type = bp_access_watchpoint;
11368 bp_type = bp_hardware_watchpoint;
11370 w = new watchpoint ();
11373 init_raw_breakpoint_without_location (b, NULL, bp_type,
11374 &masked_watchpoint_breakpoint_ops);
11376 init_raw_breakpoint_without_location (b, NULL, bp_type,
11377 &watchpoint_breakpoint_ops);
11378 b->thread = thread;
11379 b->disposition = disp_donttouch;
11380 b->pspace = current_program_space;
11381 w->exp = std::move (exp);
11382 w->exp_valid_block = exp_valid_block;
11383 w->cond_exp_valid_block = cond_exp_valid_block;
11386 struct type *t = value_type (val);
11387 CORE_ADDR addr = value_as_address (val);
11389 t = check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (check_typedef (t)));
11391 std::string name = type_to_string (t);
11393 w->exp_string_reparse = xstrprintf ("* (%s *) %s", name.c_str (),
11394 core_addr_to_string (addr));
11396 w->exp_string = xstrprintf ("-location %.*s",
11397 (int) (exp_end - exp_start), exp_start);
11399 /* The above expression is in C. */
11400 b->language = language_c;
11403 w->exp_string = savestring (exp_start, exp_end - exp_start);
11407 w->hw_wp_mask = mask;
11412 w->val_bitpos = saved_bitpos;
11413 w->val_bitsize = saved_bitsize;
11418 b->cond_string = savestring (cond_start, cond_end - cond_start);
11420 b->cond_string = 0;
11424 w->watchpoint_frame = get_frame_id (frame);
11425 w->watchpoint_thread = inferior_ptid;
11429 w->watchpoint_frame = null_frame_id;
11430 w->watchpoint_thread = null_ptid;
11433 if (scope_breakpoint != NULL)
11435 /* The scope breakpoint is related to the watchpoint. We will
11436 need to act on them together. */
11437 b->related_breakpoint = scope_breakpoint;
11438 scope_breakpoint->related_breakpoint = b;
11441 if (!just_location)
11442 value_free_to_mark (mark);
11446 /* Finally update the new watchpoint. This creates the locations
11447 that should be inserted. */
11448 update_watchpoint (w, 1);
11450 CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ALL)
11452 delete_breakpoint (b);
11453 throw_exception (e);
11457 install_breakpoint (internal, b, 1);
11458 do_cleanups (back_to);
11461 /* Return count of debug registers needed to watch the given expression.
11462 If the watchpoint cannot be handled in hardware return zero. */
11465 can_use_hardware_watchpoint (struct value *v)
11467 int found_memory_cnt = 0;
11468 struct value *head = v;
11470 /* Did the user specifically forbid us to use hardware watchpoints? */
11471 if (!can_use_hw_watchpoints)
11474 /* Make sure that the value of the expression depends only upon
11475 memory contents, and values computed from them within GDB. If we
11476 find any register references or function calls, we can't use a
11477 hardware watchpoint.
11479 The idea here is that evaluating an expression generates a series
11480 of values, one holding the value of every subexpression. (The
11481 expression a*b+c has five subexpressions: a, b, a*b, c, and
11482 a*b+c.) GDB's values hold almost enough information to establish
11483 the criteria given above --- they identify memory lvalues,
11484 register lvalues, computed values, etcetera. So we can evaluate
11485 the expression, and then scan the chain of values that leaves
11486 behind to decide whether we can detect any possible change to the
11487 expression's final value using only hardware watchpoints.
11489 However, I don't think that the values returned by inferior
11490 function calls are special in any way. So this function may not
11491 notice that an expression involving an inferior function call
11492 can't be watched with hardware watchpoints. FIXME. */
11493 for (; v; v = value_next (v))
11495 if (VALUE_LVAL (v) == lval_memory)
11497 if (v != head && value_lazy (v))
11498 /* A lazy memory lvalue in the chain is one that GDB never
11499 needed to fetch; we either just used its address (e.g.,
11500 `a' in `a.b') or we never needed it at all (e.g., `a'
11501 in `a,b'). This doesn't apply to HEAD; if that is
11502 lazy then it was not readable, but watch it anyway. */
11506 /* Ahh, memory we actually used! Check if we can cover
11507 it with hardware watchpoints. */
11508 struct type *vtype = check_typedef (value_type (v));
11510 /* We only watch structs and arrays if user asked for it
11511 explicitly, never if they just happen to appear in a
11512 middle of some value chain. */
11514 || (TYPE_CODE (vtype) != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
11515 && TYPE_CODE (vtype) != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY))
11517 CORE_ADDR vaddr = value_address (v);
11521 len = (target_exact_watchpoints
11522 && is_scalar_type_recursive (vtype))?
11523 1 : TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (v));
11525 num_regs = target_region_ok_for_hw_watchpoint (vaddr, len);
11529 found_memory_cnt += num_regs;
11533 else if (VALUE_LVAL (v) != not_lval
11534 && deprecated_value_modifiable (v) == 0)
11535 return 0; /* These are values from the history (e.g., $1). */
11536 else if (VALUE_LVAL (v) == lval_register)
11537 return 0; /* Cannot watch a register with a HW watchpoint. */
11540 /* The expression itself looks suitable for using a hardware
11541 watchpoint, but give the target machine a chance to reject it. */
11542 return found_memory_cnt;
11546 watch_command_wrapper (char *arg, int from_tty, int internal)
11548 watch_command_1 (arg, hw_write, from_tty, 0, internal);
11551 /* A helper function that looks for the "-location" argument and then
11552 calls watch_command_1. */
11555 watch_maybe_just_location (char *arg, int accessflag, int from_tty)
11557 int just_location = 0;
11560 && (check_for_argument (&arg, "-location", sizeof ("-location") - 1)
11561 || check_for_argument (&arg, "-l", sizeof ("-l") - 1)))
11563 arg = skip_spaces (arg);
11567 watch_command_1 (arg, accessflag, from_tty, just_location, 0);
11571 watch_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
11573 watch_maybe_just_location (arg, hw_write, from_tty);
11577 rwatch_command_wrapper (char *arg, int from_tty, int internal)
11579 watch_command_1 (arg, hw_read, from_tty, 0, internal);
11583 rwatch_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
11585 watch_maybe_just_location (arg, hw_read, from_tty);
11589 awatch_command_wrapper (char *arg, int from_tty, int internal)
11591 watch_command_1 (arg, hw_access, from_tty, 0, internal);
11595 awatch_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
11597 watch_maybe_just_location (arg, hw_access, from_tty);
11601 /* Data for the FSM that manages the until(location)/advance commands
11602 in infcmd.c. Here because it uses the mechanisms of
11605 struct until_break_fsm
11607 /* The base class. */
11608 struct thread_fsm thread_fsm;
11610 /* The thread that as current when the command was executed. */
11613 /* The breakpoint set at the destination location. */
11614 struct breakpoint *location_breakpoint;
11616 /* Breakpoint set at the return address in the caller frame. May be
11618 struct breakpoint *caller_breakpoint;
11621 static void until_break_fsm_clean_up (struct thread_fsm *self,
11622 struct thread_info *thread);
11623 static int until_break_fsm_should_stop (struct thread_fsm *self,
11624 struct thread_info *thread);
11625 static enum async_reply_reason
11626 until_break_fsm_async_reply_reason (struct thread_fsm *self);
11628 /* until_break_fsm's vtable. */
11630 static struct thread_fsm_ops until_break_fsm_ops =
11633 until_break_fsm_clean_up,
11634 until_break_fsm_should_stop,
11635 NULL, /* return_value */
11636 until_break_fsm_async_reply_reason,
11639 /* Allocate a new until_break_command_fsm. */
11641 static struct until_break_fsm *
11642 new_until_break_fsm (struct interp *cmd_interp, int thread,
11643 struct breakpoint *location_breakpoint,
11644 struct breakpoint *caller_breakpoint)
11646 struct until_break_fsm *sm;
11648 sm = XCNEW (struct until_break_fsm);
11649 thread_fsm_ctor (&sm->thread_fsm, &until_break_fsm_ops, cmd_interp);
11651 sm->thread = thread;
11652 sm->location_breakpoint = location_breakpoint;
11653 sm->caller_breakpoint = caller_breakpoint;
11658 /* Implementation of the 'should_stop' FSM method for the
11659 until(location)/advance commands. */
11662 until_break_fsm_should_stop (struct thread_fsm *self,
11663 struct thread_info *tp)
11665 struct until_break_fsm *sm = (struct until_break_fsm *) self;
11667 if (bpstat_find_breakpoint (tp->control.stop_bpstat,
11668 sm->location_breakpoint) != NULL
11669 || (sm->caller_breakpoint != NULL
11670 && bpstat_find_breakpoint (tp->control.stop_bpstat,
11671 sm->caller_breakpoint) != NULL))
11672 thread_fsm_set_finished (self);
11677 /* Implementation of the 'clean_up' FSM method for the
11678 until(location)/advance commands. */
11681 until_break_fsm_clean_up (struct thread_fsm *self,
11682 struct thread_info *thread)
11684 struct until_break_fsm *sm = (struct until_break_fsm *) self;
11686 /* Clean up our temporary breakpoints. */
11687 if (sm->location_breakpoint != NULL)
11689 delete_breakpoint (sm->location_breakpoint);
11690 sm->location_breakpoint = NULL;
11692 if (sm->caller_breakpoint != NULL)
11694 delete_breakpoint (sm->caller_breakpoint);
11695 sm->caller_breakpoint = NULL;
11697 delete_longjmp_breakpoint (sm->thread);
11700 /* Implementation of the 'async_reply_reason' FSM method for the
11701 until(location)/advance commands. */
11703 static enum async_reply_reason
11704 until_break_fsm_async_reply_reason (struct thread_fsm *self)
11706 return EXEC_ASYNC_LOCATION_REACHED;
11710 until_break_command (char *arg, int from_tty, int anywhere)
11712 struct symtabs_and_lines sals;
11713 struct symtab_and_line sal;
11714 struct frame_info *frame;
11715 struct gdbarch *frame_gdbarch;
11716 struct frame_id stack_frame_id;
11717 struct frame_id caller_frame_id;
11718 struct breakpoint *location_breakpoint;
11719 struct breakpoint *caller_breakpoint = NULL;
11720 struct cleanup *old_chain, *cleanup;
11722 struct thread_info *tp;
11723 struct event_location *location;
11724 struct until_break_fsm *sm;
11726 clear_proceed_status (0);
11728 /* Set a breakpoint where the user wants it and at return from
11731 location = string_to_event_location (&arg, current_language);
11732 cleanup = make_cleanup_delete_event_location (location);
11734 if (last_displayed_sal_is_valid ())
11735 sals = decode_line_1 (location, DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE, NULL,
11736 get_last_displayed_symtab (),
11737 get_last_displayed_line ());
11739 sals = decode_line_1 (location, DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE,
11740 NULL, (struct symtab *) NULL, 0);
11742 if (sals.nelts != 1)
11743 error (_("Couldn't get information on specified line."));
11745 sal = sals.sals[0];
11746 xfree (sals.sals); /* malloc'd, so freed. */
11749 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
11751 resolve_sal_pc (&sal);
11753 tp = inferior_thread ();
11754 thread = tp->global_num;
11756 old_chain = make_cleanup (null_cleanup, NULL);
11758 /* Note linespec handling above invalidates the frame chain.
11759 Installing a breakpoint also invalidates the frame chain (as it
11760 may need to switch threads), so do any frame handling before
11763 frame = get_selected_frame (NULL);
11764 frame_gdbarch = get_frame_arch (frame);
11765 stack_frame_id = get_stack_frame_id (frame);
11766 caller_frame_id = frame_unwind_caller_id (frame);
11768 /* Keep within the current frame, or in frames called by the current
11771 if (frame_id_p (caller_frame_id))
11773 struct symtab_and_line sal2;
11774 struct gdbarch *caller_gdbarch;
11776 sal2 = find_pc_line (frame_unwind_caller_pc (frame), 0);
11777 sal2.pc = frame_unwind_caller_pc (frame);
11778 caller_gdbarch = frame_unwind_caller_arch (frame);
11779 caller_breakpoint = set_momentary_breakpoint (caller_gdbarch,
11783 make_cleanup_delete_breakpoint (caller_breakpoint);
11785 set_longjmp_breakpoint (tp, caller_frame_id);
11786 make_cleanup (delete_longjmp_breakpoint_cleanup, &thread);
11789 /* set_momentary_breakpoint could invalidate FRAME. */
11793 /* If the user told us to continue until a specified location,
11794 we don't specify a frame at which we need to stop. */
11795 location_breakpoint = set_momentary_breakpoint (frame_gdbarch, sal,
11796 null_frame_id, bp_until);
11798 /* Otherwise, specify the selected frame, because we want to stop
11799 only at the very same frame. */
11800 location_breakpoint = set_momentary_breakpoint (frame_gdbarch, sal,
11801 stack_frame_id, bp_until);
11802 make_cleanup_delete_breakpoint (location_breakpoint);
11804 sm = new_until_break_fsm (command_interp (), tp->global_num,
11805 location_breakpoint, caller_breakpoint);
11806 tp->thread_fsm = &sm->thread_fsm;
11808 discard_cleanups (old_chain);
11810 proceed (-1, GDB_SIGNAL_DEFAULT);
11812 do_cleanups (cleanup);
11815 /* This function attempts to parse an optional "if <cond>" clause
11816 from the arg string. If one is not found, it returns NULL.
11818 Else, it returns a pointer to the condition string. (It does not
11819 attempt to evaluate the string against a particular block.) And,
11820 it updates arg to point to the first character following the parsed
11821 if clause in the arg string. */
11824 ep_parse_optional_if_clause (char **arg)
11828 if (((*arg)[0] != 'i') || ((*arg)[1] != 'f') || !isspace ((*arg)[2]))
11831 /* Skip the "if" keyword. */
11834 /* Skip any extra leading whitespace, and record the start of the
11835 condition string. */
11836 *arg = skip_spaces (*arg);
11837 cond_string = *arg;
11839 /* Assume that the condition occupies the remainder of the arg
11841 (*arg) += strlen (cond_string);
11843 return cond_string;
11846 /* Commands to deal with catching events, such as signals, exceptions,
11847 process start/exit, etc. */
11851 catch_fork_temporary, catch_vfork_temporary,
11852 catch_fork_permanent, catch_vfork_permanent
11857 catch_fork_command_1 (char *arg, int from_tty,
11858 struct cmd_list_element *command)
11860 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
11861 char *cond_string = NULL;
11862 catch_fork_kind fork_kind;
11865 fork_kind = (catch_fork_kind) (uintptr_t) get_cmd_context (command);
11866 tempflag = (fork_kind == catch_fork_temporary
11867 || fork_kind == catch_vfork_temporary);
11871 arg = skip_spaces (arg);
11873 /* The allowed syntax is:
11875 catch [v]fork if <cond>
11877 First, check if there's an if clause. */
11878 cond_string = ep_parse_optional_if_clause (&arg);
11880 if ((*arg != '\0') && !isspace (*arg))
11881 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
11883 /* If this target supports it, create a fork or vfork catchpoint
11884 and enable reporting of such events. */
11887 case catch_fork_temporary:
11888 case catch_fork_permanent:
11889 create_fork_vfork_event_catchpoint (gdbarch, tempflag, cond_string,
11890 &catch_fork_breakpoint_ops);
11892 case catch_vfork_temporary:
11893 case catch_vfork_permanent:
11894 create_fork_vfork_event_catchpoint (gdbarch, tempflag, cond_string,
11895 &catch_vfork_breakpoint_ops);
11898 error (_("unsupported or unknown fork kind; cannot catch it"));
11904 catch_exec_command_1 (char *arg, int from_tty,
11905 struct cmd_list_element *command)
11907 struct exec_catchpoint *c;
11908 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
11910 char *cond_string = NULL;
11912 tempflag = get_cmd_context (command) == CATCH_TEMPORARY;
11916 arg = skip_spaces (arg);
11918 /* The allowed syntax is:
11920 catch exec if <cond>
11922 First, check if there's an if clause. */
11923 cond_string = ep_parse_optional_if_clause (&arg);
11925 if ((*arg != '\0') && !isspace (*arg))
11926 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
11928 c = new exec_catchpoint ();
11929 init_catchpoint (&c->base, gdbarch, tempflag, cond_string,
11930 &catch_exec_breakpoint_ops);
11931 c->exec_pathname = NULL;
11933 install_breakpoint (0, &c->base, 1);
11937 init_ada_exception_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b,
11938 struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
11939 struct symtab_and_line sal,
11941 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
11948 struct gdbarch *loc_gdbarch = get_sal_arch (sal);
11950 loc_gdbarch = gdbarch;
11952 describe_other_breakpoints (loc_gdbarch,
11953 sal.pspace, sal.pc, sal.section, -1);
11954 /* FIXME: brobecker/2006-12-28: Actually, re-implement a special
11955 version for exception catchpoints, because two catchpoints
11956 used for different exception names will use the same address.
11957 In this case, a "breakpoint ... also set at..." warning is
11958 unproductive. Besides, the warning phrasing is also a bit
11959 inappropriate, we should use the word catchpoint, and tell
11960 the user what type of catchpoint it is. The above is good
11961 enough for now, though. */
11964 init_raw_breakpoint (b, gdbarch, sal, bp_breakpoint, ops);
11966 b->enable_state = enabled ? bp_enabled : bp_disabled;
11967 b->disposition = tempflag ? disp_del : disp_donttouch;
11968 b->location = string_to_event_location (&addr_string,
11969 language_def (language_ada));
11970 b->language = language_ada;
11974 catch_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
11976 error (_("Catch requires an event name."));
11981 tcatch_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
11983 error (_("Catch requires an event name."));
11986 /* A qsort comparison function that sorts breakpoints in order. */
11989 compare_breakpoints (const void *a, const void *b)
11991 const breakpoint_p *ba = (const breakpoint_p *) a;
11992 uintptr_t ua = (uintptr_t) *ba;
11993 const breakpoint_p *bb = (const breakpoint_p *) b;
11994 uintptr_t ub = (uintptr_t) *bb;
11996 if ((*ba)->number < (*bb)->number)
11998 else if ((*ba)->number > (*bb)->number)
12001 /* Now sort by address, in case we see, e..g, two breakpoints with
12005 return ua > ub ? 1 : 0;
12008 /* Delete breakpoints by address or line. */
12011 clear_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
12013 struct breakpoint *b, *prev;
12014 VEC(breakpoint_p) *found = 0;
12017 struct symtabs_and_lines sals;
12018 struct symtab_and_line sal;
12020 struct cleanup *cleanups = make_cleanup (null_cleanup, NULL);
12024 sals = decode_line_with_current_source (arg,
12025 (DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE
12026 | DECODE_LINE_LIST_MODE));
12027 make_cleanup (xfree, sals.sals);
12032 sals.sals = XNEW (struct symtab_and_line);
12033 make_cleanup (xfree, sals.sals);
12034 init_sal (&sal); /* Initialize to zeroes. */
12036 /* Set sal's line, symtab, pc, and pspace to the values
12037 corresponding to the last call to print_frame_info. If the
12038 codepoint is not valid, this will set all the fields to 0. */
12039 get_last_displayed_sal (&sal);
12040 if (sal.symtab == 0)
12041 error (_("No source file specified."));
12043 sals.sals[0] = sal;
12049 /* We don't call resolve_sal_pc here. That's not as bad as it
12050 seems, because all existing breakpoints typically have both
12051 file/line and pc set. So, if clear is given file/line, we can
12052 match this to existing breakpoint without obtaining pc at all.
12054 We only support clearing given the address explicitly
12055 present in breakpoint table. Say, we've set breakpoint
12056 at file:line. There were several PC values for that file:line,
12057 due to optimization, all in one block.
12059 We've picked one PC value. If "clear" is issued with another
12060 PC corresponding to the same file:line, the breakpoint won't
12061 be cleared. We probably can still clear the breakpoint, but
12062 since the other PC value is never presented to user, user
12063 can only find it by guessing, and it does not seem important
12064 to support that. */
12066 /* For each line spec given, delete bps which correspond to it. Do
12067 it in two passes, solely to preserve the current behavior that
12068 from_tty is forced true if we delete more than one
12072 make_cleanup (VEC_cleanup (breakpoint_p), &found);
12073 for (i = 0; i < sals.nelts; i++)
12075 const char *sal_fullname;
12077 /* If exact pc given, clear bpts at that pc.
12078 If line given (pc == 0), clear all bpts on specified line.
12079 If defaulting, clear all bpts on default line
12082 defaulting sal.pc != 0 tests to do
12087 1 0 <can't happen> */
12089 sal = sals.sals[i];
12090 sal_fullname = (sal.symtab == NULL
12091 ? NULL : symtab_to_fullname (sal.symtab));
12093 /* Find all matching breakpoints and add them to 'found'. */
12094 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
12097 /* Are we going to delete b? */
12098 if (b->type != bp_none && !is_watchpoint (b))
12100 struct bp_location *loc = b->loc;
12101 for (; loc; loc = loc->next)
12103 /* If the user specified file:line, don't allow a PC
12104 match. This matches historical gdb behavior. */
12105 int pc_match = (!sal.explicit_line
12107 && (loc->pspace == sal.pspace)
12108 && (loc->address == sal.pc)
12109 && (!section_is_overlay (loc->section)
12110 || loc->section == sal.section));
12111 int line_match = 0;
12113 if ((default_match || sal.explicit_line)
12114 && loc->symtab != NULL
12115 && sal_fullname != NULL
12116 && sal.pspace == loc->pspace
12117 && loc->line_number == sal.line
12118 && filename_cmp (symtab_to_fullname (loc->symtab),
12119 sal_fullname) == 0)
12122 if (pc_match || line_match)
12131 VEC_safe_push(breakpoint_p, found, b);
12135 /* Now go thru the 'found' chain and delete them. */
12136 if (VEC_empty(breakpoint_p, found))
12139 error (_("No breakpoint at %s."), arg);
12141 error (_("No breakpoint at this line."));
12144 /* Remove duplicates from the vec. */
12145 qsort (VEC_address (breakpoint_p, found),
12146 VEC_length (breakpoint_p, found),
12147 sizeof (breakpoint_p),
12148 compare_breakpoints);
12149 prev = VEC_index (breakpoint_p, found, 0);
12150 for (ix = 1; VEC_iterate (breakpoint_p, found, ix, b); ++ix)
12154 VEC_ordered_remove (breakpoint_p, found, ix);
12159 if (VEC_length(breakpoint_p, found) > 1)
12160 from_tty = 1; /* Always report if deleted more than one. */
12163 if (VEC_length(breakpoint_p, found) == 1)
12164 printf_unfiltered (_("Deleted breakpoint "));
12166 printf_unfiltered (_("Deleted breakpoints "));
12169 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate(breakpoint_p, found, ix, b); ix++)
12172 printf_unfiltered ("%d ", b->number);
12173 delete_breakpoint (b);
12176 putchar_unfiltered ('\n');
12178 do_cleanups (cleanups);
12181 /* Delete breakpoint in BS if they are `delete' breakpoints and
12182 all breakpoints that are marked for deletion, whether hit or not.
12183 This is called after any breakpoint is hit, or after errors. */
12186 breakpoint_auto_delete (bpstat bs)
12188 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
12190 for (; bs; bs = bs->next)
12191 if (bs->breakpoint_at
12192 && bs->breakpoint_at->disposition == disp_del
12194 delete_breakpoint (bs->breakpoint_at);
12196 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
12198 if (b->disposition == disp_del_at_next_stop)
12199 delete_breakpoint (b);
12203 /* A comparison function for bp_location AP and BP being interfaced to
12204 qsort. Sort elements primarily by their ADDRESS (no matter what
12205 does breakpoint_address_is_meaningful say for its OWNER),
12206 secondarily by ordering first permanent elements and
12207 terciarily just ensuring the array is sorted stable way despite
12208 qsort being an unstable algorithm. */
12211 bp_location_compare (const void *ap, const void *bp)
12213 const struct bp_location *a = *(const struct bp_location **) ap;
12214 const struct bp_location *b = *(const struct bp_location **) bp;
12216 if (a->address != b->address)
12217 return (a->address > b->address) - (a->address < b->address);
12219 /* Sort locations at the same address by their pspace number, keeping
12220 locations of the same inferior (in a multi-inferior environment)
12223 if (a->pspace->num != b->pspace->num)
12224 return ((a->pspace->num > b->pspace->num)
12225 - (a->pspace->num < b->pspace->num));
12227 /* Sort permanent breakpoints first. */
12228 if (a->permanent != b->permanent)
12229 return (a->permanent < b->permanent) - (a->permanent > b->permanent);
12231 /* Make the internal GDB representation stable across GDB runs
12232 where A and B memory inside GDB can differ. Breakpoint locations of
12233 the same type at the same address can be sorted in arbitrary order. */
12235 if (a->owner->number != b->owner->number)
12236 return ((a->owner->number > b->owner->number)
12237 - (a->owner->number < b->owner->number));
12239 return (a > b) - (a < b);
12242 /* Set bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max and
12243 bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max according to the current
12244 content of the bp_location array. */
12247 bp_location_target_extensions_update (void)
12249 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
12251 bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max = 0;
12252 bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max = 0;
12254 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
12256 CORE_ADDR start, end, addr;
12258 if (!bp_location_has_shadow (bl))
12261 start = bl->target_info.placed_address;
12262 end = start + bl->target_info.shadow_len;
12264 gdb_assert (bl->address >= start);
12265 addr = bl->address - start;
12266 if (addr > bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max)
12267 bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max = addr;
12269 /* Zero SHADOW_LEN would not pass bp_location_has_shadow. */
12271 gdb_assert (bl->address < end);
12272 addr = end - bl->address;
12273 if (addr > bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max)
12274 bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max = addr;
12278 /* Download tracepoint locations if they haven't been. */
12281 download_tracepoint_locations (void)
12283 struct breakpoint *b;
12284 struct cleanup *old_chain;
12285 enum tribool can_download_tracepoint = TRIBOOL_UNKNOWN;
12287 old_chain = save_current_space_and_thread ();
12289 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (b)
12291 struct bp_location *bl;
12292 struct tracepoint *t;
12293 int bp_location_downloaded = 0;
12295 if ((b->type == bp_fast_tracepoint
12296 ? !may_insert_fast_tracepoints
12297 : !may_insert_tracepoints))
12300 if (can_download_tracepoint == TRIBOOL_UNKNOWN)
12302 if (target_can_download_tracepoint ())
12303 can_download_tracepoint = TRIBOOL_TRUE;
12305 can_download_tracepoint = TRIBOOL_FALSE;
12308 if (can_download_tracepoint == TRIBOOL_FALSE)
12311 for (bl = b->loc; bl; bl = bl->next)
12313 /* In tracepoint, locations are _never_ duplicated, so
12314 should_be_inserted is equivalent to
12315 unduplicated_should_be_inserted. */
12316 if (!should_be_inserted (bl) || bl->inserted)
12319 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (bl->pspace);
12321 target_download_tracepoint (bl);
12324 bp_location_downloaded = 1;
12326 t = (struct tracepoint *) b;
12327 t->number_on_target = b->number;
12328 if (bp_location_downloaded)
12329 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b);
12332 do_cleanups (old_chain);
12335 /* Swap the insertion/duplication state between two locations. */
12338 swap_insertion (struct bp_location *left, struct bp_location *right)
12340 const int left_inserted = left->inserted;
12341 const int left_duplicate = left->duplicate;
12342 const int left_needs_update = left->needs_update;
12343 const struct bp_target_info left_target_info = left->target_info;
12345 /* Locations of tracepoints can never be duplicated. */
12346 if (is_tracepoint (left->owner))
12347 gdb_assert (!left->duplicate);
12348 if (is_tracepoint (right->owner))
12349 gdb_assert (!right->duplicate);
12351 left->inserted = right->inserted;
12352 left->duplicate = right->duplicate;
12353 left->needs_update = right->needs_update;
12354 left->target_info = right->target_info;
12355 right->inserted = left_inserted;
12356 right->duplicate = left_duplicate;
12357 right->needs_update = left_needs_update;
12358 right->target_info = left_target_info;
12361 /* Force the re-insertion of the locations at ADDRESS. This is called
12362 once a new/deleted/modified duplicate location is found and we are evaluating
12363 conditions on the target's side. Such conditions need to be updated on
12367 force_breakpoint_reinsertion (struct bp_location *bl)
12369 struct bp_location **locp = NULL, **loc2p;
12370 struct bp_location *loc;
12371 CORE_ADDR address = 0;
12374 address = bl->address;
12375 pspace_num = bl->pspace->num;
12377 /* This is only meaningful if the target is
12378 evaluating conditions and if the user has
12379 opted for condition evaluation on the target's
12381 if (gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p ()
12382 || !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
12385 /* Flag all breakpoint locations with this address and
12386 the same program space as the location
12387 as "its condition has changed". We need to
12388 update the conditions on the target's side. */
12389 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (loc2p, locp, address)
12393 if (!is_breakpoint (loc->owner)
12394 || pspace_num != loc->pspace->num)
12397 /* Flag the location appropriately. We use a different state to
12398 let everyone know that we already updated the set of locations
12399 with addr bl->address and program space bl->pspace. This is so
12400 we don't have to keep calling these functions just to mark locations
12401 that have already been marked. */
12402 loc->condition_changed = condition_updated;
12404 /* Free the agent expression bytecode as well. We will compute
12406 loc->cond_bytecode.reset ();
12409 /* Called whether new breakpoints are created, or existing breakpoints
12410 deleted, to update the global location list and recompute which
12411 locations are duplicate of which.
12413 The INSERT_MODE flag determines whether locations may not, may, or
12414 shall be inserted now. See 'enum ugll_insert_mode' for more
12418 update_global_location_list (enum ugll_insert_mode insert_mode)
12420 struct breakpoint *b;
12421 struct bp_location **locp, *loc;
12422 struct cleanup *cleanups;
12423 /* Last breakpoint location address that was marked for update. */
12424 CORE_ADDR last_addr = 0;
12425 /* Last breakpoint location program space that was marked for update. */
12426 int last_pspace_num = -1;
12428 /* Used in the duplicates detection below. When iterating over all
12429 bp_locations, points to the first bp_location of a given address.
12430 Breakpoints and watchpoints of different types are never
12431 duplicates of each other. Keep one pointer for each type of
12432 breakpoint/watchpoint, so we only need to loop over all locations
12434 struct bp_location *bp_loc_first; /* breakpoint */
12435 struct bp_location *wp_loc_first; /* hardware watchpoint */
12436 struct bp_location *awp_loc_first; /* access watchpoint */
12437 struct bp_location *rwp_loc_first; /* read watchpoint */
12439 /* Saved former bp_location array which we compare against the newly
12440 built bp_location from the current state of ALL_BREAKPOINTS. */
12441 struct bp_location **old_location, **old_locp;
12442 unsigned old_location_count;
12444 old_location = bp_location;
12445 old_location_count = bp_location_count;
12446 bp_location = NULL;
12447 bp_location_count = 0;
12448 cleanups = make_cleanup (xfree, old_location);
12450 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
12451 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
12452 bp_location_count++;
12454 bp_location = XNEWVEC (struct bp_location *, bp_location_count);
12455 locp = bp_location;
12456 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
12457 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
12459 qsort (bp_location, bp_location_count, sizeof (*bp_location),
12460 bp_location_compare);
12462 bp_location_target_extensions_update ();
12464 /* Identify bp_location instances that are no longer present in the
12465 new list, and therefore should be freed. Note that it's not
12466 necessary that those locations should be removed from inferior --
12467 if there's another location at the same address (previously
12468 marked as duplicate), we don't need to remove/insert the
12471 LOCP is kept in sync with OLD_LOCP, each pointing to the current
12472 and former bp_location array state respectively. */
12474 locp = bp_location;
12475 for (old_locp = old_location; old_locp < old_location + old_location_count;
12478 struct bp_location *old_loc = *old_locp;
12479 struct bp_location **loc2p;
12481 /* Tells if 'old_loc' is found among the new locations. If
12482 not, we have to free it. */
12483 int found_object = 0;
12484 /* Tells if the location should remain inserted in the target. */
12485 int keep_in_target = 0;
12488 /* Skip LOCP entries which will definitely never be needed.
12489 Stop either at or being the one matching OLD_LOC. */
12490 while (locp < bp_location + bp_location_count
12491 && (*locp)->address < old_loc->address)
12495 (loc2p < bp_location + bp_location_count
12496 && (*loc2p)->address == old_loc->address);
12499 /* Check if this is a new/duplicated location or a duplicated
12500 location that had its condition modified. If so, we want to send
12501 its condition to the target if evaluation of conditions is taking
12503 if ((*loc2p)->condition_changed == condition_modified
12504 && (last_addr != old_loc->address
12505 || last_pspace_num != old_loc->pspace->num))
12507 force_breakpoint_reinsertion (*loc2p);
12508 last_pspace_num = old_loc->pspace->num;
12511 if (*loc2p == old_loc)
12515 /* We have already handled this address, update it so that we don't
12516 have to go through updates again. */
12517 last_addr = old_loc->address;
12519 /* Target-side condition evaluation: Handle deleted locations. */
12521 force_breakpoint_reinsertion (old_loc);
12523 /* If this location is no longer present, and inserted, look if
12524 there's maybe a new location at the same address. If so,
12525 mark that one inserted, and don't remove this one. This is
12526 needed so that we don't have a time window where a breakpoint
12527 at certain location is not inserted. */
12529 if (old_loc->inserted)
12531 /* If the location is inserted now, we might have to remove
12534 if (found_object && should_be_inserted (old_loc))
12536 /* The location is still present in the location list,
12537 and still should be inserted. Don't do anything. */
12538 keep_in_target = 1;
12542 /* This location still exists, but it won't be kept in the
12543 target since it may have been disabled. We proceed to
12544 remove its target-side condition. */
12546 /* The location is either no longer present, or got
12547 disabled. See if there's another location at the
12548 same address, in which case we don't need to remove
12549 this one from the target. */
12551 /* OLD_LOC comes from existing struct breakpoint. */
12552 if (breakpoint_address_is_meaningful (old_loc->owner))
12555 (loc2p < bp_location + bp_location_count
12556 && (*loc2p)->address == old_loc->address);
12559 struct bp_location *loc2 = *loc2p;
12561 if (breakpoint_locations_match (loc2, old_loc))
12563 /* Read watchpoint locations are switched to
12564 access watchpoints, if the former are not
12565 supported, but the latter are. */
12566 if (is_hardware_watchpoint (old_loc->owner))
12568 gdb_assert (is_hardware_watchpoint (loc2->owner));
12569 loc2->watchpoint_type = old_loc->watchpoint_type;
12572 /* loc2 is a duplicated location. We need to check
12573 if it should be inserted in case it will be
12575 if (loc2 != old_loc
12576 && unduplicated_should_be_inserted (loc2))
12578 swap_insertion (old_loc, loc2);
12579 keep_in_target = 1;
12587 if (!keep_in_target)
12589 if (remove_breakpoint (old_loc))
12591 /* This is just about all we can do. We could keep
12592 this location on the global list, and try to
12593 remove it next time, but there's no particular
12594 reason why we will succeed next time.
12596 Note that at this point, old_loc->owner is still
12597 valid, as delete_breakpoint frees the breakpoint
12598 only after calling us. */
12599 printf_filtered (_("warning: Error removing "
12600 "breakpoint %d\n"),
12601 old_loc->owner->number);
12609 if (removed && target_is_non_stop_p ()
12610 && need_moribund_for_location_type (old_loc))
12612 /* This location was removed from the target. In
12613 non-stop mode, a race condition is possible where
12614 we've removed a breakpoint, but stop events for that
12615 breakpoint are already queued and will arrive later.
12616 We apply an heuristic to be able to distinguish such
12617 SIGTRAPs from other random SIGTRAPs: we keep this
12618 breakpoint location for a bit, and will retire it
12619 after we see some number of events. The theory here
12620 is that reporting of events should, "on the average",
12621 be fair, so after a while we'll see events from all
12622 threads that have anything of interest, and no longer
12623 need to keep this breakpoint location around. We
12624 don't hold locations forever so to reduce chances of
12625 mistaking a non-breakpoint SIGTRAP for a breakpoint
12628 The heuristic failing can be disastrous on
12629 decr_pc_after_break targets.
12631 On decr_pc_after_break targets, like e.g., x86-linux,
12632 if we fail to recognize a late breakpoint SIGTRAP,
12633 because events_till_retirement has reached 0 too
12634 soon, we'll fail to do the PC adjustment, and report
12635 a random SIGTRAP to the user. When the user resumes
12636 the inferior, it will most likely immediately crash
12637 with SIGILL/SIGBUS/SIGSEGV, or worse, get silently
12638 corrupted, because of being resumed e.g., in the
12639 middle of a multi-byte instruction, or skipped a
12640 one-byte instruction. This was actually seen happen
12641 on native x86-linux, and should be less rare on
12642 targets that do not support new thread events, like
12643 remote, due to the heuristic depending on
12646 Mistaking a random SIGTRAP for a breakpoint trap
12647 causes similar symptoms (PC adjustment applied when
12648 it shouldn't), but then again, playing with SIGTRAPs
12649 behind the debugger's back is asking for trouble.
12651 Since hardware watchpoint traps are always
12652 distinguishable from other traps, so we don't need to
12653 apply keep hardware watchpoint moribund locations
12654 around. We simply always ignore hardware watchpoint
12655 traps we can no longer explain. */
12657 old_loc->events_till_retirement = 3 * (thread_count () + 1);
12658 old_loc->owner = NULL;
12660 VEC_safe_push (bp_location_p, moribund_locations, old_loc);
12664 old_loc->owner = NULL;
12665 decref_bp_location (&old_loc);
12670 /* Rescan breakpoints at the same address and section, marking the
12671 first one as "first" and any others as "duplicates". This is so
12672 that the bpt instruction is only inserted once. If we have a
12673 permanent breakpoint at the same place as BPT, make that one the
12674 official one, and the rest as duplicates. Permanent breakpoints
12675 are sorted first for the same address.
12677 Do the same for hardware watchpoints, but also considering the
12678 watchpoint's type (regular/access/read) and length. */
12680 bp_loc_first = NULL;
12681 wp_loc_first = NULL;
12682 awp_loc_first = NULL;
12683 rwp_loc_first = NULL;
12684 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, locp)
12686 /* ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location has LOC->OWNER always
12688 struct bp_location **loc_first_p;
12691 if (!unduplicated_should_be_inserted (loc)
12692 || !breakpoint_address_is_meaningful (b)
12693 /* Don't detect duplicate for tracepoint locations because they are
12694 never duplicated. See the comments in field `duplicate' of
12695 `struct bp_location'. */
12696 || is_tracepoint (b))
12698 /* Clear the condition modification flag. */
12699 loc->condition_changed = condition_unchanged;
12703 if (b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint)
12704 loc_first_p = &wp_loc_first;
12705 else if (b->type == bp_read_watchpoint)
12706 loc_first_p = &rwp_loc_first;
12707 else if (b->type == bp_access_watchpoint)
12708 loc_first_p = &awp_loc_first;
12710 loc_first_p = &bp_loc_first;
12712 if (*loc_first_p == NULL
12713 || (overlay_debugging && loc->section != (*loc_first_p)->section)
12714 || !breakpoint_locations_match (loc, *loc_first_p))
12716 *loc_first_p = loc;
12717 loc->duplicate = 0;
12719 if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner) && loc->condition_changed)
12721 loc->needs_update = 1;
12722 /* Clear the condition modification flag. */
12723 loc->condition_changed = condition_unchanged;
12729 /* This and the above ensure the invariant that the first location
12730 is not duplicated, and is the inserted one.
12731 All following are marked as duplicated, and are not inserted. */
12733 swap_insertion (loc, *loc_first_p);
12734 loc->duplicate = 1;
12736 /* Clear the condition modification flag. */
12737 loc->condition_changed = condition_unchanged;
12740 if (insert_mode == UGLL_INSERT || breakpoints_should_be_inserted_now ())
12742 if (insert_mode != UGLL_DONT_INSERT)
12743 insert_breakpoint_locations ();
12746 /* Even though the caller told us to not insert new
12747 locations, we may still need to update conditions on the
12748 target's side of breakpoints that were already inserted
12749 if the target is evaluating breakpoint conditions. We
12750 only update conditions for locations that are marked
12752 update_inserted_breakpoint_locations ();
12756 if (insert_mode != UGLL_DONT_INSERT)
12757 download_tracepoint_locations ();
12759 do_cleanups (cleanups);
12763 breakpoint_retire_moribund (void)
12765 struct bp_location *loc;
12768 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (bp_location_p, moribund_locations, ix, loc); ++ix)
12769 if (--(loc->events_till_retirement) == 0)
12771 decref_bp_location (&loc);
12772 VEC_unordered_remove (bp_location_p, moribund_locations, ix);
12778 update_global_location_list_nothrow (enum ugll_insert_mode insert_mode)
12783 update_global_location_list (insert_mode);
12785 CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ERROR)
12791 /* Clear BKP from a BPS. */
12794 bpstat_remove_bp_location (bpstat bps, struct breakpoint *bpt)
12798 for (bs = bps; bs; bs = bs->next)
12799 if (bs->breakpoint_at == bpt)
12801 bs->breakpoint_at = NULL;
12802 bs->old_val = NULL;
12803 /* bs->commands will be freed later. */
12807 /* Callback for iterate_over_threads. */
12809 bpstat_remove_breakpoint_callback (struct thread_info *th, void *data)
12811 struct breakpoint *bpt = (struct breakpoint *) data;
12813 bpstat_remove_bp_location (th->control.stop_bpstat, bpt);
12817 /* Helper for breakpoint and tracepoint breakpoint_ops->mention
12821 say_where (struct breakpoint *b)
12823 struct value_print_options opts;
12825 get_user_print_options (&opts);
12827 /* i18n: cagney/2005-02-11: Below needs to be merged into a
12829 if (b->loc == NULL)
12831 /* For pending locations, the output differs slightly based
12832 on b->extra_string. If this is non-NULL, it contains either
12833 a condition or dprintf arguments. */
12834 if (b->extra_string == NULL)
12836 printf_filtered (_(" (%s) pending."),
12837 event_location_to_string (b->location));
12839 else if (b->type == bp_dprintf)
12841 printf_filtered (_(" (%s,%s) pending."),
12842 event_location_to_string (b->location),
12847 printf_filtered (_(" (%s %s) pending."),
12848 event_location_to_string (b->location),
12854 if (opts.addressprint || b->loc->symtab == NULL)
12856 printf_filtered (" at ");
12857 fputs_filtered (paddress (b->loc->gdbarch, b->loc->address),
12860 if (b->loc->symtab != NULL)
12862 /* If there is a single location, we can print the location
12864 if (b->loc->next == NULL)
12865 printf_filtered (": file %s, line %d.",
12866 symtab_to_filename_for_display (b->loc->symtab),
12867 b->loc->line_number);
12869 /* This is not ideal, but each location may have a
12870 different file name, and this at least reflects the
12871 real situation somewhat. */
12872 printf_filtered (": %s.",
12873 event_location_to_string (b->location));
12878 struct bp_location *loc = b->loc;
12880 for (; loc; loc = loc->next)
12882 printf_filtered (" (%d locations)", n);
12887 /* Default bp_location_ops methods. */
12890 bp_location_dtor (struct bp_location *self)
12892 xfree (self->function_name);
12895 static const struct bp_location_ops bp_location_ops =
12900 /* Default breakpoint_ops methods all breakpoint_ops ultimately
12904 base_breakpoint_dtor (struct breakpoint *self)
12906 decref_counted_command_line (&self->commands);
12907 xfree (self->cond_string);
12908 xfree (self->extra_string);
12909 xfree (self->filter);
12910 delete_event_location (self->location);
12911 delete_event_location (self->location_range_end);
12914 static struct bp_location *
12915 base_breakpoint_allocate_location (struct breakpoint *self)
12917 struct bp_location *loc;
12919 loc = new struct bp_location ();
12920 init_bp_location (loc, &bp_location_ops, self);
12925 base_breakpoint_re_set (struct breakpoint *b)
12927 /* Nothing to re-set. */
12930 #define internal_error_pure_virtual_called() \
12931 gdb_assert_not_reached ("pure virtual function called")
12934 base_breakpoint_insert_location (struct bp_location *bl)
12936 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12940 base_breakpoint_remove_location (struct bp_location *bl,
12941 enum remove_bp_reason reason)
12943 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12947 base_breakpoint_breakpoint_hit (const struct bp_location *bl,
12948 struct address_space *aspace,
12950 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
12952 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12956 base_breakpoint_check_status (bpstat bs)
12961 /* A "works_in_software_mode" breakpoint_ops method that just internal
12965 base_breakpoint_works_in_software_mode (const struct breakpoint *b)
12967 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12970 /* A "resources_needed" breakpoint_ops method that just internal
12974 base_breakpoint_resources_needed (const struct bp_location *bl)
12976 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12979 static enum print_stop_action
12980 base_breakpoint_print_it (bpstat bs)
12982 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12986 base_breakpoint_print_one_detail (const struct breakpoint *self,
12987 struct ui_out *uiout)
12993 base_breakpoint_print_mention (struct breakpoint *b)
12995 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12999 base_breakpoint_print_recreate (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
13001 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
13005 base_breakpoint_create_sals_from_location
13006 (const struct event_location *location,
13007 struct linespec_result *canonical,
13008 enum bptype type_wanted)
13010 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
13014 base_breakpoint_create_breakpoints_sal (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
13015 struct linespec_result *c,
13017 char *extra_string,
13018 enum bptype type_wanted,
13019 enum bpdisp disposition,
13021 int task, int ignore_count,
13022 const struct breakpoint_ops *o,
13023 int from_tty, int enabled,
13024 int internal, unsigned flags)
13026 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
13030 base_breakpoint_decode_location (struct breakpoint *b,
13031 const struct event_location *location,
13032 struct program_space *search_pspace,
13033 struct symtabs_and_lines *sals)
13035 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
13038 /* The default 'explains_signal' method. */
13041 base_breakpoint_explains_signal (struct breakpoint *b, enum gdb_signal sig)
13046 /* The default "after_condition_true" method. */
13049 base_breakpoint_after_condition_true (struct bpstats *bs)
13051 /* Nothing to do. */
13054 struct breakpoint_ops base_breakpoint_ops =
13056 base_breakpoint_dtor,
13057 base_breakpoint_allocate_location,
13058 base_breakpoint_re_set,
13059 base_breakpoint_insert_location,
13060 base_breakpoint_remove_location,
13061 base_breakpoint_breakpoint_hit,
13062 base_breakpoint_check_status,
13063 base_breakpoint_resources_needed,
13064 base_breakpoint_works_in_software_mode,
13065 base_breakpoint_print_it,
13067 base_breakpoint_print_one_detail,
13068 base_breakpoint_print_mention,
13069 base_breakpoint_print_recreate,
13070 base_breakpoint_create_sals_from_location,
13071 base_breakpoint_create_breakpoints_sal,
13072 base_breakpoint_decode_location,
13073 base_breakpoint_explains_signal,
13074 base_breakpoint_after_condition_true,
13077 /* Default breakpoint_ops methods. */
13080 bkpt_re_set (struct breakpoint *b)
13082 /* FIXME: is this still reachable? */
13083 if (breakpoint_event_location_empty_p (b))
13085 /* Anything without a location can't be re-set. */
13086 delete_breakpoint (b);
13090 breakpoint_re_set_default (b);
13094 bkpt_insert_location (struct bp_location *bl)
13096 CORE_ADDR addr = bl->target_info.reqstd_address;
13098 bl->target_info.kind = breakpoint_kind (bl, &addr);
13099 bl->target_info.placed_address = addr;
13101 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
13102 return target_insert_hw_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch, &bl->target_info);
13104 return target_insert_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch, &bl->target_info);
13108 bkpt_remove_location (struct bp_location *bl, enum remove_bp_reason reason)
13110 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
13111 return target_remove_hw_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch, &bl->target_info);
13113 return target_remove_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch, &bl->target_info, reason);
13117 bkpt_breakpoint_hit (const struct bp_location *bl,
13118 struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
13119 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
13121 if (ws->kind != TARGET_WAITKIND_STOPPED
13122 || ws->value.sig != GDB_SIGNAL_TRAP)
13125 if (!breakpoint_address_match (bl->pspace->aspace, bl->address,
13129 if (overlay_debugging /* unmapped overlay section */
13130 && section_is_overlay (bl->section)
13131 && !section_is_mapped (bl->section))
13138 dprintf_breakpoint_hit (const struct bp_location *bl,
13139 struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
13140 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
13142 if (dprintf_style == dprintf_style_agent
13143 && target_can_run_breakpoint_commands ())
13145 /* An agent-style dprintf never causes a stop. If we see a trap
13146 for this address it must be for a breakpoint that happens to
13147 be set at the same address. */
13151 return bkpt_breakpoint_hit (bl, aspace, bp_addr, ws);
13155 bkpt_resources_needed (const struct bp_location *bl)
13157 gdb_assert (bl->owner->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint);
13162 static enum print_stop_action
13163 bkpt_print_it (bpstat bs)
13165 struct breakpoint *b;
13166 const struct bp_location *bl;
13168 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
13170 gdb_assert (bs->bp_location_at != NULL);
13172 bl = bs->bp_location_at;
13173 b = bs->breakpoint_at;
13175 bp_temp = b->disposition == disp_del;
13176 if (bl->address != bl->requested_address)
13177 breakpoint_adjustment_warning (bl->requested_address,
13180 annotate_breakpoint (b->number);
13181 maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (uiout);
13184 ui_out_text (uiout, "Temporary breakpoint ");
13186 ui_out_text (uiout, "Breakpoint ");
13187 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
13189 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "reason",
13190 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_BREAKPOINT_HIT));
13191 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
13193 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "bkptno", b->number);
13194 ui_out_text (uiout, ", ");
13196 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
13200 bkpt_print_mention (struct breakpoint *b)
13202 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (current_uiout))
13207 case bp_breakpoint:
13208 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver:
13209 if (b->disposition == disp_del)
13210 printf_filtered (_("Temporary breakpoint"));
13212 printf_filtered (_("Breakpoint"));
13213 printf_filtered (_(" %d"), b->number);
13214 if (b->type == bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver)
13215 printf_filtered (_(" at gnu-indirect-function resolver"));
13217 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
13218 printf_filtered (_("Hardware assisted breakpoint %d"), b->number);
13221 printf_filtered (_("Dprintf %d"), b->number);
13229 bkpt_print_recreate (struct breakpoint *tp, struct ui_file *fp)
13231 if (tp->type == bp_breakpoint && tp->disposition == disp_del)
13232 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "tbreak");
13233 else if (tp->type == bp_breakpoint)
13234 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "break");
13235 else if (tp->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint
13236 && tp->disposition == disp_del)
13237 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "thbreak");
13238 else if (tp->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
13239 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "hbreak");
13241 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
13242 _("unhandled breakpoint type %d"), (int) tp->type);
13244 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " %s",
13245 event_location_to_string (tp->location));
13247 /* Print out extra_string if this breakpoint is pending. It might
13248 contain, for example, conditions that were set by the user. */
13249 if (tp->loc == NULL && tp->extra_string != NULL)
13250 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " %s", tp->extra_string);
13252 print_recreate_thread (tp, fp);
13256 bkpt_create_sals_from_location (const struct event_location *location,
13257 struct linespec_result *canonical,
13258 enum bptype type_wanted)
13260 create_sals_from_location_default (location, canonical, type_wanted);
13264 bkpt_create_breakpoints_sal (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
13265 struct linespec_result *canonical,
13267 char *extra_string,
13268 enum bptype type_wanted,
13269 enum bpdisp disposition,
13271 int task, int ignore_count,
13272 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
13273 int from_tty, int enabled,
13274 int internal, unsigned flags)
13276 create_breakpoints_sal_default (gdbarch, canonical,
13277 cond_string, extra_string,
13279 disposition, thread, task,
13280 ignore_count, ops, from_tty,
13281 enabled, internal, flags);
13285 bkpt_decode_location (struct breakpoint *b,
13286 const struct event_location *location,
13287 struct program_space *search_pspace,
13288 struct symtabs_and_lines *sals)
13290 decode_location_default (b, location, search_pspace, sals);
13293 /* Virtual table for internal breakpoints. */
13296 internal_bkpt_re_set (struct breakpoint *b)
13300 /* Delete overlay event and longjmp master breakpoints; they
13301 will be reset later by breakpoint_re_set. */
13302 case bp_overlay_event:
13303 case bp_longjmp_master:
13304 case bp_std_terminate_master:
13305 case bp_exception_master:
13306 delete_breakpoint (b);
13309 /* This breakpoint is special, it's set up when the inferior
13310 starts and we really don't want to touch it. */
13311 case bp_shlib_event:
13313 /* Like bp_shlib_event, this breakpoint type is special. Once
13314 it is set up, we do not want to touch it. */
13315 case bp_thread_event:
13321 internal_bkpt_check_status (bpstat bs)
13323 if (bs->breakpoint_at->type == bp_shlib_event)
13325 /* If requested, stop when the dynamic linker notifies GDB of
13326 events. This allows the user to get control and place
13327 breakpoints in initializer routines for dynamically loaded
13328 objects (among other things). */
13329 bs->stop = stop_on_solib_events;
13330 bs->print = stop_on_solib_events;
13336 static enum print_stop_action
13337 internal_bkpt_print_it (bpstat bs)
13339 struct breakpoint *b;
13341 b = bs->breakpoint_at;
13345 case bp_shlib_event:
13346 /* Did we stop because the user set the stop_on_solib_events
13347 variable? (If so, we report this as a generic, "Stopped due
13348 to shlib event" message.) */
13349 print_solib_event (0);
13352 case bp_thread_event:
13353 /* Not sure how we will get here.
13354 GDB should not stop for these breakpoints. */
13355 printf_filtered (_("Thread Event Breakpoint: gdb should not stop!\n"));
13358 case bp_overlay_event:
13359 /* By analogy with the thread event, GDB should not stop for these. */
13360 printf_filtered (_("Overlay Event Breakpoint: gdb should not stop!\n"));
13363 case bp_longjmp_master:
13364 /* These should never be enabled. */
13365 printf_filtered (_("Longjmp Master Breakpoint: gdb should not stop!\n"));
13368 case bp_std_terminate_master:
13369 /* These should never be enabled. */
13370 printf_filtered (_("std::terminate Master Breakpoint: "
13371 "gdb should not stop!\n"));
13374 case bp_exception_master:
13375 /* These should never be enabled. */
13376 printf_filtered (_("Exception Master Breakpoint: "
13377 "gdb should not stop!\n"));
13381 return PRINT_NOTHING;
13385 internal_bkpt_print_mention (struct breakpoint *b)
13387 /* Nothing to mention. These breakpoints are internal. */
13390 /* Virtual table for momentary breakpoints */
13393 momentary_bkpt_re_set (struct breakpoint *b)
13395 /* Keep temporary breakpoints, which can be encountered when we step
13396 over a dlopen call and solib_add is resetting the breakpoints.
13397 Otherwise these should have been blown away via the cleanup chain
13398 or by breakpoint_init_inferior when we rerun the executable. */
13402 momentary_bkpt_check_status (bpstat bs)
13404 /* Nothing. The point of these breakpoints is causing a stop. */
13407 static enum print_stop_action
13408 momentary_bkpt_print_it (bpstat bs)
13410 return PRINT_UNKNOWN;
13414 momentary_bkpt_print_mention (struct breakpoint *b)
13416 /* Nothing to mention. These breakpoints are internal. */
13419 /* Ensure INITIATING_FRAME is cleared when no such breakpoint exists.
13421 It gets cleared already on the removal of the first one of such placed
13422 breakpoints. This is OK as they get all removed altogether. */
13425 longjmp_bkpt_dtor (struct breakpoint *self)
13427 struct thread_info *tp = find_thread_global_id (self->thread);
13430 tp->initiating_frame = null_frame_id;
13432 momentary_breakpoint_ops.dtor (self);
13435 /* Specific methods for probe breakpoints. */
13438 bkpt_probe_insert_location (struct bp_location *bl)
13440 int v = bkpt_insert_location (bl);
13444 /* The insertion was successful, now let's set the probe's semaphore
13446 if (bl->probe.probe->pops->set_semaphore != NULL)
13447 bl->probe.probe->pops->set_semaphore (bl->probe.probe,
13456 bkpt_probe_remove_location (struct bp_location *bl,
13457 enum remove_bp_reason reason)
13459 /* Let's clear the semaphore before removing the location. */
13460 if (bl->probe.probe->pops->clear_semaphore != NULL)
13461 bl->probe.probe->pops->clear_semaphore (bl->probe.probe,
13465 return bkpt_remove_location (bl, reason);
13469 bkpt_probe_create_sals_from_location (const struct event_location *location,
13470 struct linespec_result *canonical,
13471 enum bptype type_wanted)
13473 struct linespec_sals lsal;
13475 lsal.sals = parse_probes (location, NULL, canonical);
13476 lsal.canonical = xstrdup (event_location_to_string (canonical->location));
13477 VEC_safe_push (linespec_sals, canonical->sals, &lsal);
13481 bkpt_probe_decode_location (struct breakpoint *b,
13482 const struct event_location *location,
13483 struct program_space *search_pspace,
13484 struct symtabs_and_lines *sals)
13486 *sals = parse_probes (location, search_pspace, NULL);
13488 error (_("probe not found"));
13491 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in tracepoints. */
13494 tracepoint_re_set (struct breakpoint *b)
13496 breakpoint_re_set_default (b);
13500 tracepoint_breakpoint_hit (const struct bp_location *bl,
13501 struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
13502 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
13504 /* By definition, the inferior does not report stops at
13510 tracepoint_print_one_detail (const struct breakpoint *self,
13511 struct ui_out *uiout)
13513 struct tracepoint *tp = (struct tracepoint *) self;
13514 if (tp->static_trace_marker_id)
13516 gdb_assert (self->type == bp_static_tracepoint);
13518 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tmarker id is ");
13519 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "static-tracepoint-marker-string-id",
13520 tp->static_trace_marker_id);
13521 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
13526 tracepoint_print_mention (struct breakpoint *b)
13528 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (current_uiout))
13533 case bp_tracepoint:
13534 printf_filtered (_("Tracepoint"));
13535 printf_filtered (_(" %d"), b->number);
13537 case bp_fast_tracepoint:
13538 printf_filtered (_("Fast tracepoint"));
13539 printf_filtered (_(" %d"), b->number);
13541 case bp_static_tracepoint:
13542 printf_filtered (_("Static tracepoint"));
13543 printf_filtered (_(" %d"), b->number);
13546 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
13547 _("unhandled tracepoint type %d"), (int) b->type);
13554 tracepoint_print_recreate (struct breakpoint *self, struct ui_file *fp)
13556 struct tracepoint *tp = (struct tracepoint *) self;
13558 if (self->type == bp_fast_tracepoint)
13559 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "ftrace");
13560 else if (self->type == bp_static_tracepoint)
13561 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "strace");
13562 else if (self->type == bp_tracepoint)
13563 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "trace");
13565 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
13566 _("unhandled tracepoint type %d"), (int) self->type);
13568 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " %s",
13569 event_location_to_string (self->location));
13570 print_recreate_thread (self, fp);
13572 if (tp->pass_count)
13573 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " passcount %d\n", tp->pass_count);
13577 tracepoint_create_sals_from_location (const struct event_location *location,
13578 struct linespec_result *canonical,
13579 enum bptype type_wanted)
13581 create_sals_from_location_default (location, canonical, type_wanted);
13585 tracepoint_create_breakpoints_sal (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
13586 struct linespec_result *canonical,
13588 char *extra_string,
13589 enum bptype type_wanted,
13590 enum bpdisp disposition,
13592 int task, int ignore_count,
13593 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
13594 int from_tty, int enabled,
13595 int internal, unsigned flags)
13597 create_breakpoints_sal_default (gdbarch, canonical,
13598 cond_string, extra_string,
13600 disposition, thread, task,
13601 ignore_count, ops, from_tty,
13602 enabled, internal, flags);
13606 tracepoint_decode_location (struct breakpoint *b,
13607 const struct event_location *location,
13608 struct program_space *search_pspace,
13609 struct symtabs_and_lines *sals)
13611 decode_location_default (b, location, search_pspace, sals);
13614 struct breakpoint_ops tracepoint_breakpoint_ops;
13616 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be use on tracepoints placed in a
13620 tracepoint_probe_create_sals_from_location
13621 (const struct event_location *location,
13622 struct linespec_result *canonical,
13623 enum bptype type_wanted)
13625 /* We use the same method for breakpoint on probes. */
13626 bkpt_probe_create_sals_from_location (location, canonical, type_wanted);
13630 tracepoint_probe_decode_location (struct breakpoint *b,
13631 const struct event_location *location,
13632 struct program_space *search_pspace,
13633 struct symtabs_and_lines *sals)
13635 /* We use the same method for breakpoint on probes. */
13636 bkpt_probe_decode_location (b, location, search_pspace, sals);
13639 static struct breakpoint_ops tracepoint_probe_breakpoint_ops;
13641 /* Dprintf breakpoint_ops methods. */
13644 dprintf_re_set (struct breakpoint *b)
13646 breakpoint_re_set_default (b);
13648 /* extra_string should never be non-NULL for dprintf. */
13649 gdb_assert (b->extra_string != NULL);
13651 /* 1 - connect to target 1, that can run breakpoint commands.
13652 2 - create a dprintf, which resolves fine.
13653 3 - disconnect from target 1
13654 4 - connect to target 2, that can NOT run breakpoint commands.
13656 After steps #3/#4, you'll want the dprintf command list to
13657 be updated, because target 1 and 2 may well return different
13658 answers for target_can_run_breakpoint_commands().
13659 Given absence of finer grained resetting, we get to do
13660 it all the time. */
13661 if (b->extra_string != NULL)
13662 update_dprintf_command_list (b);
13665 /* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for dprintf. */
13668 dprintf_print_recreate (struct breakpoint *tp, struct ui_file *fp)
13670 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "dprintf %s,%s",
13671 event_location_to_string (tp->location),
13673 print_recreate_thread (tp, fp);
13676 /* Implement the "after_condition_true" breakpoint_ops method for
13679 dprintf's are implemented with regular commands in their command
13680 list, but we run the commands here instead of before presenting the
13681 stop to the user, as dprintf's don't actually cause a stop. This
13682 also makes it so that the commands of multiple dprintfs at the same
13683 address are all handled. */
13686 dprintf_after_condition_true (struct bpstats *bs)
13688 struct cleanup *old_chain;
13689 struct bpstats tmp_bs = { NULL };
13690 struct bpstats *tmp_bs_p = &tmp_bs;
13692 /* dprintf's never cause a stop. This wasn't set in the
13693 check_status hook instead because that would make the dprintf's
13694 condition not be evaluated. */
13697 /* Run the command list here. Take ownership of it instead of
13698 copying. We never want these commands to run later in
13699 bpstat_do_actions, if a breakpoint that causes a stop happens to
13700 be set at same address as this dprintf, or even if running the
13701 commands here throws. */
13702 tmp_bs.commands = bs->commands;
13703 bs->commands = NULL;
13704 old_chain = make_cleanup_decref_counted_command_line (&tmp_bs.commands);
13706 bpstat_do_actions_1 (&tmp_bs_p);
13708 /* 'tmp_bs.commands' will usually be NULL by now, but
13709 bpstat_do_actions_1 may return early without processing the whole
13711 do_cleanups (old_chain);
13714 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used on static tracepoints with
13718 strace_marker_create_sals_from_location (const struct event_location *location,
13719 struct linespec_result *canonical,
13720 enum bptype type_wanted)
13722 struct linespec_sals lsal;
13723 const char *arg_start, *arg;
13725 struct cleanup *cleanup;
13727 arg = arg_start = get_linespec_location (location);
13728 lsal.sals = decode_static_tracepoint_spec (&arg);
13730 str = savestring (arg_start, arg - arg_start);
13731 cleanup = make_cleanup (xfree, str);
13732 canonical->location = new_linespec_location (&str);
13733 do_cleanups (cleanup);
13735 lsal.canonical = xstrdup (event_location_to_string (canonical->location));
13736 VEC_safe_push (linespec_sals, canonical->sals, &lsal);
13740 strace_marker_create_breakpoints_sal (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
13741 struct linespec_result *canonical,
13743 char *extra_string,
13744 enum bptype type_wanted,
13745 enum bpdisp disposition,
13747 int task, int ignore_count,
13748 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
13749 int from_tty, int enabled,
13750 int internal, unsigned flags)
13753 struct linespec_sals *lsal = VEC_index (linespec_sals,
13754 canonical->sals, 0);
13756 /* If the user is creating a static tracepoint by marker id
13757 (strace -m MARKER_ID), then store the sals index, so that
13758 breakpoint_re_set can try to match up which of the newly
13759 found markers corresponds to this one, and, don't try to
13760 expand multiple locations for each sal, given than SALS
13761 already should contain all sals for MARKER_ID. */
13763 for (i = 0; i < lsal->sals.nelts; ++i)
13765 struct symtabs_and_lines expanded;
13766 struct tracepoint *tp;
13767 struct cleanup *old_chain;
13768 struct event_location *location;
13770 expanded.nelts = 1;
13771 expanded.sals = &lsal->sals.sals[i];
13773 location = copy_event_location (canonical->location);
13774 old_chain = make_cleanup_delete_event_location (location);
13776 tp = new tracepoint ();
13777 init_breakpoint_sal (&tp->base, gdbarch, expanded,
13779 cond_string, extra_string,
13780 type_wanted, disposition,
13781 thread, task, ignore_count, ops,
13782 from_tty, enabled, internal, flags,
13783 canonical->special_display);
13784 /* Given that its possible to have multiple markers with
13785 the same string id, if the user is creating a static
13786 tracepoint by marker id ("strace -m MARKER_ID"), then
13787 store the sals index, so that breakpoint_re_set can
13788 try to match up which of the newly found markers
13789 corresponds to this one */
13790 tp->static_trace_marker_id_idx = i;
13792 install_breakpoint (internal, &tp->base, 0);
13794 discard_cleanups (old_chain);
13799 strace_marker_decode_location (struct breakpoint *b,
13800 const struct event_location *location,
13801 struct program_space *search_pspace,
13802 struct symtabs_and_lines *sals)
13804 struct tracepoint *tp = (struct tracepoint *) b;
13805 const char *s = get_linespec_location (location);
13807 *sals = decode_static_tracepoint_spec (&s);
13808 if (sals->nelts > tp->static_trace_marker_id_idx)
13810 sals->sals[0] = sals->sals[tp->static_trace_marker_id_idx];
13814 error (_("marker %s not found"), tp->static_trace_marker_id);
13817 static struct breakpoint_ops strace_marker_breakpoint_ops;
13820 strace_marker_p (struct breakpoint *b)
13822 return b->ops == &strace_marker_breakpoint_ops;
13825 /* Delete a breakpoint and clean up all traces of it in the data
13829 delete_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt)
13831 struct breakpoint *b;
13833 gdb_assert (bpt != NULL);
13835 /* Has this bp already been deleted? This can happen because
13836 multiple lists can hold pointers to bp's. bpstat lists are
13839 One example of this happening is a watchpoint's scope bp. When
13840 the scope bp triggers, we notice that the watchpoint is out of
13841 scope, and delete it. We also delete its scope bp. But the
13842 scope bp is marked "auto-deleting", and is already on a bpstat.
13843 That bpstat is then checked for auto-deleting bp's, which are
13846 A real solution to this problem might involve reference counts in
13847 bp's, and/or giving them pointers back to their referencing
13848 bpstat's, and teaching delete_breakpoint to only free a bp's
13849 storage when no more references were extent. A cheaper bandaid
13851 if (bpt->type == bp_none)
13854 /* At least avoid this stale reference until the reference counting
13855 of breakpoints gets resolved. */
13856 if (bpt->related_breakpoint != bpt)
13858 struct breakpoint *related;
13859 struct watchpoint *w;
13861 if (bpt->type == bp_watchpoint_scope)
13862 w = (struct watchpoint *) bpt->related_breakpoint;
13863 else if (bpt->related_breakpoint->type == bp_watchpoint_scope)
13864 w = (struct watchpoint *) bpt;
13868 watchpoint_del_at_next_stop (w);
13870 /* Unlink bpt from the bpt->related_breakpoint ring. */
13871 for (related = bpt; related->related_breakpoint != bpt;
13872 related = related->related_breakpoint);
13873 related->related_breakpoint = bpt->related_breakpoint;
13874 bpt->related_breakpoint = bpt;
13877 /* watch_command_1 creates a watchpoint but only sets its number if
13878 update_watchpoint succeeds in creating its bp_locations. If there's
13879 a problem in that process, we'll be asked to delete the half-created
13880 watchpoint. In that case, don't announce the deletion. */
13882 observer_notify_breakpoint_deleted (bpt);
13884 if (breakpoint_chain == bpt)
13885 breakpoint_chain = bpt->next;
13887 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
13888 if (b->next == bpt)
13890 b->next = bpt->next;
13894 /* Be sure no bpstat's are pointing at the breakpoint after it's
13896 /* FIXME, how can we find all bpstat's? We just check stop_bpstat
13897 in all threads for now. Note that we cannot just remove bpstats
13898 pointing at bpt from the stop_bpstat list entirely, as breakpoint
13899 commands are associated with the bpstat; if we remove it here,
13900 then the later call to bpstat_do_actions (&stop_bpstat); in
13901 event-top.c won't do anything, and temporary breakpoints with
13902 commands won't work. */
13904 iterate_over_threads (bpstat_remove_breakpoint_callback, bpt);
13906 /* Now that breakpoint is removed from breakpoint list, update the
13907 global location list. This will remove locations that used to
13908 belong to this breakpoint. Do this before freeing the breakpoint
13909 itself, since remove_breakpoint looks at location's owner. It
13910 might be better design to have location completely
13911 self-contained, but it's not the case now. */
13912 update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT);
13914 bpt->ops->dtor (bpt);
13915 /* On the chance that someone will soon try again to delete this
13916 same bp, we mark it as deleted before freeing its storage. */
13917 bpt->type = bp_none;
13922 do_delete_breakpoint_cleanup (void *b)
13924 delete_breakpoint ((struct breakpoint *) b);
13928 make_cleanup_delete_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b)
13930 return make_cleanup (do_delete_breakpoint_cleanup, b);
13933 /* Iterator function to call a user-provided callback function once
13934 for each of B and its related breakpoints. */
13937 iterate_over_related_breakpoints (struct breakpoint *b,
13938 void (*function) (struct breakpoint *,
13942 struct breakpoint *related;
13947 struct breakpoint *next;
13949 /* FUNCTION may delete RELATED. */
13950 next = related->related_breakpoint;
13952 if (next == related)
13954 /* RELATED is the last ring entry. */
13955 function (related, data);
13957 /* FUNCTION may have deleted it, so we'd never reach back to
13958 B. There's nothing left to do anyway, so just break
13963 function (related, data);
13967 while (related != b);
13971 do_delete_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b, void *ignore)
13973 delete_breakpoint (b);
13976 /* A callback for map_breakpoint_numbers that calls
13977 delete_breakpoint. */
13980 do_map_delete_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b, void *ignore)
13982 iterate_over_related_breakpoints (b, do_delete_breakpoint, NULL);
13986 delete_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
13988 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
13994 int breaks_to_delete = 0;
13996 /* Delete all breakpoints if no argument. Do not delete
13997 internal breakpoints, these have to be deleted with an
13998 explicit breakpoint number argument. */
13999 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
14000 if (user_breakpoint_p (b))
14002 breaks_to_delete = 1;
14006 /* Ask user only if there are some breakpoints to delete. */
14008 || (breaks_to_delete && query (_("Delete all breakpoints? "))))
14010 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
14011 if (user_breakpoint_p (b))
14012 delete_breakpoint (b);
14016 map_breakpoint_numbers (arg, do_map_delete_breakpoint, NULL);
14019 /* Return true if all locations of B bound to PSPACE are pending. If
14020 PSPACE is NULL, all locations of all program spaces are
14024 all_locations_are_pending (struct breakpoint *b, struct program_space *pspace)
14026 struct bp_location *loc;
14028 for (loc = b->loc; loc != NULL; loc = loc->next)
14029 if ((pspace == NULL
14030 || loc->pspace == pspace)
14031 && !loc->shlib_disabled
14032 && !loc->pspace->executing_startup)
14037 /* Subroutine of update_breakpoint_locations to simplify it.
14038 Return non-zero if multiple fns in list LOC have the same name.
14039 Null names are ignored. */
14042 ambiguous_names_p (struct bp_location *loc)
14044 struct bp_location *l;
14045 htab_t htab = htab_create_alloc (13, htab_hash_string,
14046 (int (*) (const void *,
14047 const void *)) streq,
14048 NULL, xcalloc, xfree);
14050 for (l = loc; l != NULL; l = l->next)
14053 const char *name = l->function_name;
14055 /* Allow for some names to be NULL, ignore them. */
14059 slot = (const char **) htab_find_slot (htab, (const void *) name,
14061 /* NOTE: We can assume slot != NULL here because xcalloc never
14065 htab_delete (htab);
14071 htab_delete (htab);
14075 /* When symbols change, it probably means the sources changed as well,
14076 and it might mean the static tracepoint markers are no longer at
14077 the same address or line numbers they used to be at last we
14078 checked. Losing your static tracepoints whenever you rebuild is
14079 undesirable. This function tries to resync/rematch gdb static
14080 tracepoints with the markers on the target, for static tracepoints
14081 that have not been set by marker id. Static tracepoint that have
14082 been set by marker id are reset by marker id in breakpoint_re_set.
14085 1) For a tracepoint set at a specific address, look for a marker at
14086 the old PC. If one is found there, assume to be the same marker.
14087 If the name / string id of the marker found is different from the
14088 previous known name, assume that means the user renamed the marker
14089 in the sources, and output a warning.
14091 2) For a tracepoint set at a given line number, look for a marker
14092 at the new address of the old line number. If one is found there,
14093 assume to be the same marker. If the name / string id of the
14094 marker found is different from the previous known name, assume that
14095 means the user renamed the marker in the sources, and output a
14098 3) If a marker is no longer found at the same address or line, it
14099 may mean the marker no longer exists. But it may also just mean
14100 the code changed a bit. Maybe the user added a few lines of code
14101 that made the marker move up or down (in line number terms). Ask
14102 the target for info about the marker with the string id as we knew
14103 it. If found, update line number and address in the matching
14104 static tracepoint. This will get confused if there's more than one
14105 marker with the same ID (possible in UST, although unadvised
14106 precisely because it confuses tools). */
14108 static struct symtab_and_line
14109 update_static_tracepoint (struct breakpoint *b, struct symtab_and_line sal)
14111 struct tracepoint *tp = (struct tracepoint *) b;
14112 struct static_tracepoint_marker marker;
14117 find_line_pc (sal.symtab, sal.line, &pc);
14119 if (target_static_tracepoint_marker_at (pc, &marker))
14121 if (strcmp (tp->static_trace_marker_id, marker.str_id) != 0)
14122 warning (_("static tracepoint %d changed probed marker from %s to %s"),
14124 tp->static_trace_marker_id, marker.str_id);
14126 xfree (tp->static_trace_marker_id);
14127 tp->static_trace_marker_id = xstrdup (marker.str_id);
14128 release_static_tracepoint_marker (&marker);
14133 /* Old marker wasn't found on target at lineno. Try looking it up
14135 if (!sal.explicit_pc
14137 && sal.symtab != NULL
14138 && tp->static_trace_marker_id != NULL)
14140 VEC(static_tracepoint_marker_p) *markers;
14143 = target_static_tracepoint_markers_by_strid (tp->static_trace_marker_id);
14145 if (!VEC_empty(static_tracepoint_marker_p, markers))
14147 struct symtab_and_line sal2;
14148 struct symbol *sym;
14149 struct static_tracepoint_marker *tpmarker;
14150 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
14151 struct explicit_location explicit_loc;
14153 tpmarker = VEC_index (static_tracepoint_marker_p, markers, 0);
14155 xfree (tp->static_trace_marker_id);
14156 tp->static_trace_marker_id = xstrdup (tpmarker->str_id);
14158 warning (_("marker for static tracepoint %d (%s) not "
14159 "found at previous line number"),
14160 b->number, tp->static_trace_marker_id);
14164 sal2.pc = tpmarker->address;
14166 sal2 = find_pc_line (tpmarker->address, 0);
14167 sym = find_pc_sect_function (tpmarker->address, NULL);
14168 ui_out_text (uiout, "Now in ");
14171 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "func",
14172 SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (sym));
14173 ui_out_text (uiout, " at ");
14175 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "file",
14176 symtab_to_filename_for_display (sal2.symtab));
14177 ui_out_text (uiout, ":");
14179 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
14181 const char *fullname = symtab_to_fullname (sal2.symtab);
14183 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "fullname", fullname);
14186 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "line", sal2.line);
14187 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
14189 b->loc->line_number = sal2.line;
14190 b->loc->symtab = sym != NULL ? sal2.symtab : NULL;
14192 delete_event_location (b->location);
14193 initialize_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
14194 explicit_loc.source_filename
14195 = ASTRDUP (symtab_to_filename_for_display (sal2.symtab));
14196 explicit_loc.line_offset.offset = b->loc->line_number;
14197 explicit_loc.line_offset.sign = LINE_OFFSET_NONE;
14198 b->location = new_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
14200 /* Might be nice to check if function changed, and warn if
14203 release_static_tracepoint_marker (tpmarker);
14209 /* Returns 1 iff locations A and B are sufficiently same that
14210 we don't need to report breakpoint as changed. */
14213 locations_are_equal (struct bp_location *a, struct bp_location *b)
14217 if (a->address != b->address)
14220 if (a->shlib_disabled != b->shlib_disabled)
14223 if (a->enabled != b->enabled)
14230 if ((a == NULL) != (b == NULL))
14236 /* Split all locations of B that are bound to PSPACE out of B's
14237 location list to a separate list and return that list's head. If
14238 PSPACE is NULL, hoist out all locations of B. */
14240 static struct bp_location *
14241 hoist_existing_locations (struct breakpoint *b, struct program_space *pspace)
14243 struct bp_location head;
14244 struct bp_location *i = b->loc;
14245 struct bp_location **i_link = &b->loc;
14246 struct bp_location *hoisted = &head;
14248 if (pspace == NULL)
14259 if (i->pspace == pspace)
14274 /* Create new breakpoint locations for B (a hardware or software
14275 breakpoint) based on SALS and SALS_END. If SALS_END.NELTS is not
14276 zero, then B is a ranged breakpoint. Only recreates locations for
14277 FILTER_PSPACE. Locations of other program spaces are left
14281 update_breakpoint_locations (struct breakpoint *b,
14282 struct program_space *filter_pspace,
14283 struct symtabs_and_lines sals,
14284 struct symtabs_and_lines sals_end)
14287 struct bp_location *existing_locations;
14289 if (sals_end.nelts != 0 && (sals.nelts != 1 || sals_end.nelts != 1))
14291 /* Ranged breakpoints have only one start location and one end
14293 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
14294 printf_unfiltered (_("Could not reset ranged breakpoint %d: "
14295 "multiple locations found\n"),
14300 /* If there's no new locations, and all existing locations are
14301 pending, don't do anything. This optimizes the common case where
14302 all locations are in the same shared library, that was unloaded.
14303 We'd like to retain the location, so that when the library is
14304 loaded again, we don't loose the enabled/disabled status of the
14305 individual locations. */
14306 if (all_locations_are_pending (b, filter_pspace) && sals.nelts == 0)
14309 existing_locations = hoist_existing_locations (b, filter_pspace);
14311 for (i = 0; i < sals.nelts; ++i)
14313 struct bp_location *new_loc;
14315 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (sals.sals[i].pspace);
14317 new_loc = add_location_to_breakpoint (b, &(sals.sals[i]));
14319 /* Reparse conditions, they might contain references to the
14321 if (b->cond_string != NULL)
14325 s = b->cond_string;
14328 new_loc->cond = parse_exp_1 (&s, sals.sals[i].pc,
14329 block_for_pc (sals.sals[i].pc),
14332 CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ERROR)
14334 warning (_("failed to reevaluate condition "
14335 "for breakpoint %d: %s"),
14336 b->number, e.message);
14337 new_loc->enabled = 0;
14342 if (sals_end.nelts)
14344 CORE_ADDR end = find_breakpoint_range_end (sals_end.sals[0]);
14346 new_loc->length = end - sals.sals[0].pc + 1;
14350 /* If possible, carry over 'disable' status from existing
14353 struct bp_location *e = existing_locations;
14354 /* If there are multiple breakpoints with the same function name,
14355 e.g. for inline functions, comparing function names won't work.
14356 Instead compare pc addresses; this is just a heuristic as things
14357 may have moved, but in practice it gives the correct answer
14358 often enough until a better solution is found. */
14359 int have_ambiguous_names = ambiguous_names_p (b->loc);
14361 for (; e; e = e->next)
14363 if (!e->enabled && e->function_name)
14365 struct bp_location *l = b->loc;
14366 if (have_ambiguous_names)
14368 for (; l; l = l->next)
14369 if (breakpoint_locations_match (e, l))
14377 for (; l; l = l->next)
14378 if (l->function_name
14379 && strcmp (e->function_name, l->function_name) == 0)
14389 if (!locations_are_equal (existing_locations, b->loc))
14390 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b);
14393 /* Find the SaL locations corresponding to the given LOCATION.
14394 On return, FOUND will be 1 if any SaL was found, zero otherwise. */
14396 static struct symtabs_and_lines
14397 location_to_sals (struct breakpoint *b, struct event_location *location,
14398 struct program_space *search_pspace, int *found)
14400 struct symtabs_and_lines sals = {0};
14401 struct gdb_exception exception = exception_none;
14403 gdb_assert (b->ops != NULL);
14407 b->ops->decode_location (b, location, search_pspace, &sals);
14409 CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ERROR)
14411 int not_found_and_ok = 0;
14415 /* For pending breakpoints, it's expected that parsing will
14416 fail until the right shared library is loaded. User has
14417 already told to create pending breakpoints and don't need
14418 extra messages. If breakpoint is in bp_shlib_disabled
14419 state, then user already saw the message about that
14420 breakpoint being disabled, and don't want to see more
14422 if (e.error == NOT_FOUND_ERROR
14423 && (b->condition_not_parsed
14425 && search_pspace != NULL
14426 && b->loc->pspace != search_pspace)
14427 || (b->loc && b->loc->shlib_disabled)
14428 || (b->loc && b->loc->pspace->executing_startup)
14429 || b->enable_state == bp_disabled))
14430 not_found_and_ok = 1;
14432 if (!not_found_and_ok)
14434 /* We surely don't want to warn about the same breakpoint
14435 10 times. One solution, implemented here, is disable
14436 the breakpoint on error. Another solution would be to
14437 have separate 'warning emitted' flag. Since this
14438 happens only when a binary has changed, I don't know
14439 which approach is better. */
14440 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
14441 throw_exception (e);
14446 if (exception.reason == 0 || exception.error != NOT_FOUND_ERROR)
14450 for (i = 0; i < sals.nelts; ++i)
14451 resolve_sal_pc (&sals.sals[i]);
14452 if (b->condition_not_parsed && b->extra_string != NULL)
14454 char *cond_string, *extra_string;
14457 find_condition_and_thread (b->extra_string, sals.sals[0].pc,
14458 &cond_string, &thread, &task,
14460 gdb_assert (b->cond_string == NULL);
14462 b->cond_string = cond_string;
14463 b->thread = thread;
14467 xfree (b->extra_string);
14468 b->extra_string = extra_string;
14470 b->condition_not_parsed = 0;
14473 if (b->type == bp_static_tracepoint && !strace_marker_p (b))
14474 sals.sals[0] = update_static_tracepoint (b, sals.sals[0]);
14484 /* The default re_set method, for typical hardware or software
14485 breakpoints. Reevaluate the breakpoint and recreate its
14489 breakpoint_re_set_default (struct breakpoint *b)
14492 struct symtabs_and_lines sals, sals_end;
14493 struct symtabs_and_lines expanded = {0};
14494 struct symtabs_and_lines expanded_end = {0};
14495 struct program_space *filter_pspace = current_program_space;
14497 sals = location_to_sals (b, b->location, filter_pspace, &found);
14500 make_cleanup (xfree, sals.sals);
14504 if (b->location_range_end != NULL)
14506 sals_end = location_to_sals (b, b->location_range_end,
14507 filter_pspace, &found);
14510 make_cleanup (xfree, sals_end.sals);
14511 expanded_end = sals_end;
14515 update_breakpoint_locations (b, filter_pspace, expanded, expanded_end);
14518 /* Default method for creating SALs from an address string. It basically
14519 calls parse_breakpoint_sals. Return 1 for success, zero for failure. */
14522 create_sals_from_location_default (const struct event_location *location,
14523 struct linespec_result *canonical,
14524 enum bptype type_wanted)
14526 parse_breakpoint_sals (location, canonical);
14529 /* Call create_breakpoints_sal for the given arguments. This is the default
14530 function for the `create_breakpoints_sal' method of
14534 create_breakpoints_sal_default (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
14535 struct linespec_result *canonical,
14537 char *extra_string,
14538 enum bptype type_wanted,
14539 enum bpdisp disposition,
14541 int task, int ignore_count,
14542 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
14543 int from_tty, int enabled,
14544 int internal, unsigned flags)
14546 create_breakpoints_sal (gdbarch, canonical, cond_string,
14548 type_wanted, disposition,
14549 thread, task, ignore_count, ops, from_tty,
14550 enabled, internal, flags);
14553 /* Decode the line represented by S by calling decode_line_full. This is the
14554 default function for the `decode_location' method of breakpoint_ops. */
14557 decode_location_default (struct breakpoint *b,
14558 const struct event_location *location,
14559 struct program_space *search_pspace,
14560 struct symtabs_and_lines *sals)
14562 struct linespec_result canonical;
14564 init_linespec_result (&canonical);
14565 decode_line_full (location, DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE, search_pspace,
14566 (struct symtab *) NULL, 0,
14567 &canonical, multiple_symbols_all,
14570 /* We should get 0 or 1 resulting SALs. */
14571 gdb_assert (VEC_length (linespec_sals, canonical.sals) < 2);
14573 if (VEC_length (linespec_sals, canonical.sals) > 0)
14575 struct linespec_sals *lsal;
14577 lsal = VEC_index (linespec_sals, canonical.sals, 0);
14578 *sals = lsal->sals;
14579 /* Arrange it so the destructor does not free the
14581 lsal->sals.sals = NULL;
14584 destroy_linespec_result (&canonical);
14587 /* Prepare the global context for a re-set of breakpoint B. */
14589 static struct cleanup *
14590 prepare_re_set_context (struct breakpoint *b)
14592 input_radix = b->input_radix;
14593 set_language (b->language);
14595 return make_cleanup (null_cleanup, NULL);
14598 /* Reset a breakpoint given it's struct breakpoint * BINT.
14599 The value we return ends up being the return value from catch_errors.
14600 Unused in this case. */
14603 breakpoint_re_set_one (void *bint)
14605 /* Get past catch_errs. */
14606 struct breakpoint *b = (struct breakpoint *) bint;
14607 struct cleanup *cleanups;
14609 cleanups = prepare_re_set_context (b);
14610 b->ops->re_set (b);
14611 do_cleanups (cleanups);
14615 /* Re-set breakpoint locations for the current program space.
14616 Locations bound to other program spaces are left untouched. */
14619 breakpoint_re_set (void)
14621 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
14622 enum language save_language;
14623 int save_input_radix;
14624 struct cleanup *old_chain;
14626 save_language = current_language->la_language;
14627 save_input_radix = input_radix;
14628 old_chain = save_current_space_and_thread ();
14630 /* Note: we must not try to insert locations until after all
14631 breakpoints have been re-set. Otherwise, e.g., when re-setting
14632 breakpoint 1, we'd insert the locations of breakpoint 2, which
14633 hadn't been re-set yet, and thus may have stale locations. */
14635 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
14637 /* Format possible error msg. */
14638 char *message = xstrprintf ("Error in re-setting breakpoint %d: ",
14640 struct cleanup *cleanups = make_cleanup (xfree, message);
14641 catch_errors (breakpoint_re_set_one, b, message, RETURN_MASK_ALL);
14642 do_cleanups (cleanups);
14644 set_language (save_language);
14645 input_radix = save_input_radix;
14647 jit_breakpoint_re_set ();
14649 do_cleanups (old_chain);
14651 create_overlay_event_breakpoint ();
14652 create_longjmp_master_breakpoint ();
14653 create_std_terminate_master_breakpoint ();
14654 create_exception_master_breakpoint ();
14656 /* Now we can insert. */
14657 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
14660 /* Reset the thread number of this breakpoint:
14662 - If the breakpoint is for all threads, leave it as-is.
14663 - Else, reset it to the current thread for inferior_ptid. */
14665 breakpoint_re_set_thread (struct breakpoint *b)
14667 if (b->thread != -1)
14669 if (in_thread_list (inferior_ptid))
14670 b->thread = ptid_to_global_thread_id (inferior_ptid);
14672 /* We're being called after following a fork. The new fork is
14673 selected as current, and unless this was a vfork will have a
14674 different program space from the original thread. Reset that
14676 b->loc->pspace = current_program_space;
14680 /* Set ignore-count of breakpoint number BPTNUM to COUNT.
14681 If from_tty is nonzero, it prints a message to that effect,
14682 which ends with a period (no newline). */
14685 set_ignore_count (int bptnum, int count, int from_tty)
14687 struct breakpoint *b;
14692 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
14693 if (b->number == bptnum)
14695 if (is_tracepoint (b))
14697 if (from_tty && count != 0)
14698 printf_filtered (_("Ignore count ignored for tracepoint %d."),
14703 b->ignore_count = count;
14707 printf_filtered (_("Will stop next time "
14708 "breakpoint %d is reached."),
14710 else if (count == 1)
14711 printf_filtered (_("Will ignore next crossing of breakpoint %d."),
14714 printf_filtered (_("Will ignore next %d "
14715 "crossings of breakpoint %d."),
14718 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b);
14722 error (_("No breakpoint number %d."), bptnum);
14725 /* Command to set ignore-count of breakpoint N to COUNT. */
14728 ignore_command (char *args, int from_tty)
14734 error_no_arg (_("a breakpoint number"));
14736 num = get_number (&p);
14738 error (_("bad breakpoint number: '%s'"), args);
14740 error (_("Second argument (specified ignore-count) is missing."));
14742 set_ignore_count (num,
14743 longest_to_int (value_as_long (parse_and_eval (p))),
14746 printf_filtered ("\n");
14749 /* Call FUNCTION on each of the breakpoints
14750 whose numbers are given in ARGS. */
14753 map_breakpoint_numbers (const char *args,
14754 void (*function) (struct breakpoint *,
14759 struct breakpoint *b, *tmp;
14761 if (args == 0 || *args == '\0')
14762 error_no_arg (_("one or more breakpoint numbers"));
14764 number_or_range_parser parser (args);
14766 while (!parser.finished ())
14768 const char *p = parser.cur_tok ();
14769 bool match = false;
14771 num = parser.get_number ();
14774 warning (_("bad breakpoint number at or near '%s'"), p);
14778 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, tmp)
14779 if (b->number == num)
14782 function (b, data);
14786 printf_unfiltered (_("No breakpoint number %d.\n"), num);
14791 static struct bp_location *
14792 find_location_by_number (char *number)
14794 char *dot = strchr (number, '.');
14798 struct breakpoint *b;
14799 struct bp_location *loc;
14804 bp_num = get_number (&p1);
14806 error (_("Bad breakpoint number '%s'"), number);
14808 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
14809 if (b->number == bp_num)
14814 if (!b || b->number != bp_num)
14815 error (_("Bad breakpoint number '%s'"), number);
14818 loc_num = get_number (&p1);
14820 error (_("Bad breakpoint location number '%s'"), number);
14824 for (;loc_num && loc; --loc_num, loc = loc->next)
14827 error (_("Bad breakpoint location number '%s'"), dot+1);
14833 /* Set ignore-count of breakpoint number BPTNUM to COUNT.
14834 If from_tty is nonzero, it prints a message to that effect,
14835 which ends with a period (no newline). */
14838 disable_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt)
14840 /* Never disable a watchpoint scope breakpoint; we want to
14841 hit them when we leave scope so we can delete both the
14842 watchpoint and its scope breakpoint at that time. */
14843 if (bpt->type == bp_watchpoint_scope)
14846 bpt->enable_state = bp_disabled;
14848 /* Mark breakpoint locations modified. */
14849 mark_breakpoint_modified (bpt);
14851 if (target_supports_enable_disable_tracepoint ()
14852 && current_trace_status ()->running && is_tracepoint (bpt))
14854 struct bp_location *location;
14856 for (location = bpt->loc; location; location = location->next)
14857 target_disable_tracepoint (location);
14860 update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT);
14862 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (bpt);
14865 /* A callback for iterate_over_related_breakpoints. */
14868 do_disable_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b, void *ignore)
14870 disable_breakpoint (b);
14873 /* A callback for map_breakpoint_numbers that calls
14874 disable_breakpoint. */
14877 do_map_disable_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b, void *ignore)
14879 iterate_over_related_breakpoints (b, do_disable_breakpoint, NULL);
14883 disable_command (char *args, int from_tty)
14887 struct breakpoint *bpt;
14889 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt)
14890 if (user_breakpoint_p (bpt))
14891 disable_breakpoint (bpt);
14895 char *num = extract_arg (&args);
14899 if (strchr (num, '.'))
14901 struct bp_location *loc = find_location_by_number (num);
14908 mark_breakpoint_location_modified (loc);
14910 if (target_supports_enable_disable_tracepoint ()
14911 && current_trace_status ()->running && loc->owner
14912 && is_tracepoint (loc->owner))
14913 target_disable_tracepoint (loc);
14915 update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT);
14918 map_breakpoint_numbers (num, do_map_disable_breakpoint, NULL);
14919 num = extract_arg (&args);
14925 enable_breakpoint_disp (struct breakpoint *bpt, enum bpdisp disposition,
14928 int target_resources_ok;
14930 if (bpt->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
14933 i = hw_breakpoint_used_count ();
14934 target_resources_ok =
14935 target_can_use_hardware_watchpoint (bp_hardware_breakpoint,
14937 if (target_resources_ok == 0)
14938 error (_("No hardware breakpoint support in the target."));
14939 else if (target_resources_ok < 0)
14940 error (_("Hardware breakpoints used exceeds limit."));
14943 if (is_watchpoint (bpt))
14945 /* Initialize it just to avoid a GCC false warning. */
14946 enum enable_state orig_enable_state = bp_disabled;
14950 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bpt;
14952 orig_enable_state = bpt->enable_state;
14953 bpt->enable_state = bp_enabled;
14954 update_watchpoint (w, 1 /* reparse */);
14956 CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ALL)
14958 bpt->enable_state = orig_enable_state;
14959 exception_fprintf (gdb_stderr, e, _("Cannot enable watchpoint %d: "),
14966 bpt->enable_state = bp_enabled;
14968 /* Mark breakpoint locations modified. */
14969 mark_breakpoint_modified (bpt);
14971 if (target_supports_enable_disable_tracepoint ()
14972 && current_trace_status ()->running && is_tracepoint (bpt))
14974 struct bp_location *location;
14976 for (location = bpt->loc; location; location = location->next)
14977 target_enable_tracepoint (location);
14980 bpt->disposition = disposition;
14981 bpt->enable_count = count;
14982 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
14984 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (bpt);
14989 enable_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt)
14991 enable_breakpoint_disp (bpt, bpt->disposition, 0);
14995 do_enable_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt, void *arg)
14997 enable_breakpoint (bpt);
15000 /* A callback for map_breakpoint_numbers that calls
15001 enable_breakpoint. */
15004 do_map_enable_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b, void *ignore)
15006 iterate_over_related_breakpoints (b, do_enable_breakpoint, NULL);
15009 /* The enable command enables the specified breakpoints (or all defined
15010 breakpoints) so they once again become (or continue to be) effective
15011 in stopping the inferior. */
15014 enable_command (char *args, int from_tty)
15018 struct breakpoint *bpt;
15020 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt)
15021 if (user_breakpoint_p (bpt))
15022 enable_breakpoint (bpt);
15026 char *num = extract_arg (&args);
15030 if (strchr (num, '.'))
15032 struct bp_location *loc = find_location_by_number (num);
15039 mark_breakpoint_location_modified (loc);
15041 if (target_supports_enable_disable_tracepoint ()
15042 && current_trace_status ()->running && loc->owner
15043 && is_tracepoint (loc->owner))
15044 target_enable_tracepoint (loc);
15046 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
15049 map_breakpoint_numbers (num, do_map_enable_breakpoint, NULL);
15050 num = extract_arg (&args);
15055 /* This struct packages up disposition data for application to multiple
15065 do_enable_breakpoint_disp (struct breakpoint *bpt, void *arg)
15067 struct disp_data disp_data = *(struct disp_data *) arg;
15069 enable_breakpoint_disp (bpt, disp_data.disp, disp_data.count);
15073 do_map_enable_once_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt, void *ignore)
15075 struct disp_data disp = { disp_disable, 1 };
15077 iterate_over_related_breakpoints (bpt, do_enable_breakpoint_disp, &disp);
15081 enable_once_command (char *args, int from_tty)
15083 map_breakpoint_numbers (args, do_map_enable_once_breakpoint, NULL);
15087 do_map_enable_count_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt, void *countptr)
15089 struct disp_data disp = { disp_disable, *(int *) countptr };
15091 iterate_over_related_breakpoints (bpt, do_enable_breakpoint_disp, &disp);
15095 enable_count_command (char *args, int from_tty)
15100 error_no_arg (_("hit count"));
15102 count = get_number (&args);
15104 map_breakpoint_numbers (args, do_map_enable_count_breakpoint, &count);
15108 do_map_enable_delete_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt, void *ignore)
15110 struct disp_data disp = { disp_del, 1 };
15112 iterate_over_related_breakpoints (bpt, do_enable_breakpoint_disp, &disp);
15116 enable_delete_command (char *args, int from_tty)
15118 map_breakpoint_numbers (args, do_map_enable_delete_breakpoint, NULL);
15122 set_breakpoint_cmd (char *args, int from_tty)
15127 show_breakpoint_cmd (char *args, int from_tty)
15131 /* Invalidate last known value of any hardware watchpoint if
15132 the memory which that value represents has been written to by
15136 invalidate_bp_value_on_memory_change (struct inferior *inferior,
15137 CORE_ADDR addr, ssize_t len,
15138 const bfd_byte *data)
15140 struct breakpoint *bp;
15142 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bp)
15143 if (bp->enable_state == bp_enabled
15144 && bp->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint)
15146 struct watchpoint *wp = (struct watchpoint *) bp;
15148 if (wp->val_valid && wp->val)
15150 struct bp_location *loc;
15152 for (loc = bp->loc; loc != NULL; loc = loc->next)
15153 if (loc->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint
15154 && loc->address + loc->length > addr
15155 && addr + len > loc->address)
15157 value_free (wp->val);
15165 /* Create and insert a breakpoint for software single step. */
15168 insert_single_step_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
15169 struct address_space *aspace,
15172 struct thread_info *tp = inferior_thread ();
15173 struct symtab_and_line sal;
15174 CORE_ADDR pc = next_pc;
15176 if (tp->control.single_step_breakpoints == NULL)
15178 tp->control.single_step_breakpoints
15179 = new_single_step_breakpoint (tp->global_num, gdbarch);
15182 sal = find_pc_line (pc, 0);
15184 sal.section = find_pc_overlay (pc);
15185 sal.explicit_pc = 1;
15186 add_location_to_breakpoint (tp->control.single_step_breakpoints, &sal);
15188 update_global_location_list (UGLL_INSERT);
15191 /* Insert single step breakpoints according to the current state. */
15194 insert_single_step_breakpoints (struct gdbarch *gdbarch)
15196 struct regcache *regcache = get_current_regcache ();
15197 VEC (CORE_ADDR) * next_pcs;
15199 next_pcs = gdbarch_software_single_step (gdbarch, regcache);
15201 if (next_pcs != NULL)
15205 struct frame_info *frame = get_current_frame ();
15206 struct address_space *aspace = get_frame_address_space (frame);
15208 for (i = 0; VEC_iterate (CORE_ADDR, next_pcs, i, pc); i++)
15209 insert_single_step_breakpoint (gdbarch, aspace, pc);
15211 VEC_free (CORE_ADDR, next_pcs);
15219 /* See breakpoint.h. */
15222 breakpoint_has_location_inserted_here (struct breakpoint *bp,
15223 struct address_space *aspace,
15226 struct bp_location *loc;
15228 for (loc = bp->loc; loc != NULL; loc = loc->next)
15230 && breakpoint_location_address_match (loc, aspace, pc))
15236 /* Check whether a software single-step breakpoint is inserted at
15240 single_step_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (struct address_space *aspace,
15243 struct breakpoint *bpt;
15245 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt)
15247 if (bpt->type == bp_single_step
15248 && breakpoint_has_location_inserted_here (bpt, aspace, pc))
15254 /* Tracepoint-specific operations. */
15256 /* Set tracepoint count to NUM. */
15258 set_tracepoint_count (int num)
15260 tracepoint_count = num;
15261 set_internalvar_integer (lookup_internalvar ("tpnum"), num);
15265 trace_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
15267 struct breakpoint_ops *ops;
15268 struct event_location *location;
15269 struct cleanup *back_to;
15271 location = string_to_event_location (&arg, current_language);
15272 back_to = make_cleanup_delete_event_location (location);
15273 if (location != NULL
15274 && event_location_type (location) == PROBE_LOCATION)
15275 ops = &tracepoint_probe_breakpoint_ops;
15277 ops = &tracepoint_breakpoint_ops;
15279 create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
15281 NULL, 0, arg, 1 /* parse arg */,
15283 bp_tracepoint /* type_wanted */,
15284 0 /* Ignore count */,
15285 pending_break_support,
15289 0 /* internal */, 0);
15290 do_cleanups (back_to);
15294 ftrace_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
15296 struct event_location *location;
15297 struct cleanup *back_to;
15299 location = string_to_event_location (&arg, current_language);
15300 back_to = make_cleanup_delete_event_location (location);
15301 create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
15303 NULL, 0, arg, 1 /* parse arg */,
15305 bp_fast_tracepoint /* type_wanted */,
15306 0 /* Ignore count */,
15307 pending_break_support,
15308 &tracepoint_breakpoint_ops,
15311 0 /* internal */, 0);
15312 do_cleanups (back_to);
15315 /* strace command implementation. Creates a static tracepoint. */
15318 strace_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
15320 struct breakpoint_ops *ops;
15321 struct event_location *location;
15322 struct cleanup *back_to;
15324 /* Decide if we are dealing with a static tracepoint marker (`-m'),
15325 or with a normal static tracepoint. */
15326 if (arg && startswith (arg, "-m") && isspace (arg[2]))
15328 ops = &strace_marker_breakpoint_ops;
15329 location = new_linespec_location (&arg);
15333 ops = &tracepoint_breakpoint_ops;
15334 location = string_to_event_location (&arg, current_language);
15337 back_to = make_cleanup_delete_event_location (location);
15338 create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
15340 NULL, 0, arg, 1 /* parse arg */,
15342 bp_static_tracepoint /* type_wanted */,
15343 0 /* Ignore count */,
15344 pending_break_support,
15348 0 /* internal */, 0);
15349 do_cleanups (back_to);
15352 /* Set up a fake reader function that gets command lines from a linked
15353 list that was acquired during tracepoint uploading. */
15355 static struct uploaded_tp *this_utp;
15356 static int next_cmd;
15359 read_uploaded_action (void)
15363 VEC_iterate (char_ptr, this_utp->cmd_strings, next_cmd, rslt);
15370 /* Given information about a tracepoint as recorded on a target (which
15371 can be either a live system or a trace file), attempt to create an
15372 equivalent GDB tracepoint. This is not a reliable process, since
15373 the target does not necessarily have all the information used when
15374 the tracepoint was originally defined. */
15376 struct tracepoint *
15377 create_tracepoint_from_upload (struct uploaded_tp *utp)
15379 char *addr_str, small_buf[100];
15380 struct tracepoint *tp;
15381 struct event_location *location;
15382 struct cleanup *cleanup;
15384 if (utp->at_string)
15385 addr_str = utp->at_string;
15388 /* In the absence of a source location, fall back to raw
15389 address. Since there is no way to confirm that the address
15390 means the same thing as when the trace was started, warn the
15392 warning (_("Uploaded tracepoint %d has no "
15393 "source location, using raw address"),
15395 xsnprintf (small_buf, sizeof (small_buf), "*%s", hex_string (utp->addr));
15396 addr_str = small_buf;
15399 /* There's not much we can do with a sequence of bytecodes. */
15400 if (utp->cond && !utp->cond_string)
15401 warning (_("Uploaded tracepoint %d condition "
15402 "has no source form, ignoring it"),
15405 location = string_to_event_location (&addr_str, current_language);
15406 cleanup = make_cleanup_delete_event_location (location);
15407 if (!create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
15409 utp->cond_string, -1, addr_str,
15410 0 /* parse cond/thread */,
15412 utp->type /* type_wanted */,
15413 0 /* Ignore count */,
15414 pending_break_support,
15415 &tracepoint_breakpoint_ops,
15417 utp->enabled /* enabled */,
15419 CREATE_BREAKPOINT_FLAGS_INSERTED))
15421 do_cleanups (cleanup);
15425 do_cleanups (cleanup);
15427 /* Get the tracepoint we just created. */
15428 tp = get_tracepoint (tracepoint_count);
15429 gdb_assert (tp != NULL);
15433 xsnprintf (small_buf, sizeof (small_buf), "%d %d", utp->pass,
15436 trace_pass_command (small_buf, 0);
15439 /* If we have uploaded versions of the original commands, set up a
15440 special-purpose "reader" function and call the usual command line
15441 reader, then pass the result to the breakpoint command-setting
15443 if (!VEC_empty (char_ptr, utp->cmd_strings))
15445 struct command_line *cmd_list;
15450 cmd_list = read_command_lines_1 (read_uploaded_action, 1, NULL, NULL);
15452 breakpoint_set_commands (&tp->base, cmd_list);
15454 else if (!VEC_empty (char_ptr, utp->actions)
15455 || !VEC_empty (char_ptr, utp->step_actions))
15456 warning (_("Uploaded tracepoint %d actions "
15457 "have no source form, ignoring them"),
15460 /* Copy any status information that might be available. */
15461 tp->base.hit_count = utp->hit_count;
15462 tp->traceframe_usage = utp->traceframe_usage;
15467 /* Print information on tracepoint number TPNUM_EXP, or all if
15471 tracepoints_info (char *args, int from_tty)
15473 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
15476 num_printed = breakpoint_1 (args, 0, is_tracepoint);
15478 if (num_printed == 0)
15480 if (args == NULL || *args == '\0')
15481 ui_out_message (uiout, "No tracepoints.\n");
15483 ui_out_message (uiout, "No tracepoint matching '%s'.\n", args);
15486 default_collect_info ();
15489 /* The 'enable trace' command enables tracepoints.
15490 Not supported by all targets. */
15492 enable_trace_command (char *args, int from_tty)
15494 enable_command (args, from_tty);
15497 /* The 'disable trace' command disables tracepoints.
15498 Not supported by all targets. */
15500 disable_trace_command (char *args, int from_tty)
15502 disable_command (args, from_tty);
15505 /* Remove a tracepoint (or all if no argument). */
15507 delete_trace_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
15509 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
15515 int breaks_to_delete = 0;
15517 /* Delete all breakpoints if no argument.
15518 Do not delete internal or call-dummy breakpoints, these
15519 have to be deleted with an explicit breakpoint number
15521 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (b)
15522 if (is_tracepoint (b) && user_breakpoint_p (b))
15524 breaks_to_delete = 1;
15528 /* Ask user only if there are some breakpoints to delete. */
15530 || (breaks_to_delete && query (_("Delete all tracepoints? "))))
15532 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
15533 if (is_tracepoint (b) && user_breakpoint_p (b))
15534 delete_breakpoint (b);
15538 map_breakpoint_numbers (arg, do_map_delete_breakpoint, NULL);
15541 /* Helper function for trace_pass_command. */
15544 trace_pass_set_count (struct tracepoint *tp, int count, int from_tty)
15546 tp->pass_count = count;
15547 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (&tp->base);
15549 printf_filtered (_("Setting tracepoint %d's passcount to %d\n"),
15550 tp->base.number, count);
15553 /* Set passcount for tracepoint.
15555 First command argument is passcount, second is tracepoint number.
15556 If tracepoint number omitted, apply to most recently defined.
15557 Also accepts special argument "all". */
15560 trace_pass_command (char *args, int from_tty)
15562 struct tracepoint *t1;
15563 unsigned int count;
15565 if (args == 0 || *args == 0)
15566 error (_("passcount command requires an "
15567 "argument (count + optional TP num)"));
15569 count = strtoul (args, &args, 10); /* Count comes first, then TP num. */
15571 args = skip_spaces (args);
15572 if (*args && strncasecmp (args, "all", 3) == 0)
15574 struct breakpoint *b;
15576 args += 3; /* Skip special argument "all". */
15578 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
15580 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (b)
15582 t1 = (struct tracepoint *) b;
15583 trace_pass_set_count (t1, count, from_tty);
15586 else if (*args == '\0')
15588 t1 = get_tracepoint_by_number (&args, NULL);
15590 trace_pass_set_count (t1, count, from_tty);
15594 number_or_range_parser parser (args);
15595 while (!parser.finished ())
15597 t1 = get_tracepoint_by_number (&args, &parser);
15599 trace_pass_set_count (t1, count, from_tty);
15604 struct tracepoint *
15605 get_tracepoint (int num)
15607 struct breakpoint *t;
15609 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (t)
15610 if (t->number == num)
15611 return (struct tracepoint *) t;
15616 /* Find the tracepoint with the given target-side number (which may be
15617 different from the tracepoint number after disconnecting and
15620 struct tracepoint *
15621 get_tracepoint_by_number_on_target (int num)
15623 struct breakpoint *b;
15625 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (b)
15627 struct tracepoint *t = (struct tracepoint *) b;
15629 if (t->number_on_target == num)
15636 /* Utility: parse a tracepoint number and look it up in the list.
15637 If STATE is not NULL, use, get_number_or_range_state and ignore ARG.
15638 If the argument is missing, the most recent tracepoint
15639 (tracepoint_count) is returned. */
15641 struct tracepoint *
15642 get_tracepoint_by_number (char **arg,
15643 number_or_range_parser *parser)
15645 struct breakpoint *t;
15647 char *instring = arg == NULL ? NULL : *arg;
15649 if (parser != NULL)
15651 gdb_assert (!parser->finished ());
15652 tpnum = parser->get_number ();
15654 else if (arg == NULL || *arg == NULL || ! **arg)
15655 tpnum = tracepoint_count;
15657 tpnum = get_number (arg);
15661 if (instring && *instring)
15662 printf_filtered (_("bad tracepoint number at or near '%s'\n"),
15665 printf_filtered (_("No previous tracepoint\n"));
15669 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (t)
15670 if (t->number == tpnum)
15672 return (struct tracepoint *) t;
15675 printf_unfiltered ("No tracepoint number %d.\n", tpnum);
15680 print_recreate_thread (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
15682 if (b->thread != -1)
15683 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " thread %d", b->thread);
15686 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " task %d", b->task);
15688 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "\n");
15691 /* Save information on user settable breakpoints (watchpoints, etc) to
15692 a new script file named FILENAME. If FILTER is non-NULL, call it
15693 on each breakpoint and only include the ones for which it returns
15697 save_breakpoints (char *filename, int from_tty,
15698 int (*filter) (const struct breakpoint *))
15700 struct breakpoint *tp;
15702 struct cleanup *cleanup;
15703 struct ui_file *fp;
15704 int extra_trace_bits = 0;
15706 if (filename == 0 || *filename == 0)
15707 error (_("Argument required (file name in which to save)"));
15709 /* See if we have anything to save. */
15710 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (tp)
15712 /* Skip internal and momentary breakpoints. */
15713 if (!user_breakpoint_p (tp))
15716 /* If we have a filter, only save the breakpoints it accepts. */
15717 if (filter && !filter (tp))
15722 if (is_tracepoint (tp))
15724 extra_trace_bits = 1;
15726 /* We can stop searching. */
15733 warning (_("Nothing to save."));
15737 filename = tilde_expand (filename);
15738 cleanup = make_cleanup (xfree, filename);
15739 fp = gdb_fopen (filename, "w");
15741 error (_("Unable to open file '%s' for saving (%s)"),
15742 filename, safe_strerror (errno));
15743 make_cleanup_ui_file_delete (fp);
15745 if (extra_trace_bits)
15746 save_trace_state_variables (fp);
15748 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (tp)
15750 /* Skip internal and momentary breakpoints. */
15751 if (!user_breakpoint_p (tp))
15754 /* If we have a filter, only save the breakpoints it accepts. */
15755 if (filter && !filter (tp))
15758 tp->ops->print_recreate (tp, fp);
15760 /* Note, we can't rely on tp->number for anything, as we can't
15761 assume the recreated breakpoint numbers will match. Use $bpnum
15764 if (tp->cond_string)
15765 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " condition $bpnum %s\n", tp->cond_string);
15767 if (tp->ignore_count)
15768 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " ignore $bpnum %d\n", tp->ignore_count);
15770 if (tp->type != bp_dprintf && tp->commands)
15772 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " commands\n");
15774 ui_out_redirect (current_uiout, fp);
15777 print_command_lines (current_uiout, tp->commands->commands, 2);
15779 CATCH (ex, RETURN_MASK_ALL)
15781 ui_out_redirect (current_uiout, NULL);
15782 throw_exception (ex);
15786 ui_out_redirect (current_uiout, NULL);
15787 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " end\n");
15790 if (tp->enable_state == bp_disabled)
15791 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "disable $bpnum\n");
15793 /* If this is a multi-location breakpoint, check if the locations
15794 should be individually disabled. Watchpoint locations are
15795 special, and not user visible. */
15796 if (!is_watchpoint (tp) && tp->loc && tp->loc->next)
15798 struct bp_location *loc;
15801 for (loc = tp->loc; loc != NULL; loc = loc->next, n++)
15803 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "disable $bpnum.%d\n", n);
15807 if (extra_trace_bits && *default_collect)
15808 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "set default-collect %s\n", default_collect);
15811 printf_filtered (_("Saved to file '%s'.\n"), filename);
15812 do_cleanups (cleanup);
15815 /* The `save breakpoints' command. */
15818 save_breakpoints_command (char *args, int from_tty)
15820 save_breakpoints (args, from_tty, NULL);
15823 /* The `save tracepoints' command. */
15826 save_tracepoints_command (char *args, int from_tty)
15828 save_breakpoints (args, from_tty, is_tracepoint);
15831 /* Create a vector of all tracepoints. */
15833 VEC(breakpoint_p) *
15834 all_tracepoints (void)
15836 VEC(breakpoint_p) *tp_vec = 0;
15837 struct breakpoint *tp;
15839 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (tp)
15841 VEC_safe_push (breakpoint_p, tp_vec, tp);
15848 /* This help string is used to consolidate all the help string for specifying
15849 locations used by several commands. */
15851 #define LOCATION_HELP_STRING \
15852 "Linespecs are colon-separated lists of location parameters, such as\n\
15853 source filename, function name, label name, and line number.\n\
15854 Example: To specify the start of a label named \"the_top\" in the\n\
15855 function \"fact\" in the file \"factorial.c\", use\n\
15856 \"factorial.c:fact:the_top\".\n\
15858 Address locations begin with \"*\" and specify an exact address in the\n\
15859 program. Example: To specify the fourth byte past the start function\n\
15860 \"main\", use \"*main + 4\".\n\
15862 Explicit locations are similar to linespecs but use an option/argument\n\
15863 syntax to specify location parameters.\n\
15864 Example: To specify the start of the label named \"the_top\" in the\n\
15865 function \"fact\" in the file \"factorial.c\", use \"-source factorial.c\n\
15866 -function fact -label the_top\".\n"
15868 /* This help string is used for the break, hbreak, tbreak and thbreak
15869 commands. It is defined as a macro to prevent duplication.
15870 COMMAND should be a string constant containing the name of the
15873 #define BREAK_ARGS_HELP(command) \
15874 command" [PROBE_MODIFIER] [LOCATION] [thread THREADNUM] [if CONDITION]\n\
15875 PROBE_MODIFIER shall be present if the command is to be placed in a\n\
15876 probe point. Accepted values are `-probe' (for a generic, automatically\n\
15877 guessed probe type), `-probe-stap' (for a SystemTap probe) or \n\
15878 `-probe-dtrace' (for a DTrace probe).\n\
15879 LOCATION may be a linespec, address, or explicit location as described\n\
15882 With no LOCATION, uses current execution address of the selected\n\
15883 stack frame. This is useful for breaking on return to a stack frame.\n\
15885 THREADNUM is the number from \"info threads\".\n\
15886 CONDITION is a boolean expression.\n\
15887 \n" LOCATION_HELP_STRING "\n\
15888 Multiple breakpoints at one place are permitted, and useful if their\n\
15889 conditions are different.\n\
15891 Do \"help breakpoints\" for info on other commands dealing with breakpoints."
15893 /* List of subcommands for "catch". */
15894 static struct cmd_list_element *catch_cmdlist;
15896 /* List of subcommands for "tcatch". */
15897 static struct cmd_list_element *tcatch_cmdlist;
15900 add_catch_command (char *name, char *docstring,
15901 cmd_sfunc_ftype *sfunc,
15902 completer_ftype *completer,
15903 void *user_data_catch,
15904 void *user_data_tcatch)
15906 struct cmd_list_element *command;
15908 command = add_cmd (name, class_breakpoint, NULL, docstring,
15910 set_cmd_sfunc (command, sfunc);
15911 set_cmd_context (command, user_data_catch);
15912 set_cmd_completer (command, completer);
15914 command = add_cmd (name, class_breakpoint, NULL, docstring,
15916 set_cmd_sfunc (command, sfunc);
15917 set_cmd_context (command, user_data_tcatch);
15918 set_cmd_completer (command, completer);
15922 save_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
15924 printf_unfiltered (_("\"save\" must be followed by "
15925 "the name of a save subcommand.\n"));
15926 help_list (save_cmdlist, "save ", all_commands, gdb_stdout);
15929 struct breakpoint *
15930 iterate_over_breakpoints (int (*callback) (struct breakpoint *, void *),
15933 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
15935 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
15937 if ((*callback) (b, data))
15944 /* Zero if any of the breakpoint's locations could be a location where
15945 functions have been inlined, nonzero otherwise. */
15948 is_non_inline_function (struct breakpoint *b)
15950 /* The shared library event breakpoint is set on the address of a
15951 non-inline function. */
15952 if (b->type == bp_shlib_event)
15958 /* Nonzero if the specified PC cannot be a location where functions
15959 have been inlined. */
15962 pc_at_non_inline_function (struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc,
15963 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
15965 struct breakpoint *b;
15966 struct bp_location *bl;
15968 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
15970 if (!is_non_inline_function (b))
15973 for (bl = b->loc; bl != NULL; bl = bl->next)
15975 if (!bl->shlib_disabled
15976 && bpstat_check_location (bl, aspace, pc, ws))
15984 /* Remove any references to OBJFILE which is going to be freed. */
15987 breakpoint_free_objfile (struct objfile *objfile)
15989 struct bp_location **locp, *loc;
15991 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, locp)
15992 if (loc->symtab != NULL && SYMTAB_OBJFILE (loc->symtab) == objfile)
15993 loc->symtab = NULL;
15997 initialize_breakpoint_ops (void)
15999 static int initialized = 0;
16001 struct breakpoint_ops *ops;
16007 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be inherit by all kinds of
16008 breakpoints (real breakpoints, i.e., user "break" breakpoints,
16009 internal and momentary breakpoints, etc.). */
16010 ops = &bkpt_base_breakpoint_ops;
16011 *ops = base_breakpoint_ops;
16012 ops->re_set = bkpt_re_set;
16013 ops->insert_location = bkpt_insert_location;
16014 ops->remove_location = bkpt_remove_location;
16015 ops->breakpoint_hit = bkpt_breakpoint_hit;
16016 ops->create_sals_from_location = bkpt_create_sals_from_location;
16017 ops->create_breakpoints_sal = bkpt_create_breakpoints_sal;
16018 ops->decode_location = bkpt_decode_location;
16020 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in regular breakpoints. */
16021 ops = &bkpt_breakpoint_ops;
16022 *ops = bkpt_base_breakpoint_ops;
16023 ops->re_set = bkpt_re_set;
16024 ops->resources_needed = bkpt_resources_needed;
16025 ops->print_it = bkpt_print_it;
16026 ops->print_mention = bkpt_print_mention;
16027 ops->print_recreate = bkpt_print_recreate;
16029 /* Ranged breakpoints. */
16030 ops = &ranged_breakpoint_ops;
16031 *ops = bkpt_breakpoint_ops;
16032 ops->breakpoint_hit = breakpoint_hit_ranged_breakpoint;
16033 ops->resources_needed = resources_needed_ranged_breakpoint;
16034 ops->print_it = print_it_ranged_breakpoint;
16035 ops->print_one = print_one_ranged_breakpoint;
16036 ops->print_one_detail = print_one_detail_ranged_breakpoint;
16037 ops->print_mention = print_mention_ranged_breakpoint;
16038 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_ranged_breakpoint;
16040 /* Internal breakpoints. */
16041 ops = &internal_breakpoint_ops;
16042 *ops = bkpt_base_breakpoint_ops;
16043 ops->re_set = internal_bkpt_re_set;
16044 ops->check_status = internal_bkpt_check_status;
16045 ops->print_it = internal_bkpt_print_it;
16046 ops->print_mention = internal_bkpt_print_mention;
16048 /* Momentary breakpoints. */
16049 ops = &momentary_breakpoint_ops;
16050 *ops = bkpt_base_breakpoint_ops;
16051 ops->re_set = momentary_bkpt_re_set;
16052 ops->check_status = momentary_bkpt_check_status;
16053 ops->print_it = momentary_bkpt_print_it;
16054 ops->print_mention = momentary_bkpt_print_mention;
16056 /* Momentary breakpoints for bp_longjmp and bp_exception. */
16057 ops = &longjmp_breakpoint_ops;
16058 *ops = momentary_breakpoint_ops;
16059 ops->dtor = longjmp_bkpt_dtor;
16061 /* Probe breakpoints. */
16062 ops = &bkpt_probe_breakpoint_ops;
16063 *ops = bkpt_breakpoint_ops;
16064 ops->insert_location = bkpt_probe_insert_location;
16065 ops->remove_location = bkpt_probe_remove_location;
16066 ops->create_sals_from_location = bkpt_probe_create_sals_from_location;
16067 ops->decode_location = bkpt_probe_decode_location;
16070 ops = &watchpoint_breakpoint_ops;
16071 *ops = base_breakpoint_ops;
16072 ops->dtor = dtor_watchpoint;
16073 ops->re_set = re_set_watchpoint;
16074 ops->insert_location = insert_watchpoint;
16075 ops->remove_location = remove_watchpoint;
16076 ops->breakpoint_hit = breakpoint_hit_watchpoint;
16077 ops->check_status = check_status_watchpoint;
16078 ops->resources_needed = resources_needed_watchpoint;
16079 ops->works_in_software_mode = works_in_software_mode_watchpoint;
16080 ops->print_it = print_it_watchpoint;
16081 ops->print_mention = print_mention_watchpoint;
16082 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_watchpoint;
16083 ops->explains_signal = explains_signal_watchpoint;
16085 /* Masked watchpoints. */
16086 ops = &masked_watchpoint_breakpoint_ops;
16087 *ops = watchpoint_breakpoint_ops;
16088 ops->insert_location = insert_masked_watchpoint;
16089 ops->remove_location = remove_masked_watchpoint;
16090 ops->resources_needed = resources_needed_masked_watchpoint;
16091 ops->works_in_software_mode = works_in_software_mode_masked_watchpoint;
16092 ops->print_it = print_it_masked_watchpoint;
16093 ops->print_one_detail = print_one_detail_masked_watchpoint;
16094 ops->print_mention = print_mention_masked_watchpoint;
16095 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_masked_watchpoint;
16098 ops = &tracepoint_breakpoint_ops;
16099 *ops = base_breakpoint_ops;
16100 ops->re_set = tracepoint_re_set;
16101 ops->breakpoint_hit = tracepoint_breakpoint_hit;
16102 ops->print_one_detail = tracepoint_print_one_detail;
16103 ops->print_mention = tracepoint_print_mention;
16104 ops->print_recreate = tracepoint_print_recreate;
16105 ops->create_sals_from_location = tracepoint_create_sals_from_location;
16106 ops->create_breakpoints_sal = tracepoint_create_breakpoints_sal;
16107 ops->decode_location = tracepoint_decode_location;
16109 /* Probe tracepoints. */
16110 ops = &tracepoint_probe_breakpoint_ops;
16111 *ops = tracepoint_breakpoint_ops;
16112 ops->create_sals_from_location = tracepoint_probe_create_sals_from_location;
16113 ops->decode_location = tracepoint_probe_decode_location;
16115 /* Static tracepoints with marker (`-m'). */
16116 ops = &strace_marker_breakpoint_ops;
16117 *ops = tracepoint_breakpoint_ops;
16118 ops->create_sals_from_location = strace_marker_create_sals_from_location;
16119 ops->create_breakpoints_sal = strace_marker_create_breakpoints_sal;
16120 ops->decode_location = strace_marker_decode_location;
16122 /* Fork catchpoints. */
16123 ops = &catch_fork_breakpoint_ops;
16124 *ops = base_breakpoint_ops;
16125 ops->insert_location = insert_catch_fork;
16126 ops->remove_location = remove_catch_fork;
16127 ops->breakpoint_hit = breakpoint_hit_catch_fork;
16128 ops->print_it = print_it_catch_fork;
16129 ops->print_one = print_one_catch_fork;
16130 ops->print_mention = print_mention_catch_fork;
16131 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_catch_fork;
16133 /* Vfork catchpoints. */
16134 ops = &catch_vfork_breakpoint_ops;
16135 *ops = base_breakpoint_ops;
16136 ops->insert_location = insert_catch_vfork;
16137 ops->remove_location = remove_catch_vfork;
16138 ops->breakpoint_hit = breakpoint_hit_catch_vfork;
16139 ops->print_it = print_it_catch_vfork;
16140 ops->print_one = print_one_catch_vfork;
16141 ops->print_mention = print_mention_catch_vfork;
16142 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_catch_vfork;
16144 /* Exec catchpoints. */
16145 ops = &catch_exec_breakpoint_ops;
16146 *ops = base_breakpoint_ops;
16147 ops->dtor = dtor_catch_exec;
16148 ops->insert_location = insert_catch_exec;
16149 ops->remove_location = remove_catch_exec;
16150 ops->breakpoint_hit = breakpoint_hit_catch_exec;
16151 ops->print_it = print_it_catch_exec;
16152 ops->print_one = print_one_catch_exec;
16153 ops->print_mention = print_mention_catch_exec;
16154 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_catch_exec;
16156 /* Solib-related catchpoints. */
16157 ops = &catch_solib_breakpoint_ops;
16158 *ops = base_breakpoint_ops;
16159 ops->dtor = dtor_catch_solib;
16160 ops->insert_location = insert_catch_solib;
16161 ops->remove_location = remove_catch_solib;
16162 ops->breakpoint_hit = breakpoint_hit_catch_solib;
16163 ops->check_status = check_status_catch_solib;
16164 ops->print_it = print_it_catch_solib;
16165 ops->print_one = print_one_catch_solib;
16166 ops->print_mention = print_mention_catch_solib;
16167 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_catch_solib;
16169 ops = &dprintf_breakpoint_ops;
16170 *ops = bkpt_base_breakpoint_ops;
16171 ops->re_set = dprintf_re_set;
16172 ops->resources_needed = bkpt_resources_needed;
16173 ops->print_it = bkpt_print_it;
16174 ops->print_mention = bkpt_print_mention;
16175 ops->print_recreate = dprintf_print_recreate;
16176 ops->after_condition_true = dprintf_after_condition_true;
16177 ops->breakpoint_hit = dprintf_breakpoint_hit;
16180 /* Chain containing all defined "enable breakpoint" subcommands. */
16182 static struct cmd_list_element *enablebreaklist = NULL;
16185 _initialize_breakpoint (void)
16187 struct cmd_list_element *c;
16189 initialize_breakpoint_ops ();
16191 observer_attach_solib_unloaded (disable_breakpoints_in_unloaded_shlib);
16192 observer_attach_free_objfile (disable_breakpoints_in_freed_objfile);
16193 observer_attach_memory_changed (invalidate_bp_value_on_memory_change);
16195 breakpoint_objfile_key
16196 = register_objfile_data_with_cleanup (NULL, free_breakpoint_probes);
16198 breakpoint_chain = 0;
16199 /* Don't bother to call set_breakpoint_count. $bpnum isn't useful
16200 before a breakpoint is set. */
16201 breakpoint_count = 0;
16203 tracepoint_count = 0;
16205 add_com ("ignore", class_breakpoint, ignore_command, _("\
16206 Set ignore-count of breakpoint number N to COUNT.\n\
16207 Usage is `ignore N COUNT'."));
16209 add_com ("commands", class_breakpoint, commands_command, _("\
16210 Set commands to be executed when a breakpoint is hit.\n\
16211 Give breakpoint number as argument after \"commands\".\n\
16212 With no argument, the targeted breakpoint is the last one set.\n\
16213 The commands themselves follow starting on the next line.\n\
16214 Type a line containing \"end\" to indicate the end of them.\n\
16215 Give \"silent\" as the first line to make the breakpoint silent;\n\
16216 then no output is printed when it is hit, except what the commands print."));
16218 c = add_com ("condition", class_breakpoint, condition_command, _("\
16219 Specify breakpoint number N to break only if COND is true.\n\
16220 Usage is `condition N COND', where N is an integer and COND is an\n\
16221 expression to be evaluated whenever breakpoint N is reached."));
16222 set_cmd_completer (c, condition_completer);
16224 c = add_com ("tbreak", class_breakpoint, tbreak_command, _("\
16225 Set a temporary breakpoint.\n\
16226 Like \"break\" except the breakpoint is only temporary,\n\
16227 so it will be deleted when hit. Equivalent to \"break\" followed\n\
16228 by using \"enable delete\" on the breakpoint number.\n\
16230 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("tbreak")));
16231 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
16233 c = add_com ("hbreak", class_breakpoint, hbreak_command, _("\
16234 Set a hardware assisted breakpoint.\n\
16235 Like \"break\" except the breakpoint requires hardware support,\n\
16236 some target hardware may not have this support.\n\
16238 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("hbreak")));
16239 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
16241 c = add_com ("thbreak", class_breakpoint, thbreak_command, _("\
16242 Set a temporary hardware assisted breakpoint.\n\
16243 Like \"hbreak\" except the breakpoint is only temporary,\n\
16244 so it will be deleted when hit.\n\
16246 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("thbreak")));
16247 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
16249 add_prefix_cmd ("enable", class_breakpoint, enable_command, _("\
16250 Enable some breakpoints.\n\
16251 Give breakpoint numbers (separated by spaces) as arguments.\n\
16252 With no subcommand, breakpoints are enabled until you command otherwise.\n\
16253 This is used to cancel the effect of the \"disable\" command.\n\
16254 With a subcommand you can enable temporarily."),
16255 &enablelist, "enable ", 1, &cmdlist);
16257 add_com_alias ("en", "enable", class_breakpoint, 1);
16259 add_prefix_cmd ("breakpoints", class_breakpoint, enable_command, _("\
16260 Enable some breakpoints.\n\
16261 Give breakpoint numbers (separated by spaces) as arguments.\n\
16262 This is used to cancel the effect of the \"disable\" command.\n\
16263 May be abbreviated to simply \"enable\".\n"),
16264 &enablebreaklist, "enable breakpoints ", 1, &enablelist);
16266 add_cmd ("once", no_class, enable_once_command, _("\
16267 Enable breakpoints for one hit. Give breakpoint numbers.\n\
16268 If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion, it becomes disabled."),
16271 add_cmd ("delete", no_class, enable_delete_command, _("\
16272 Enable breakpoints and delete when hit. Give breakpoint numbers.\n\
16273 If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion, it is deleted."),
16276 add_cmd ("count", no_class, enable_count_command, _("\
16277 Enable breakpoints for COUNT hits. Give count and then breakpoint numbers.\n\
16278 If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion,\n\
16279 the count is decremented; when it reaches zero, the breakpoint is disabled."),
16282 add_cmd ("delete", no_class, enable_delete_command, _("\
16283 Enable breakpoints and delete when hit. Give breakpoint numbers.\n\
16284 If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion, it is deleted."),
16287 add_cmd ("once", no_class, enable_once_command, _("\
16288 Enable breakpoints for one hit. Give breakpoint numbers.\n\
16289 If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion, it becomes disabled."),
16292 add_cmd ("count", no_class, enable_count_command, _("\
16293 Enable breakpoints for COUNT hits. Give count and then breakpoint numbers.\n\
16294 If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion,\n\
16295 the count is decremented; when it reaches zero, the breakpoint is disabled."),
16298 add_prefix_cmd ("disable", class_breakpoint, disable_command, _("\
16299 Disable some breakpoints.\n\
16300 Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
16301 To disable all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\
16302 A disabled breakpoint is not forgotten, but has no effect until re-enabled."),
16303 &disablelist, "disable ", 1, &cmdlist);
16304 add_com_alias ("dis", "disable", class_breakpoint, 1);
16305 add_com_alias ("disa", "disable", class_breakpoint, 1);
16307 add_cmd ("breakpoints", class_alias, disable_command, _("\
16308 Disable some breakpoints.\n\
16309 Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
16310 To disable all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\
16311 A disabled breakpoint is not forgotten, but has no effect until re-enabled.\n\
16312 This command may be abbreviated \"disable\"."),
16315 add_prefix_cmd ("delete", class_breakpoint, delete_command, _("\
16316 Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions.\n\
16317 Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
16318 To delete all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\
16320 Also a prefix command for deletion of other GDB objects.\n\
16321 The \"unset\" command is also an alias for \"delete\"."),
16322 &deletelist, "delete ", 1, &cmdlist);
16323 add_com_alias ("d", "delete", class_breakpoint, 1);
16324 add_com_alias ("del", "delete", class_breakpoint, 1);
16326 add_cmd ("breakpoints", class_alias, delete_command, _("\
16327 Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions.\n\
16328 Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
16329 To delete all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\
16330 This command may be abbreviated \"delete\"."),
16333 add_com ("clear", class_breakpoint, clear_command, _("\
16334 Clear breakpoint at specified location.\n\
16335 Argument may be a linespec, explicit, or address location as described below.\n\
16337 With no argument, clears all breakpoints in the line that the selected frame\n\
16338 is executing in.\n"
16339 "\n" LOCATION_HELP_STRING "\n\
16340 See also the \"delete\" command which clears breakpoints by number."));
16341 add_com_alias ("cl", "clear", class_breakpoint, 1);
16343 c = add_com ("break", class_breakpoint, break_command, _("\
16344 Set breakpoint at specified location.\n"
16345 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("break")));
16346 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
16348 add_com_alias ("b", "break", class_run, 1);
16349 add_com_alias ("br", "break", class_run, 1);
16350 add_com_alias ("bre", "break", class_run, 1);
16351 add_com_alias ("brea", "break", class_run, 1);
16355 add_abbrev_prefix_cmd ("stop", class_breakpoint, stop_command, _("\
16356 Break in function/address or break at a line in the current file."),
16357 &stoplist, "stop ", 1, &cmdlist);
16358 add_cmd ("in", class_breakpoint, stopin_command,
16359 _("Break in function or address."), &stoplist);
16360 add_cmd ("at", class_breakpoint, stopat_command,
16361 _("Break at a line in the current file."), &stoplist);
16362 add_com ("status", class_info, breakpoints_info, _("\
16363 Status of user-settable breakpoints, or breakpoint number NUMBER.\n\
16364 The \"Type\" column indicates one of:\n\
16365 \tbreakpoint - normal breakpoint\n\
16366 \twatchpoint - watchpoint\n\
16367 The \"Disp\" column contains one of \"keep\", \"del\", or \"dis\" to indicate\n\
16368 the disposition of the breakpoint after it gets hit. \"dis\" means that the\n\
16369 breakpoint will be disabled. The \"Address\" and \"What\" columns indicate the\n\
16370 address and file/line number respectively.\n\
16372 Convenience variable \"$_\" and default examine address for \"x\"\n\
16373 are set to the address of the last breakpoint listed unless the command\n\
16374 is prefixed with \"server \".\n\n\
16375 Convenience variable \"$bpnum\" contains the number of the last\n\
16376 breakpoint set."));
16379 add_info ("breakpoints", breakpoints_info, _("\
16380 Status of specified breakpoints (all user-settable breakpoints if no argument).\n\
16381 The \"Type\" column indicates one of:\n\
16382 \tbreakpoint - normal breakpoint\n\
16383 \twatchpoint - watchpoint\n\
16384 The \"Disp\" column contains one of \"keep\", \"del\", or \"dis\" to indicate\n\
16385 the disposition of the breakpoint after it gets hit. \"dis\" means that the\n\
16386 breakpoint will be disabled. The \"Address\" and \"What\" columns indicate the\n\
16387 address and file/line number respectively.\n\
16389 Convenience variable \"$_\" and default examine address for \"x\"\n\
16390 are set to the address of the last breakpoint listed unless the command\n\
16391 is prefixed with \"server \".\n\n\
16392 Convenience variable \"$bpnum\" contains the number of the last\n\
16393 breakpoint set."));
16395 add_info_alias ("b", "breakpoints", 1);
16397 add_cmd ("breakpoints", class_maintenance, maintenance_info_breakpoints, _("\
16398 Status of all breakpoints, or breakpoint number NUMBER.\n\
16399 The \"Type\" column indicates one of:\n\
16400 \tbreakpoint - normal breakpoint\n\
16401 \twatchpoint - watchpoint\n\
16402 \tlongjmp - internal breakpoint used to step through longjmp()\n\
16403 \tlongjmp resume - internal breakpoint at the target of longjmp()\n\
16404 \tuntil - internal breakpoint used by the \"until\" command\n\
16405 \tfinish - internal breakpoint used by the \"finish\" command\n\
16406 The \"Disp\" column contains one of \"keep\", \"del\", or \"dis\" to indicate\n\
16407 the disposition of the breakpoint after it gets hit. \"dis\" means that the\n\
16408 breakpoint will be disabled. The \"Address\" and \"What\" columns indicate the\n\
16409 address and file/line number respectively.\n\
16411 Convenience variable \"$_\" and default examine address for \"x\"\n\
16412 are set to the address of the last breakpoint listed unless the command\n\
16413 is prefixed with \"server \".\n\n\
16414 Convenience variable \"$bpnum\" contains the number of the last\n\
16416 &maintenanceinfolist);
16418 add_prefix_cmd ("catch", class_breakpoint, catch_command, _("\
16419 Set catchpoints to catch events."),
16420 &catch_cmdlist, "catch ",
16421 0/*allow-unknown*/, &cmdlist);
16423 add_prefix_cmd ("tcatch", class_breakpoint, tcatch_command, _("\
16424 Set temporary catchpoints to catch events."),
16425 &tcatch_cmdlist, "tcatch ",
16426 0/*allow-unknown*/, &cmdlist);
16428 add_catch_command ("fork", _("Catch calls to fork."),
16429 catch_fork_command_1,
16431 (void *) (uintptr_t) catch_fork_permanent,
16432 (void *) (uintptr_t) catch_fork_temporary);
16433 add_catch_command ("vfork", _("Catch calls to vfork."),
16434 catch_fork_command_1,
16436 (void *) (uintptr_t) catch_vfork_permanent,
16437 (void *) (uintptr_t) catch_vfork_temporary);
16438 add_catch_command ("exec", _("Catch calls to exec."),
16439 catch_exec_command_1,
16443 add_catch_command ("load", _("Catch loads of shared libraries.\n\
16444 Usage: catch load [REGEX]\n\
16445 If REGEX is given, only stop for libraries matching the regular expression."),
16446 catch_load_command_1,
16450 add_catch_command ("unload", _("Catch unloads of shared libraries.\n\
16451 Usage: catch unload [REGEX]\n\
16452 If REGEX is given, only stop for libraries matching the regular expression."),
16453 catch_unload_command_1,
16458 c = add_com ("watch", class_breakpoint, watch_command, _("\
16459 Set a watchpoint for an expression.\n\
16460 Usage: watch [-l|-location] EXPRESSION\n\
16461 A watchpoint stops execution of your program whenever the value of\n\
16462 an expression changes.\n\
16463 If -l or -location is given, this evaluates EXPRESSION and watches\n\
16464 the memory to which it refers."));
16465 set_cmd_completer (c, expression_completer);
16467 c = add_com ("rwatch", class_breakpoint, rwatch_command, _("\
16468 Set a read watchpoint for an expression.\n\
16469 Usage: rwatch [-l|-location] EXPRESSION\n\
16470 A watchpoint stops execution of your program whenever the value of\n\
16471 an expression is read.\n\
16472 If -l or -location is given, this evaluates EXPRESSION and watches\n\
16473 the memory to which it refers."));
16474 set_cmd_completer (c, expression_completer);
16476 c = add_com ("awatch", class_breakpoint, awatch_command, _("\
16477 Set a watchpoint for an expression.\n\
16478 Usage: awatch [-l|-location] EXPRESSION\n\
16479 A watchpoint stops execution of your program whenever the value of\n\
16480 an expression is either read or written.\n\
16481 If -l or -location is given, this evaluates EXPRESSION and watches\n\
16482 the memory to which it refers."));
16483 set_cmd_completer (c, expression_completer);
16485 add_info ("watchpoints", watchpoints_info, _("\
16486 Status of specified watchpoints (all watchpoints if no argument)."));
16488 /* XXX: cagney/2005-02-23: This should be a boolean, and should
16489 respond to changes - contrary to the description. */
16490 add_setshow_zinteger_cmd ("can-use-hw-watchpoints", class_support,
16491 &can_use_hw_watchpoints, _("\
16492 Set debugger's willingness to use watchpoint hardware."), _("\
16493 Show debugger's willingness to use watchpoint hardware."), _("\
16494 If zero, gdb will not use hardware for new watchpoints, even if\n\
16495 such is available. (However, any hardware watchpoints that were\n\
16496 created before setting this to nonzero, will continue to use watchpoint\n\
16499 show_can_use_hw_watchpoints,
16500 &setlist, &showlist);
16502 can_use_hw_watchpoints = 1;
16504 /* Tracepoint manipulation commands. */
16506 c = add_com ("trace", class_breakpoint, trace_command, _("\
16507 Set a tracepoint at specified location.\n\
16509 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("trace") "\n\
16510 Do \"help tracepoints\" for info on other tracepoint commands."));
16511 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
16513 add_com_alias ("tp", "trace", class_alias, 0);
16514 add_com_alias ("tr", "trace", class_alias, 1);
16515 add_com_alias ("tra", "trace", class_alias, 1);
16516 add_com_alias ("trac", "trace", class_alias, 1);
16518 c = add_com ("ftrace", class_breakpoint, ftrace_command, _("\
16519 Set a fast tracepoint at specified location.\n\
16521 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("ftrace") "\n\
16522 Do \"help tracepoints\" for info on other tracepoint commands."));
16523 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
16525 c = add_com ("strace", class_breakpoint, strace_command, _("\
16526 Set a static tracepoint at location or marker.\n\
16528 strace [LOCATION] [if CONDITION]\n\
16529 LOCATION may be a linespec, explicit, or address location (described below) \n\
16530 or -m MARKER_ID.\n\n\
16531 If a marker id is specified, probe the marker with that name. With\n\
16532 no LOCATION, uses current execution address of the selected stack frame.\n\
16533 Static tracepoints accept an extra collect action -- ``collect $_sdata''.\n\
16534 This collects arbitrary user data passed in the probe point call to the\n\
16535 tracing library. You can inspect it when analyzing the trace buffer,\n\
16536 by printing the $_sdata variable like any other convenience variable.\n\
16538 CONDITION is a boolean expression.\n\
16539 \n" LOCATION_HELP_STRING "\n\
16540 Multiple tracepoints at one place are permitted, and useful if their\n\
16541 conditions are different.\n\
16543 Do \"help breakpoints\" for info on other commands dealing with breakpoints.\n\
16544 Do \"help tracepoints\" for info on other tracepoint commands."));
16545 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
16547 add_info ("tracepoints", tracepoints_info, _("\
16548 Status of specified tracepoints (all tracepoints if no argument).\n\
16549 Convenience variable \"$tpnum\" contains the number of the\n\
16550 last tracepoint set."));
16552 add_info_alias ("tp", "tracepoints", 1);
16554 add_cmd ("tracepoints", class_trace, delete_trace_command, _("\
16555 Delete specified tracepoints.\n\
16556 Arguments are tracepoint numbers, separated by spaces.\n\
16557 No argument means delete all tracepoints."),
16559 add_alias_cmd ("tr", "tracepoints", class_trace, 1, &deletelist);
16561 c = add_cmd ("tracepoints", class_trace, disable_trace_command, _("\
16562 Disable specified tracepoints.\n\
16563 Arguments are tracepoint numbers, separated by spaces.\n\
16564 No argument means disable all tracepoints."),
16566 deprecate_cmd (c, "disable");
16568 c = add_cmd ("tracepoints", class_trace, enable_trace_command, _("\
16569 Enable specified tracepoints.\n\
16570 Arguments are tracepoint numbers, separated by spaces.\n\
16571 No argument means enable all tracepoints."),
16573 deprecate_cmd (c, "enable");
16575 add_com ("passcount", class_trace, trace_pass_command, _("\
16576 Set the passcount for a tracepoint.\n\
16577 The trace will end when the tracepoint has been passed 'count' times.\n\
16578 Usage: passcount COUNT TPNUM, where TPNUM may also be \"all\";\n\
16579 if TPNUM is omitted, passcount refers to the last tracepoint defined."));
16581 add_prefix_cmd ("save", class_breakpoint, save_command,
16582 _("Save breakpoint definitions as a script."),
16583 &save_cmdlist, "save ",
16584 0/*allow-unknown*/, &cmdlist);
16586 c = add_cmd ("breakpoints", class_breakpoint, save_breakpoints_command, _("\
16587 Save current breakpoint definitions as a script.\n\
16588 This includes all types of breakpoints (breakpoints, watchpoints,\n\
16589 catchpoints, tracepoints). Use the 'source' command in another debug\n\
16590 session to restore them."),
16592 set_cmd_completer (c, filename_completer);
16594 c = add_cmd ("tracepoints", class_trace, save_tracepoints_command, _("\
16595 Save current tracepoint definitions as a script.\n\
16596 Use the 'source' command in another debug session to restore them."),
16598 set_cmd_completer (c, filename_completer);
16600 c = add_com_alias ("save-tracepoints", "save tracepoints", class_trace, 0);
16601 deprecate_cmd (c, "save tracepoints");
16603 add_prefix_cmd ("breakpoint", class_maintenance, set_breakpoint_cmd, _("\
16604 Breakpoint specific settings\n\
16605 Configure various breakpoint-specific variables such as\n\
16606 pending breakpoint behavior"),
16607 &breakpoint_set_cmdlist, "set breakpoint ",
16608 0/*allow-unknown*/, &setlist);
16609 add_prefix_cmd ("breakpoint", class_maintenance, show_breakpoint_cmd, _("\
16610 Breakpoint specific settings\n\
16611 Configure various breakpoint-specific variables such as\n\
16612 pending breakpoint behavior"),
16613 &breakpoint_show_cmdlist, "show breakpoint ",
16614 0/*allow-unknown*/, &showlist);
16616 add_setshow_auto_boolean_cmd ("pending", no_class,
16617 &pending_break_support, _("\
16618 Set debugger's behavior regarding pending breakpoints."), _("\
16619 Show debugger's behavior regarding pending breakpoints."), _("\
16620 If on, an unrecognized breakpoint location will cause gdb to create a\n\
16621 pending breakpoint. If off, an unrecognized breakpoint location results in\n\
16622 an error. If auto, an unrecognized breakpoint location results in a\n\
16623 user-query to see if a pending breakpoint should be created."),
16625 show_pending_break_support,
16626 &breakpoint_set_cmdlist,
16627 &breakpoint_show_cmdlist);
16629 pending_break_support = AUTO_BOOLEAN_AUTO;
16631 add_setshow_boolean_cmd ("auto-hw", no_class,
16632 &automatic_hardware_breakpoints, _("\
16633 Set automatic usage of hardware breakpoints."), _("\
16634 Show automatic usage of hardware breakpoints."), _("\
16635 If set, the debugger will automatically use hardware breakpoints for\n\
16636 breakpoints set with \"break\" but falling in read-only memory. If not set,\n\
16637 a warning will be emitted for such breakpoints."),
16639 show_automatic_hardware_breakpoints,
16640 &breakpoint_set_cmdlist,
16641 &breakpoint_show_cmdlist);
16643 add_setshow_boolean_cmd ("always-inserted", class_support,
16644 &always_inserted_mode, _("\
16645 Set mode for inserting breakpoints."), _("\
16646 Show mode for inserting breakpoints."), _("\
16647 When this mode is on, breakpoints are inserted immediately as soon as\n\
16648 they're created, kept inserted even when execution stops, and removed\n\
16649 only when the user deletes them. When this mode is off (the default),\n\
16650 breakpoints are inserted only when execution continues, and removed\n\
16651 when execution stops."),
16653 &show_always_inserted_mode,
16654 &breakpoint_set_cmdlist,
16655 &breakpoint_show_cmdlist);
16657 add_setshow_enum_cmd ("condition-evaluation", class_breakpoint,
16658 condition_evaluation_enums,
16659 &condition_evaluation_mode_1, _("\
16660 Set mode of breakpoint condition evaluation."), _("\
16661 Show mode of breakpoint condition evaluation."), _("\
16662 When this is set to \"host\", breakpoint conditions will be\n\
16663 evaluated on the host's side by GDB. When it is set to \"target\",\n\
16664 breakpoint conditions will be downloaded to the target (if the target\n\
16665 supports such feature) and conditions will be evaluated on the target's side.\n\
16666 If this is set to \"auto\" (default), this will be automatically set to\n\
16667 \"target\" if it supports condition evaluation, otherwise it will\n\
16668 be set to \"gdb\""),
16669 &set_condition_evaluation_mode,
16670 &show_condition_evaluation_mode,
16671 &breakpoint_set_cmdlist,
16672 &breakpoint_show_cmdlist);
16674 add_com ("break-range", class_breakpoint, break_range_command, _("\
16675 Set a breakpoint for an address range.\n\
16676 break-range START-LOCATION, END-LOCATION\n\
16677 where START-LOCATION and END-LOCATION can be one of the following:\n\
16678 LINENUM, for that line in the current file,\n\
16679 FILE:LINENUM, for that line in that file,\n\
16680 +OFFSET, for that number of lines after the current line\n\
16681 or the start of the range\n\
16682 FUNCTION, for the first line in that function,\n\
16683 FILE:FUNCTION, to distinguish among like-named static functions.\n\
16684 *ADDRESS, for the instruction at that address.\n\
16686 The breakpoint will stop execution of the inferior whenever it executes\n\
16687 an instruction at any address within the [START-LOCATION, END-LOCATION]\n\
16688 range (including START-LOCATION and END-LOCATION)."));
16690 c = add_com ("dprintf", class_breakpoint, dprintf_command, _("\
16691 Set a dynamic printf at specified location.\n\
16692 dprintf location,format string,arg1,arg2,...\n\
16693 location may be a linespec, explicit, or address location.\n"
16694 "\n" LOCATION_HELP_STRING));
16695 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
16697 add_setshow_enum_cmd ("dprintf-style", class_support,
16698 dprintf_style_enums, &dprintf_style, _("\
16699 Set the style of usage for dynamic printf."), _("\
16700 Show the style of usage for dynamic printf."), _("\
16701 This setting chooses how GDB will do a dynamic printf.\n\
16702 If the value is \"gdb\", then the printing is done by GDB to its own\n\
16703 console, as with the \"printf\" command.\n\
16704 If the value is \"call\", the print is done by calling a function in your\n\
16705 program; by default printf(), but you can choose a different function or\n\
16706 output stream by setting dprintf-function and dprintf-channel."),
16707 update_dprintf_commands, NULL,
16708 &setlist, &showlist);
16710 dprintf_function = xstrdup ("printf");
16711 add_setshow_string_cmd ("dprintf-function", class_support,
16712 &dprintf_function, _("\
16713 Set the function to use for dynamic printf"), _("\
16714 Show the function to use for dynamic printf"), NULL,
16715 update_dprintf_commands, NULL,
16716 &setlist, &showlist);
16718 dprintf_channel = xstrdup ("");
16719 add_setshow_string_cmd ("dprintf-channel", class_support,
16720 &dprintf_channel, _("\
16721 Set the channel to use for dynamic printf"), _("\
16722 Show the channel to use for dynamic printf"), NULL,
16723 update_dprintf_commands, NULL,
16724 &setlist, &showlist);
16726 add_setshow_boolean_cmd ("disconnected-dprintf", no_class,
16727 &disconnected_dprintf, _("\
16728 Set whether dprintf continues after GDB disconnects."), _("\
16729 Show whether dprintf continues after GDB disconnects."), _("\
16730 Use this to let dprintf commands continue to hit and produce output\n\
16731 even if GDB disconnects or detaches from the target."),
16734 &setlist, &showlist);
16736 add_com ("agent-printf", class_vars, agent_printf_command, _("\
16737 agent-printf \"printf format string\", arg1, arg2, arg3, ..., argn\n\
16738 (target agent only) This is useful for formatted output in user-defined commands."));
16740 automatic_hardware_breakpoints = 1;
16742 observer_attach_about_to_proceed (breakpoint_about_to_proceed);
16743 observer_attach_thread_exit (remove_threaded_breakpoints);